blob: 31aac447aa68b0358af668c3ea154a0e94d0f0e8 [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau8317b282014-04-23 01:49:41 +02002 HAProxy
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreaufba74ea2018-12-22 11:19:45 +01005 version 2.0
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
Willy Tarreau6e893b92019-03-26 05:40:51 +01007 2019/03/26
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011specified above. It does not provide any hints, examples, or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013The summary below is meant to help you find sections by name and navigate
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outputs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to emphasize the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when they may be ambiguous. If you add sections,
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020025 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100341.2.1. The request line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100371.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200422.2. Quoting and escaping
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200432.3. Environment variables
442.4. Time format
452.5. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020046
473. Global parameters
483.1. Process management and security
493.2. Performance tuning
503.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100513.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200523.5. Peers
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200533.6. Mailers
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020054
554. Proxies
564.1. Proxy keywords matrix
574.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
58
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100595. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200605.1. Bind options
615.2. Server and default-server options
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +0200625.3. Server DNS resolution
635.3.1. Global overview
645.3.2. The resolvers section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020065
666. HTTP header manipulation
67
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200687. Using ACLs and fetching samples
697.1. ACL basics
707.1.1. Matching booleans
717.1.2. Matching integers
727.1.3. Matching strings
737.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
747.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
757.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
767.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
777.3. Fetching samples
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200787.3.1. Converters
797.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
807.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
817.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
827.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
837.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200847.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020085
868. Logging
878.1. Log levels
888.2. Log formats
898.2.1. Default log format
908.2.2. TCP log format
918.2.3. HTTP log format
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +0100928.2.4. Custom log format
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +0100938.2.5. Error log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200948.3. Advanced logging options
958.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
968.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
978.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
988.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
998.4. Timing events
1008.5. Session state at disconnection
1018.6. Non-printable characters
1028.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
1038.8. Capturing HTTP headers
1048.9. Examples of logs
105
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02001069. Supported filters
1079.1. Trace
1089.2. HTTP compression
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +02001099.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +01001109.4. Cache
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200111
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010011210. Cache
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +010011310.1. Limitation
11410.2. Setup
11510.2.1. Cache section
11610.2.2. Proxy section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200117
1181. Quick reminder about HTTP
119----------------------------
120
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100121When HAProxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200122fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
123on almost anything found in the contents.
124
125However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
126formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
127correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
128
129
1301.1. The HTTP transaction model
131-------------------------------
132
133The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100134to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100135from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client through the
136connection, the server responds, and the connection is closed. A new request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200137will involve a new connection :
138
139 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
140
141In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
142establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
143by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
144length.
145
146Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
147to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
148however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
149response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
150header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
151
152 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
153
154Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
155power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
156but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200157a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200158
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100159Another improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200160keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
161second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
162page :
163
164 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
165
166This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
167latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
168correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
169the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100170server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200171
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100172The next improvement is the multiplexed mode, as implemented in HTTP/2. This
173time, each transaction is assigned a single stream identifier, and all streams
174are multiplexed over an existing connection. Many requests can be sent in
175parallel by the client, and responses can arrive in any order since they also
176carry the stream identifier.
177
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100178By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
179connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
180leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100181start of a new request. When it receives HTTP/2 connections from a client, it
182processes all the requests in parallel and leaves the connection idling,
183waiting for new requests, just as if it was a keep-alive HTTP connection.
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200184
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200185HAProxy supports 4 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100186 - keep alive : all requests and responses are processed (default)
187 - tunnel : only the first request and response are processed,
Christopher Faulet6c9bbb22019-03-26 21:37:23 +0100188 everything else is forwarded with no analysis (deprecated).
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100189 - server close : the server-facing connection is closed after the response.
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200190 - close : the connection is actively closed after end of response.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100191
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100192For HTTP/2, the connection mode resembles more the "server close" mode : given
193the independence of all streams, there is currently no place to hook the idle
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100194server connection after a response, so it is closed after the response. HTTP/2
195is only supported for incoming connections, not on connections going to
196servers.
197
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200198
1991.2. HTTP request
200-----------------
201
202First, let's consider this HTTP request :
203
204 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100205 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200206 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
207 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
208 3 User-agent: my small browser
209 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
210 5 Accept: image/png
211
212
2131.2.1. The Request line
214-----------------------
215
216Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
217
218 - a METHOD : GET
219 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
220 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
221
222All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
223which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
224followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
225is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
226desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
227the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
228
229The URI itself can have several forms :
230
231 - A "relative URI" :
232
233 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
234
235 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
236 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
237
238 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
239
240 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
241
242 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
243 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
244 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
245 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
246 must accept this form too.
247
248 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
249 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
250 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100251
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200252 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
253 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
254 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
255 other protocols too.
256
257In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
258mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
259on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
260It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
261specific to the language, framework or application in use.
262
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100263HTTP/2 doesn't convey a version information with the request, so the version is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100264assumed to be the same as the one of the underlying protocol (i.e. "HTTP/2").
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100265However, haproxy natively processes HTTP/1.x requests and headers, so requests
266received over an HTTP/2 connection are transcoded to HTTP/1.1 before being
267processed. This explains why they still appear as "HTTP/1.1" in haproxy's logs
268as well as in server logs.
269
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200270
2711.2.2. The request headers
272--------------------------
273
274The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
275beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
276an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
277Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
278values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
279encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
280the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
281define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
282
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100283Contrary to a common misconception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200284their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100285"Connection:" header). In HTTP/2, header names are always sent in lower case,
286as can be seen when running in debug mode.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200287
288The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
289that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
290is one valid form of empty line.
291
292Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
293headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
294about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
295application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
296
297Important note:
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000298 As suggested by RFC7231, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200299 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
300 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
301 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
302
303
3041.3. HTTP response
305------------------
306
307An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
308messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
309
310 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100311 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200312 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
313 2 Content-length: 350
314 3 Content-Type: text/html
315
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200316As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
317codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
318response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100319continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
320the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
321following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
322sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
323(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
324correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
325such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
326state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
327over the same connection and that haproxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
328if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
329information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200330
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200331
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003321.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200333------------------------
334
335Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
336
337 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
338 - a status code : 200
339 - a reason : OK
340
341The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100342 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (e.g. 100, 101)
343 - 2xx = OK, content is following (e.g. 200, 206)
344 - 3xx = OK, no content following (e.g. 302, 304)
345 - 4xx = error caused by the client (e.g. 401, 403, 404)
346 - 5xx = error caused by the server (e.g. 500, 502, 503)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200347
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000348Please refer to RFC7231 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100349"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200350found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
351messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
352or "Authentication Required".
353
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100354HAProxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200355
356 Code When / reason
357 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
358 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
359 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
360 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +0100361 307 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
362 308 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200363 400 for an invalid or too large request
364 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
365 accessing the stats page)
366 403 when a request is forbidden by a "block" ACL or "reqdeny" filter
367 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
368 500 when haproxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
369 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
370 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
371 when an "rspdeny" filter blocks the response.
372 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
373 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
374 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
375
376The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3774.2).
378
379
3801.3.2. The response headers
381---------------------------
382
383Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
384the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
385details.
386
387
3882. Configuring HAProxy
389----------------------
390
3912.1. Configuration file format
392------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200393
394HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
395
396 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
397 - the "global" section, which sets process-wide parameters
398 - the proxies sections which can take form of "defaults", "listen",
399 "frontend" and "backend".
400
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100401The configuration file syntax consists in lines beginning with a keyword
402referenced in this manual, optionally followed by one or several parameters
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200403delimited by spaces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100404
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200405
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +02004062.2. Quoting and escaping
407-------------------------
408
409HAProxy's configuration introduces a quoting and escaping system similar to
410many programming languages. The configuration file supports 3 types: escaping
411with a backslash, weak quoting with double quotes, and strong quoting with
412single quotes.
413
414If spaces have to be entered in strings, then they must be escaped by preceding
415them by a backslash ('\') or by quoting them. Backslashes also have to be
416escaped by doubling or strong quoting them.
417
418Escaping is achieved by preceding a special character by a backslash ('\'):
419
420 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
421 \# to mark a hash and differentiate it from a comment
422 \\ to use a backslash
423 \' to use a single quote and differentiate it from strong quoting
424 \" to use a double quote and differentiate it from weak quoting
425
426Weak quoting is achieved by using double quotes (""). Weak quoting prevents
427the interpretation of:
428
429 space as a parameter separator
430 ' single quote as a strong quoting delimiter
431 # hash as a comment start
432
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200433Weak quoting permits the interpretation of variables, if you want to use a non
434-interpreted dollar within a double quoted string, you should escape it with a
435backslash ("\$"), it does not work outside weak quoting.
436
437Interpretation of escaping and special characters are not prevented by weak
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200438quoting.
439
440Strong quoting is achieved by using single quotes (''). Inside single quotes,
441nothing is interpreted, it's the efficient way to quote regexes.
442
443Quoted and escaped strings are replaced in memory by their interpreted
444equivalent, it allows you to perform concatenation.
445
446 Example:
447 # those are equivalents:
448 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
449 log-format "%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r"
450 log-format '%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r'
451 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s %{-Q}r'
452 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s'\ %{-Q}r
453
454 # those are equivalents:
455 reqrep "^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" \1\ /\2
456 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" '\1 /\2'
457 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1 /\2"
458 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1\ /\2"
459
460
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004612.3. Environment variables
462--------------------------
463
464HAProxy's configuration supports environment variables. Those variables are
465interpreted only within double quotes. Variables are expanded during the
466configuration parsing. Variable names must be preceded by a dollar ("$") and
467optionally enclosed with braces ("{}") similarly to what is done in Bourne
468shell. Variable names can contain alphanumerical characters or the character
469underscore ("_") but should not start with a digit.
470
471 Example:
472
473 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
474
475 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
476
477 user "$HAPROXY_USER"
478
William Lallemanddaf4cd22018-04-17 16:46:13 +0200479A special variable $HAPROXY_LOCALPEER is defined at the startup of the process
480which contains the name of the local peer. (See "-L" in the management guide.)
481
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200482
4832.4. Time format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200484----------------
485
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100486Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100487values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
488otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
489numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
490for every keyword. Supported units are :
491
492 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
493 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
494 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
495 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
496 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
497 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
498
499
Lukas Tribusaa83a312017-03-21 09:25:09 +00005002.5. Examples
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200501-------------
502
503 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
504 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
505 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
506 global
507 daemon
508 maxconn 256
509
510 defaults
511 mode http
512 timeout connect 5000ms
513 timeout client 50000ms
514 timeout server 50000ms
515
516 frontend http-in
517 bind *:80
518 default_backend servers
519
520 backend servers
521 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
522
523
524 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
525 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
526 global
527 daemon
528 maxconn 256
529
530 defaults
531 mode http
532 timeout connect 5000ms
533 timeout client 50000ms
534 timeout server 50000ms
535
536 listen http-in
537 bind *:80
538 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
539
540
541Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
542
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100543 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200544
545
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005463. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200547--------------------
548
549Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
550are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
551of them have command-line equivalents.
552
553The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
554
555 * Process management and security
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200556 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200557 - chroot
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200558 - crt-base
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200559 - cpu-map
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200560 - daemon
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200561 - description
562 - deviceatlas-json-file
563 - deviceatlas-log-level
564 - deviceatlas-separator
565 - deviceatlas-properties-cookie
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900566 - external-check
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200567 - gid
568 - group
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +0100569 - hard-stop-after
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200570 - log
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200571 - log-tag
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100572 - log-send-hostname
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200573 - lua-load
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +0200574 - mworker-max-reloads
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200575 - nbproc
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +0200576 - nbthread
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200577 - node
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200578 - pidfile
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100579 - presetenv
580 - resetenv
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200581 - uid
582 - ulimit-n
583 - user
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +0200584 - set-dumpable
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100585 - setenv
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200586 - stats
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200587 - ssl-default-bind-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +0200588 - ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200589 - ssl-default-bind-options
590 - ssl-default-server-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +0200591 - ssl-default-server-ciphersuites
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200592 - ssl-default-server-options
593 - ssl-dh-param-file
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100594 - ssl-server-verify
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100595 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100596 - unsetenv
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100597 - 51degrees-data-file
598 - 51degrees-property-name-list
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200599 - 51degrees-property-separator
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +0200600 - 51degrees-cache-size
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +0200601 - wurfl-data-file
602 - wurfl-information-list
603 - wurfl-information-list-separator
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +0200604 - wurfl-cache-size
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100605
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200606 * Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +0200607 - max-spread-checks
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200608 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200609 - maxconnrate
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100610 - maxcomprate
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100611 - maxcompcpuusage
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100612 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +0200613 - maxsessrate
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200614 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +0200615 - maxsslrate
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200616 - maxzlibmem
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200617 - noepoll
618 - nokqueue
619 - nopoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100620 - nosplice
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300621 - nogetaddrinfo
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +0000622 - noreuseport
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +0100623 - profiling.tasks
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200624 - spread-checks
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +0200625 - server-state-base
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +0200626 - server-state-file
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +0000627 - ssl-engine
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +0000628 - ssl-mode-async
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200629 - tune.buffers.limit
630 - tune.buffers.reserve
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200631 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200632 - tune.chksize
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100633 - tune.comp.maxlevel
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +0200634 - tune.h2.header-table-size
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +0200635 - tune.h2.initial-window-size
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +0200636 - tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100637 - tune.http.cookielen
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +0200638 - tune.http.logurilen
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200639 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +0100640 - tune.idletimer
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100641 - tune.lua.forced-yield
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +0100642 - tune.lua.maxmem
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100643 - tune.lua.session-timeout
644 - tune.lua.task-timeout
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +0200645 - tune.lua.service-timeout
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100646 - tune.maxaccept
647 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200648 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +0200649 - tune.pattern.cache-size
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200650 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100651 - tune.rcvbuf.client
652 - tune.rcvbuf.server
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +0100653 - tune.recv_enough
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +0200654 - tune.runqueue-depth
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100655 - tune.sndbuf.client
656 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100657 - tune.ssl.cachesize
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100658 - tune.ssl.lifetime
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +0200659 - tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100660 - tune.ssl.maxrecord
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +0200661 - tune.ssl.default-dh-param
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +0200662 - tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +0100663 - tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +0200664 - tune.vars.global-max-size
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +0100665 - tune.vars.proc-max-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +0200666 - tune.vars.reqres-max-size
667 - tune.vars.sess-max-size
668 - tune.vars.txn-max-size
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +0100669 - tune.zlib.memlevel
670 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100671
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200672 * Debugging
673 - debug
674 - quiet
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200675
676
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006773.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200678------------------------------------
679
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200680ca-base <dir>
681 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +0200682 relative path is used with "ca-file" or "crl-file" directives. Absolute
683 locations specified in "ca-file" and "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200684
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200685chroot <jail dir>
686 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
687 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
688 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
689 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
690 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100691 empty and non-writable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100692
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100693cpu-map [auto:]<process-set>[/<thread-set>] <cpu-set>...
694 On Linux 2.6 and above, it is possible to bind a process or a thread to a
695 specific CPU set. This means that the process or the thread will never run on
696 other CPUs. The "cpu-map" directive specifies CPU sets for process or thread
697 sets. The first argument is a process set, eventually followed by a thread
698 set. These sets have the format
699
700 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
701
702 <number>> must be a number between 1 and 32 or 64, depending on the machine's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100703 word size. Any process IDs above nbproc and any thread IDs above nbthread are
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100704 ignored. It is possible to specify a range with two such number delimited by
705 a dash ('-'). It also is possible to specify all processes at once using
Christopher Faulet1dcb9cb2017-11-22 10:24:40 +0100706 "all", only odd numbers using "odd" or even numbers using "even", just like
707 with the "bind-process" directive. The second and forthcoming arguments are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100708 CPU sets. Each CPU set is either a unique number between 0 and 31 or 63 or a
Christopher Faulet1dcb9cb2017-11-22 10:24:40 +0100709 range with two such numbers delimited by a dash ('-'). Multiple CPU numbers
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100710 or ranges may be specified, and the processes or threads will be allowed to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100711 bind to all of them. Obviously, multiple "cpu-map" directives may be
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100712 specified. Each "cpu-map" directive will replace the previous ones when they
713 overlap. A thread will be bound on the intersection of its mapping and the
714 one of the process on which it is attached. If the intersection is null, no
715 specific binding will be set for the thread.
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100716
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +0100717 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
718 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value, 32 or 64 depending
719 on the machine's word size.
720
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100721 The prefix "auto:" can be added before the process set to let HAProxy
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100722 automatically bind a process or a thread to a CPU by incrementing
723 process/thread and CPU sets. To be valid, both sets must have the same
724 size. No matter the declaration order of the CPU sets, it will be bound from
725 the lowest to the highest bound. Having a process and a thread range with the
726 "auto:" prefix is not supported. Only one range is supported, the other one
727 must be a fixed number.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100728
729 Examples:
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100730 cpu-map 1-4 0-3 # bind processes 1 to 4 on the first 4 CPUs
731
732 cpu-map 1/all 0-3 # bind all threads of the first process on the
733 # first 4 CPUs
734
735 cpu-map 1- 0- # will be replaced by "cpu-map 1-64 0-63"
736 # or "cpu-map 1-32 0-31" depending on the machine's
737 # word size.
738
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100739 # all these lines bind the process 1 to the cpu 0, the process 2 to cpu 1
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100740 # and so on.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100741 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-3
742 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-1 2-3
743 cpu-map auto:1-4 3 2 1 0
744
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100745 # all these lines bind the thread 1 to the cpu 0, the thread 2 to cpu 1
746 # and so on.
747 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-3
748 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-1 2-3
749 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 3 2 1 0
750
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100751 # bind each process to exactly one CPU using all/odd/even keyword
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100752 cpu-map auto:all 0-63
753 cpu-map auto:even 0-31
754 cpu-map auto:odd 32-63
755
756 # invalid cpu-map because process and CPU sets have different sizes.
757 cpu-map auto:1-4 0 # invalid
758 cpu-map auto:1 0-3 # invalid
759
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100760 # invalid cpu-map because automatic binding is used with a process range
761 # and a thread range.
762 cpu-map auto:all/all 0 # invalid
763 cpu-map auto:all/1-4 0 # invalid
764 cpu-map auto:1-4/all 0 # invalid
765
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200766crt-base <dir>
767 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
768 path is used with "crtfile" directives. Absolute locations specified after
769 "crtfile" prevail and ignore "crt-base".
770
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200771daemon
772 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
773 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
Lukas Tribusf46bf952017-11-21 12:39:34 +0100774 disabled by the command line "-db" argument. This option is ignored in
775 systemd mode.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200776
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200777deviceatlas-json-file <path>
778 Sets the path of the DeviceAtlas JSON data file to be loaded by the API.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100779 The path must be a valid JSON data file and accessible by HAProxy process.
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200780
781deviceatlas-log-level <value>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100782 Sets the level of information returned by the API. This directive is
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200783 optional and set to 0 by default if not set.
784
785deviceatlas-separator <char>
786 Sets the character separator for the API properties results. This directive
787 is optional and set to | by default if not set.
788
Cyril Bonté0306c4a2015-10-26 22:37:38 +0100789deviceatlas-properties-cookie <name>
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200790 Sets the client cookie's name used for the detection if the DeviceAtlas
791 Client-side component was used during the request. This directive is optional
792 and set to DAPROPS by default if not set.
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +0100793
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900794external-check
795 Allows the use of an external agent to perform health checks.
796 This is disabled by default as a security precaution.
797 See "option external-check".
798
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200799gid <number>
800 Changes the process' group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
801 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
802 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
Michael Schererab012dd2013-01-12 18:35:19 +0100803 Note that if haproxy is started from a user having supplementary groups, it
804 will only be able to drop these groups if started with superuser privileges.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200805 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100806
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +0100807hard-stop-after <time>
808 Defines the maximum time allowed to perform a clean soft-stop.
809
810 Arguments :
811 <time> is the maximum time (by default in milliseconds) for which the
812 instance will remain alive when a soft-stop is received via the
813 SIGUSR1 signal.
814
815 This may be used to ensure that the instance will quit even if connections
816 remain opened during a soft-stop (for example with long timeouts for a proxy
817 in tcp mode). It applies both in TCP and HTTP mode.
818
819 Example:
820 global
821 hard-stop-after 30s
822
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200823group <group name>
824 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
825 See also "gid" and "user".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100826
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +0200827log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>]
828 <facility> [max level [min level]]
Cyril Bonté3e954872018-03-20 23:30:27 +0100829 Adds a global syslog server. Several global servers can be defined. They
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100830 will receive logs for starts and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100831 configured with "log global".
832
833 <address> can be one of:
834
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100835 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100836 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
837 port).
838
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +0100839 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
840 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
841 port).
842
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +0100843 - A filesystem path to a datagram UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100844 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
845 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100846 writable).
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100847
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +0100848 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may point
849 to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered logs are used
850 and one writev() call per log is performed. This is a bit expensive
851 but acceptable for most workloads. Messages sent this way will not be
852 truncated but may be dropped, in which case the DroppedLogs counter
853 will be incremented. The writev() call is atomic even on pipes for
854 messages up to PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least
855 512 and which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
856 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other processes.
857 Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file descriptor may also be
858 directed to a file, but doing so will significantly slow haproxy down
859 as non-blocking calls will be ignored. Also there will be no way to
860 purge nor rotate this file without restarting the process. Note that
861 the configured syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +0100862 for use with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
863 format below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +0100864
865 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1" and
866 "fd@2", see above.
867
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200868 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
869 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +0100870
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +0200871 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this value
872 will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that syslog
873 servers act differently on log line length. All servers support the
874 default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop larger lines
875 while others do log them. If a server supports long lines, it may
876 make sense to set this value here in order to avoid truncating long
877 lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines, it is preferable to
878 truncate them before sending them. Accepted values are 80 to 65535
879 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is generally fine for all
880 standard usages. Some specific cases of long captures or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100881 JSON-formatted logs may require larger values. You may also need to
882 increase "tune.http.logurilen" if your request URIs are truncated.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +0200883
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +0200884 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
885 one of the following :
886
887 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format. This is the default.
888 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
889
890 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
891 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
892
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +0100893 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
894 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
895 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
896 local log server. This format is compatible with what the systemd
897 logger consumes.
898
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +0100899 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
900 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
901 used in containers or during development, where the severity only
902 depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
903
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +0200904 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
905 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
906 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
907 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must be
908 set with <sample_size> parameter.
909
910 <sample_size>
911 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
912 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
913 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
914 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
915 (see also <ranges> parameter).
916
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100917 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200918
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +0100919 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
920 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
921 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
922
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +0100923 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
924 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
925 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
926 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200927
928 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +0200929 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
930 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
931 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
932 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
933 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
934 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200935
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200936 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200937
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100938log-send-hostname [<string>]
939 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
940 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
941 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
942 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
943 the logs.
944
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +0000945log-tag <string>
946 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
947 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
948 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +0100949 running on the same host. See also the per-proxy "log-tag" directive.
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +0000950
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100951lua-load <file>
952 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file. This directive can be
953 used multiple times.
954
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +0100955master-worker [no-exit-on-failure]
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +0200956 Master-worker mode. It is equivalent to the command line "-W" argument.
957 This mode will launch a "master" which will monitor the "workers". Using
958 this mode, you can reload HAProxy directly by sending a SIGUSR2 signal to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100959 the master. The master-worker mode is compatible either with the foreground
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +0200960 or daemon mode. It is recommended to use this mode with multiprocess and
961 systemd.
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +0100962 By default, if a worker exits with a bad return code, in the case of a
963 segfault for example, all workers will be killed, and the master will leave.
964 It is convenient to combine this behavior with Restart=on-failure in a
965 systemd unit file in order to relaunch the whole process. If you don't want
966 this behavior, you must use the keyword "no-exit-on-failure".
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +0200967
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +0100968 See also "-W" in the management guide.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +0200969
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +0200970mworker-max-reloads <number>
971 In master-worker mode, this option limits the number of time a worker can
972 survive to a reload. If the worker did not left after a reload, once its
973 number of reloads is greater than this number, the worker will receive a
974 SIGTERM. This option helps to keep under control the number of workers.
975 See also "show proc" in the Management Guide.
976
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200977nbproc <number>
978 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
979 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
980 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
Willy Tarreau149ab772019-01-26 14:27:06 +0100981 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. When set to a value
982 larger than 1, threads are automatically disabled. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
Willy Tarreau1f672a82019-01-26 14:20:55 +0100983 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. See also "daemon" and
984 "nbthread".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200985
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +0200986nbthread <number>
987 This setting is only available when support for threads was built in. It
Willy Tarreau26f6ae12019-02-02 12:56:15 +0100988 makes haproxy run on <number> threads. This is exclusive with "nbproc". While
989 "nbproc" historically used to be the only way to use multiple processors, it
990 also involved a number of shortcomings related to the lack of synchronization
991 between processes (health-checks, peers, stick-tables, stats, ...) which do
992 not affect threads. As such, any modern configuration is strongly encouraged
Willy Tarreau149ab772019-01-26 14:27:06 +0100993 to migrate away from "nbproc" to "nbthread". "nbthread" also works when
994 HAProxy is started in foreground. On some platforms supporting CPU affinity,
995 when nbproc is not used, the default "nbthread" value is automatically set to
996 the number of CPUs the process is bound to upon startup. This means that the
997 thread count can easily be adjusted from the calling process using commands
998 like "taskset" or "cpuset". Otherwise, this value defaults to 1. The default
999 value is reported in the output of "haproxy -vv". See also "nbproc".
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001000
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001001pidfile <pidfile>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001002 Writes PIDs of all daemons into file <pidfile>. This option is equivalent to
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001003 the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to the user
1004 starting the process. See also "daemon".
1005
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001006presetenv <name> <value>
1007 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1008 is NOT overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line
1009 in the configuration file sees the new value. See also "setenv", "resetenv",
1010 and "unsetenv".
1011
1012resetenv [<name> ...]
1013 Removes all environment variables except the ones specified in argument. It
1014 allows to use a clean controlled environment before setting new values with
1015 setenv or unsetenv. Please note that some internal functions may make use of
1016 some environment variables, such as time manipulation functions, but also
1017 OpenSSL or even external checks. This must be used with extreme care and only
1018 after complete validation. The changes immediately take effect so that the
1019 next line in the configuration file sees the new environment. See also
1020 "setenv", "presetenv", and "unsetenv".
1021
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001022stats bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +02001023 Limits the stats socket to a certain set of processes numbers. By default the
1024 stats socket is bound to all processes, causing a warning to be emitted when
1025 nbproc is greater than 1 because there is no way to select the target process
1026 when connecting. However, by using this setting, it becomes possible to pin
1027 the stats socket to a specific set of processes, typically the first one. The
1028 warning will automatically be disabled when this setting is used, whatever
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01001029 the number of processes used. The maximum process ID depends on the machine's
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001030 word size (32 or 64). Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can
1031 be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum
1032 value. A better option consists in using the "process" setting of the "stats
1033 socket" line to force the process on each line.
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +02001034
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001035server-state-base <directory>
1036 Specifies the directory prefix to be prepended in front of all servers state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001037 file names which do not start with a '/'. See also "server-state-file",
1038 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name".
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +02001039
1040server-state-file <file>
1041 Specifies the path to the file containing state of servers. If the path starts
1042 with a slash ('/'), it is considered absolute, otherwise it is considered
1043 relative to the directory specified using "server-state-base" (if set) or to
1044 the current directory. Before reloading HAProxy, it is possible to save the
1045 servers' current state using the stats command "show servers state". The
1046 output of this command must be written in the file pointed by <file>. When
1047 starting up, before handling traffic, HAProxy will read, load and apply state
1048 for each server found in the file and available in its current running
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001049 configuration. See also "server-state-base" and "show servers state",
1050 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name"
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001051
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001052setenv <name> <value>
1053 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1054 is overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line in
1055 the configuration file sees the new value. See also "presetenv", "resetenv",
1056 and "unsetenv".
1057
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +02001058set-dumpable
1059 This option is better left disabled by default and enabled only upon a
1060 developer's request. It has no impact on performance nor stability but will
1061 try hard to re-enable core dumps that were possibly disabled by file size
1062 limitations (ulimit -f), core size limitations (ulimit -c), or "dumpability"
1063 of a process after changing its UID/GID (such as /proc/sys/fs/suid_dumpable
1064 on Linux). Core dumps might still be limited by the current directory's
1065 permissions (check what directory the file is started from), the chroot
1066 directory's permission (it may be needed to temporarily disable the chroot
1067 directive or to move it to a dedicated writable location), or any other
1068 system-specific constraint. For example, some Linux flavours are notorious
1069 for replacing the default core file with a path to an executable not even
1070 installed on the system (check /proc/sys/kernel/core_pattern). Often, simply
1071 writing "core", "core.%p" or "/var/log/core/core.%p" addresses the issue.
1072 When trying to enable this option waiting for a rare issue to re-appear, it's
1073 often a good idea to first try to obtain such a dump by issuing, for example,
1074 "kill -11" to the haproxy process and verify that it leaves a core where
1075 expected when dying.
1076
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001077ssl-default-bind-ciphers <ciphers>
1078 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1079 the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite")
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001080 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 for all
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001081 "bind" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001082 is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1083 information and recommendations see e.g.
1084 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1085 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
1086 cipher configuration, please check the "ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites" keyword.
1087 Please check the "bind" keyword for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001088
1089ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1090 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1091 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default string
1092 describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated
1093 during the TLSv1.3 handshake for all "bind" lines which do not explicitly define
1094 theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001095 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1096 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1097 "ssl-default-bind-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "bind" keyword for more
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001098 information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001099
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001100ssl-default-bind-options [<option>]...
1101 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1102 default ssl-options to force on all "bind" lines. Please check the "bind"
1103 keyword to see available options.
1104
1105 Example:
1106 global
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +02001107 ssl-default-bind-options ssl-min-ver TLSv1.0 no-tls-tickets
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001108
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001109ssl-default-server-ciphers <ciphers>
1110 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
1111 sets the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001112 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 with the server,
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001113 for all "server" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001114 the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1115 information and recommendations see e.g.
1116 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1117 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/).
1118 For TLSv1.3 cipher configuration, please check the
1119 "ssl-default-server-ciphersuites" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword
1120 for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001121
1122ssl-default-server-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1123 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1124 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default
1125 string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are negotiated during
1126 the TLSv1.3 handshake with the server, for all "server" lines which do not
1127 explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001128 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1129 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1130 "ssl-default-server-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword for
1131 more information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001132
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001133ssl-default-server-options [<option>]...
1134 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1135 default ssl-options to force on all "server" lines. Please check the "server"
1136 keyword to see available options.
1137
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001138ssl-dh-param-file <file>
1139 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1140 the default DH parameters that are used during the SSL/TLS handshake when
1141 ephemeral Diffie-Hellman (DHE) key exchange is used, for all "bind" lines
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001142 which do not explicitly define theirs. It will be overridden by custom DH
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001143 parameters found in a bind certificate file if any. If custom DH parameters
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02001144 are not specified either by using ssl-dh-param-file or by setting them
1145 directly in the certificate file, pre-generated DH parameters of the size
1146 specified by tune.ssl.default-dh-param will be used. Custom parameters are
1147 known to be more secure and therefore their use is recommended.
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001148 Custom DH parameters may be generated by using the OpenSSL command
1149 "openssl dhparam <size>", where size should be at least 2048, as 1024-bit DH
1150 parameters should not be considered secure anymore.
1151
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +01001152ssl-server-verify [none|required]
1153 The default behavior for SSL verify on servers side. If specified to 'none',
1154 servers certificates are not verified. The default is 'required' except if
1155 forced using cmdline option '-dV'.
1156
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02001157stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
1158 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
1159 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
1160 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02001161 consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide for more
Kevin Decherf949c7202015-10-13 23:26:44 +02001162 details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +02001163
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02001164 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
1165 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
1166 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001167
1168stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
1169 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
1170 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +01001171 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001172
1173stats maxconn <connections>
1174 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
1175 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
1176
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001177uid <number>
1178 Changes the process' user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
1179 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
1180 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
1181 one. See also "gid" and "user".
1182
1183ulimit-n <number>
1184 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
1185 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
1186 option.
1187
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001188unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
1189 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
1190
1191 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
1192 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
1193 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
1194 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
1195 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
1196 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before haproxy chroots
1197 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
1198 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
1199 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
1200 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
1201
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001202unsetenv [<name> ...]
1203 Removes environment variables specified in arguments. This can be useful to
1204 hide some sensitive information that are occasionally inherited from the
1205 user's environment during some operations. Variables which did not exist are
1206 silently ignored so that after the operation, it is certain that none of
1207 these variables remain. The changes immediately take effect so that the next
1208 line in the configuration file will not see these variables. See also
1209 "setenv", "presetenv", and "resetenv".
1210
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001211user <user name>
1212 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
1213 See also "uid" and "group".
1214
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02001215node <name>
1216 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
1217
1218 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
1219 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
1220 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
1221 traffic.
1222
1223description <text>
1224 Add a text that describes the instance.
1225
1226 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
1227 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
1228 "<" and ">" characters.
1229
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100123051degrees-data-file <file path>
1231 The path of the 51Degrees data file to provide device detection services. The
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001232 file should be unzipped and accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001233
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001234 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001235 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1236
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +0000123751degrees-property-name-list [<string> ...]
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001238 A list of 51Degrees property names to be load from the dataset. A full list
1239 of names is available on the 51Degrees website:
1240 https://51degrees.com/resources/property-dictionary
1241
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001242 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001243 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1244
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200124551degrees-property-separator <char>
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001246 A char that will be appended to every property value in a response header
1247 containing 51Degrees results. If not set that will be set as ','.
1248
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001249 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
1250 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1251
125251degrees-cache-size <number>
1253 Sets the size of the 51Degrees converter cache to <number> entries. This
1254 is an LRU cache which reminds previous device detections and their results.
1255 By default, this cache is disabled.
1256
1257 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001258 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1259
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001260wurfl-data-file <file path>
1261 The path of the WURFL data file to provide device detection services. The
1262 file should be accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
1263
1264 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1265 with USE_WURFL=1.
1266
1267wurfl-information-list [<capability>]*
1268 A space-delimited list of WURFL capabilities, virtual capabilities, property
1269 names we plan to use in injected headers. A full list of capability and
1270 virtual capability names is available on the Scientiamobile website :
1271
1272 https://www.scientiamobile.com/wurflCapability
1273
1274 Valid WURFL properties are:
1275 - wurfl_id Contains the device ID of the matched device.
1276
1277 - wurfl_root_id Contains the device root ID of the matched
1278 device.
1279
1280 - wurfl_isdevroot Tells if the matched device is a root device.
1281 Possible values are "TRUE" or "FALSE".
1282
1283 - wurfl_useragent The original useragent coming with this
1284 particular web request.
1285
1286 - wurfl_api_version Contains a string representing the currently
1287 used Libwurfl API version.
1288
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001289 - wurfl_info A string containing information on the parsed
1290 wurfl.xml and its full path.
1291
1292 - wurfl_last_load_time Contains the UNIX timestamp of the last time
1293 WURFL has been loaded successfully.
1294
1295 - wurfl_normalized_useragent The normalized useragent.
1296
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001297 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1298 with USE_WURFL=1.
1299
1300wurfl-information-list-separator <char>
1301 A char that will be used to separate values in a response header containing
1302 WURFL results. If not set that a comma (',') will be used by default.
1303
1304 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1305 with USE_WURFL=1.
1306
1307wurfl-patch-file [<file path>]
1308 A list of WURFL patch file paths. Note that patches are loaded during startup
1309 thus before the chroot.
1310
1311 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1312 with USE_WURFL=1.
1313
paulborilebad132c2019-04-18 11:57:04 +02001314wurfl-cache-size <size>
1315 Sets the WURFL Useragent cache size. For faster lookups, already processed user
1316 agents are kept in a LRU cache :
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001317 - "0" : no cache is used.
paulborilebad132c2019-04-18 11:57:04 +02001318 - <size> : size of lru cache in elements.
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001319
1320 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1321 with USE_WURFL=1.
1322
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013233.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001324-----------------------
1325
Willy Tarreaubeb859a2018-11-22 18:07:59 +01001326busy-polling
1327 In some situations, especially when dealing with low latency on processors
1328 supporting a variable frequency or when running inside virtual machines, each
1329 time the process waits for an I/O using the poller, the processor goes back
1330 to sleep or is offered to another VM for a long time, and it causes
1331 excessively high latencies. This option provides a solution preventing the
1332 processor from sleeping by always using a null timeout on the pollers. This
1333 results in a significant latency reduction (30 to 100 microseconds observed)
1334 at the expense of a risk to overheat the processor. It may even be used with
1335 threads, in which case improperly bound threads may heavily conflict,
1336 resulting in a worse performance and high values for the CPU stolen fields
1337 in "show info" output, indicating which threads are misconfigured. It is
1338 important not to let the process run on the same processor as the network
1339 interrupts when this option is used. It is also better to avoid using it on
1340 multiple CPU threads sharing the same core. This option is disabled by
1341 default. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly disabled by
1342 prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It is ignored by the "select" and
1343 "poll" pollers.
1344
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02001345max-spread-checks <delay in milliseconds>
1346 By default, haproxy tries to spread the start of health checks across the
1347 smallest health check interval of all the servers in a farm. The principle is
1348 to avoid hammering services running on the same server. But when using large
1349 check intervals (10 seconds or more), the last servers in the farm take some
1350 time before starting to be tested, which can be a problem. This parameter is
1351 used to enforce an upper bound on delay between the first and the last check,
1352 even if the servers' check intervals are larger. When servers run with
1353 shorter intervals, their intervals will be respected though.
1354
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001355maxconn <number>
1356 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
1357 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
1358 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
Willy Tarreau8274e102014-06-19 15:31:25 +02001359 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n". Note:
1360 the "select" poller cannot reliably use more than 1024 file descriptors on
1361 some platforms. If your platform only supports select and reports "select
1362 FAILED" on startup, you need to reduce maxconn until it works (slightly
Willy Tarreaub28f3442019-03-04 08:13:43 +01001363 below 500 in general). If this value is not set, it will automatically be
1364 calculated based on the current file descriptors limit reported by the
1365 "ulimit -n" command, possibly reduced to a lower value if a memory limit
1366 is enforced, based on the buffer size, memory allocated to compression, SSL
1367 cache size, and use or not of SSL and the associated maxsslconn (which can
1368 also be automatic).
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001369
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +02001370maxconnrate <number>
1371 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
1372 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
1373 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
1374 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
1375 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
1376 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
1377 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
1378 fairness.
1379
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001380maxcomprate <number>
1381 Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001382 per second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001383 level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
1384 beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
1385 is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001386 tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001387 default value.
1388
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +01001389maxcompcpuusage <number>
1390 Sets the maximum CPU usage HAProxy can reach before stopping the compression
1391 for new requests or decreasing the compression level of current requests.
1392 It works like 'maxcomprate' but measures CPU usage instead of incoming data
1393 bandwidth. The value is expressed in percent of the CPU used by haproxy. In
1394 case of multiple processes (nbproc > 1), each process manages its individual
1395 usage. A value of 100 disable the limit. The default value is 100. Setting
1396 a lower value will prevent the compression work from slowing the whole
1397 process down and from introducing high latencies.
1398
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001399maxpipes <number>
1400 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
1401 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
1402 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
1403 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
1404 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
1405 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
1406
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +02001407maxsessrate <number>
1408 Sets the maximum per-process number of sessions per second to <number>.
1409 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
1410 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
1411 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
1412 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
1413 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
1414 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
1415 fairness.
1416
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001417maxsslconn <number>
1418 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
1419 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
1420 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
1421 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
1422 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
1423 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
1424 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01001425 If this value is not set, but a memory limit is enforced, this value will be
1426 automatically computed based on the memory limit, maxconn, the buffer size,
1427 memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use of SSL in either
1428 frontends, backends or both. If neither maxconn nor maxsslconn are specified
1429 when there is a memory limit, haproxy will automatically adjust these values
1430 so that 100% of the connections can be made over SSL with no risk, and will
1431 consider the sides where it is enabled (frontend, backend, both).
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001432
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +02001433maxsslrate <number>
1434 Sets the maximum per-process number of SSL sessions per second to <number>.
1435 SSL listeners will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It
1436 can be used to limit the global SSL CPU usage regardless of each frontend
1437 capacity. It is important to note that this can only be used as a service
1438 protection measure, as there will not necessarily be a fair share between
1439 frontends when the limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each
1440 frontend to some value close to its expected share. It is also important to
1441 note that the sessions are accounted before they enter the SSL stack and not
1442 after, which also protects the stack against bad handshakes. Also, lowering
1443 tune.maxaccept can improve fairness.
1444
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +01001445maxzlibmem <number>
1446 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
1447 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
1448 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
William Lallemande3a7d992012-11-20 11:25:20 +01001449 The default value is 0. The value is available in bytes on the UNIX socket
1450 with "show info" on the line "MaxZlibMemUsage", the memory used by zlib is
1451 "ZlibMemUsage" in bytes.
1452
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001453noepoll
1454 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
1455 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01001456 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001457
1458nokqueue
1459 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
1460 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
1461 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
1462
1463nopoll
1464 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
1465 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001466 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01001467 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue" and "noepoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001468
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001469nosplice
1470 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001471 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001472 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001473 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001474 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
1475 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
1476 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
1477 "option splice-response".
1478
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001479nogetaddrinfo
1480 Disables the use of getaddrinfo(3) for name resolving. It is equivalent to
1481 the command line argument "-dG". Deprecated gethostbyname(3) will be used.
1482
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +00001483noreuseport
1484 Disables the use of SO_REUSEPORT - see socket(7). It is equivalent to the
1485 command line argument "-dR".
1486
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02001487profiling.tasks { auto | on | off }
1488 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') per-task CPU profiling. When set to 'auto'
1489 the profiling automatically turns on a thread when it starts to suffer from
1490 an average latency of 1000 microseconds or higher as reported in the
1491 "avg_loop_us" activity field, and automatically turns off when the latency
1492 reutnrs below 990 microseconds (this value is an average over the last 1024
1493 loops so it does not vary quickly and tends to significantly smooth short
1494 spikes). It may also spontaneously trigger from time to time on overloaded
1495 systems, containers, or virtual machines, or when the system swaps (which
1496 must absolutely never happen on a load balancer).
1497
1498 CPU profiling per task can be very convenient to report where the time is
1499 spent and which requests have what effect on which other request. Enabling
1500 it will typically affect the overall's performance by less than 1%, thus it
1501 is recommended to leave it to the default 'auto' value so that it only
1502 operates when a problem is identified. This feature requires a system
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +01001503 supporting the clock_gettime(2) syscall with clock identifiers
1504 CLOCK_MONOTONIC and CLOCK_THREAD_CPUTIME_ID, otherwise the reported time will
1505 be zero. This option may be changed at run time using "set profiling" on the
1506 CLI.
1507
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001508spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09001509 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending agent and health checks to
1510 servers at exact intervals, for instance when many logical servers are
1511 located on the same physical server. With the help of this parameter, it
1512 becomes possible to add some randomness in the check interval between 0
1513 and +/- 50%. A value between 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The
1514 default value remains at 0.
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001515
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001516ssl-engine <name> [algo <comma-separated list of algorithms>]
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001517 Sets the OpenSSL engine to <name>. List of valid values for <name> may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001518 obtained using the command "openssl engine". This statement may be used
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001519 multiple times, it will simply enable multiple crypto engines. Referencing an
1520 unsupported engine will prevent haproxy from starting. Note that many engines
1521 will lead to lower HTTPS performance than pure software with recent
1522 processors. The optional command "algo" sets the default algorithms an ENGINE
1523 will supply using the OPENSSL function ENGINE_set_default_string(). A value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001524 of "ALL" uses the engine for all cryptographic operations. If no list of
1525 algo is specified then the value of "ALL" is used. A comma-separated list
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001526 of different algorithms may be specified, including: RSA, DSA, DH, EC, RAND,
1527 CIPHERS, DIGESTS, PKEY, PKEY_CRYPTO, PKEY_ASN1. This is the same format that
1528 openssl configuration file uses:
1529 https://www.openssl.org/docs/man1.0.2/apps/config.html
1530
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00001531ssl-mode-async
1532 Adds SSL_MODE_ASYNC mode to the SSL context. This enables asynchronous TLS
Emeric Brun3854e012017-05-17 20:42:48 +02001533 I/O operations if asynchronous capable SSL engines are used. The current
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00001534 implementation supports a maximum of 32 engines. The Openssl ASYNC API
1535 doesn't support moving read/write buffers and is not compliant with
1536 haproxy's buffer management. So the asynchronous mode is disabled on
1537 read/write operations (it is only enabled during initial and reneg
1538 handshakes).
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00001539
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01001540tune.buffers.limit <number>
1541 Sets a hard limit on the number of buffers which may be allocated per process.
1542 The default value is zero which means unlimited. The minimum non-zero value
1543 will always be greater than "tune.buffers.reserve" and should ideally always
1544 be about twice as large. Forcing this value can be particularly useful to
1545 limit the amount of memory a process may take, while retaining a sane
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001546 behavior. When this limit is reached, sessions which need a buffer wait for
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01001547 another one to be released by another session. Since buffers are dynamically
1548 allocated and released, the waiting time is very short and not perceptible
1549 provided that limits remain reasonable. In fact sometimes reducing the limit
1550 may even increase performance by increasing the CPU cache's efficiency. Tests
1551 have shown good results on average HTTP traffic with a limit to 1/10 of the
1552 expected global maxconn setting, which also significantly reduces memory
1553 usage. The memory savings come from the fact that a number of connections
1554 will not allocate 2*tune.bufsize. It is best not to touch this value unless
1555 advised to do so by an haproxy core developer.
1556
Willy Tarreau1058ae72014-12-23 22:40:40 +01001557tune.buffers.reserve <number>
1558 Sets the number of buffers which are pre-allocated and reserved for use only
1559 during memory shortage conditions resulting in failed memory allocations. The
1560 minimum value is 2 and is also the default. There is no reason a user would
1561 want to change this value, it's mostly aimed at haproxy core developers.
1562
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001563tune.bufsize <number>
1564 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
1565 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
1566 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
1567 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
1568 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
1569 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
1570 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
Willy Tarreau45a66cc2017-11-24 11:28:00 +01001571 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased. In
1572 addition, use of HTTP/2 mandates that this value must be 16384 or more. If an
1573 HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), haproxy will
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04001574 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
Willy Tarreauc77d3642018-12-12 06:19:42 +01001575 than this size, haproxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway). Note that the
1576 value set using this parameter will automatically be rounded up to the next
1577 multiple of 8 on 32-bit machines and 16 on 64-bit machines.
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001578
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +02001579tune.chksize <number>
1580 Sets the check buffer size to this size (in bytes). Higher values may help
1581 find string or regex patterns in very large pages, though doing so may imply
1582 more memory and CPU usage. The default value is 16384 and can be changed at
1583 build time. It is not recommended to change this value, but to use better
1584 checks whenever possible.
1585
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +01001586tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
1587 Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
1588 usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
1589 Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
1590 this value. The default value is 1.
1591
Willy Tarreauc299e1e2019-02-27 11:35:12 +01001592tune.fail-alloc
1593 If compiled with DEBUG_FAIL_ALLOC, gives the percentage of chances an
1594 allocation attempt fails. Must be between 0 (no failure) and 100 (no
1595 success). This is useful to debug and make sure memory failures are handled
1596 gracefully.
1597
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +02001598tune.h2.header-table-size <number>
1599 Sets the HTTP/2 dynamic header table size. It defaults to 4096 bytes and
1600 cannot be larger than 65536 bytes. A larger value may help certain clients
1601 send more compact requests, depending on their capabilities. This amount of
1602 memory is consumed for each HTTP/2 connection. It is recommended not to
1603 change it.
1604
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02001605tune.h2.initial-window-size <number>
1606 Sets the HTTP/2 initial window size, which is the number of bytes the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001607 can upload before waiting for an acknowledgment from haproxy. This setting
1608 only affects payload contents (i.e. the body of POST requests), not headers.
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02001609 The default value is 65535, which roughly allows up to 5 Mbps of upload
1610 bandwidth per client over a network showing a 100 ms ping time, or 500 Mbps
1611 over a 1-ms local network. It can make sense to increase this value to allow
1612 faster uploads, or to reduce it to increase fairness when dealing with many
1613 clients. It doesn't affect resource usage.
1614
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +02001615tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams <number>
1616 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum number of concurrent streams per connection (ie the
1617 number of outstanding requests on a single connection). The default value is
1618 100. A larger one may slightly improve page load time for complex sites when
1619 visited over high latency networks, but increases the amount of resources a
1620 single client may allocate. A value of zero disables the limit so a single
1621 client may create as many streams as allocatable by haproxy. It is highly
1622 recommended not to change this value.
1623
Willy Tarreaua24b35c2019-02-21 13:24:36 +01001624tune.h2.max-frame-size <number>
1625 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum frame size that haproxy announces it is willing to
1626 receive to its peers. The default value is the largest between 16384 and the
1627 buffer size (tune.bufsize). In any case, haproxy will not announce support
1628 for frame sizes larger than buffers. The main purpose of this setting is to
1629 allow to limit the maximum frame size setting when using large buffers. Too
1630 large frame sizes might have performance impact or cause some peers to
1631 misbehave. It is highly recommended not to change this value.
1632
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01001633tune.http.cookielen <number>
1634 Sets the maximum length of captured cookies. This is the maximum value that
1635 the "capture cookie xxx len yyy" will be allowed to take, and any upper value
1636 will automatically be truncated to this one. It is important not to set too
1637 high a value because all cookie captures still allocate this size whatever
1638 their configured value (they share a same pool). This value is per request
1639 per response, so the memory allocated is twice this value per connection.
1640 When not specified, the limit is set to 63 characters. It is recommended not
1641 to change this value.
1642
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001643tune.http.logurilen <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001644 Sets the maximum length of request URI in logs. This prevents truncating long
1645 request URIs with valuable query strings in log lines. This is not related
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001646 to syslog limits. If you increase this limit, you may also increase the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001647 'log ... len yyy' parameter. Your syslog daemon may also need specific
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001648 configuration directives too.
1649 The default value is 1024.
1650
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001651tune.http.maxhdr <number>
1652 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
1653 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
1654 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
1655 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
1656 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
1657 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
Christopher Faulet50174f32017-06-21 16:31:35 +02001658 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. The accepted range is
1659 1..32767. Keep in mind that each new header consumes 32bits of memory for
1660 each session, so don't push this limit too high.
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001661
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001662tune.idletimer <timeout>
1663 Sets the duration after which haproxy will consider that an empty buffer is
1664 probably associated with an idle stream. This is used to optimally adjust
1665 some packet sizes while forwarding large and small data alternatively. The
1666 decision to use splice() or to send large buffers in SSL is modulated by this
1667 parameter. The value is in milliseconds between 0 and 65535. A value of zero
1668 means that haproxy will not try to detect idle streams. The default is 1000,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001669 which seems to correctly detect end user pauses (e.g. read a page before
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001670 clicking). There should be not reason for changing this value. Please check
1671 tune.ssl.maxrecord below.
1672
Willy Tarreau7ac908b2019-02-27 12:02:18 +01001673tune.listener.multi-queue { on | off }
1674 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the listener's multi-queue accept which
1675 spreads the incoming traffic to all threads a "bind" line is allowed to run
1676 on instead of taking them for itself. This provides a smoother traffic
1677 distribution and scales much better, especially in environments where threads
1678 may be unevenly loaded due to external activity (network interrupts colliding
1679 with one thread for example). This option is enabled by default, but it may
1680 be forcefully disabled for troubleshooting or for situations where it is
1681 estimated that the operating system already provides a good enough
1682 distribution and connections are extremely short-lived.
1683
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001684tune.lua.forced-yield <number>
1685 This directive forces the Lua engine to execute a yield each <number> of
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01001686 instructions executed. This permits interrupting a long script and allows the
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001687 HAProxy scheduler to process other tasks like accepting connections or
1688 forwarding traffic. The default value is 10000 instructions. If HAProxy often
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001689 executes some Lua code but more responsiveness is required, this value can be
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001690 lowered. If the Lua code is quite long and its result is absolutely required
1691 to process the data, the <number> can be increased.
1692
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +01001693tune.lua.maxmem
1694 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by Lua. By
1695 default it is zero which means unlimited. It is important to set a limit to
1696 ensure that a bug in a script will not result in the system running out of
1697 memory.
1698
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001699tune.lua.session-timeout <timeout>
1700 This is the execution timeout for the Lua sessions. This is useful for
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001701 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
1702 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001703 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001704
1705tune.lua.task-timeout <timeout>
1706 Purpose is the same as "tune.lua.session-timeout", but this timeout is
1707 dedicated to the tasks. By default, this timeout isn't set because a task may
1708 remain alive during of the lifetime of HAProxy. For example, a task used to
1709 check servers.
1710
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001711tune.lua.service-timeout <timeout>
1712 This is the execution timeout for the Lua services. This is useful for
1713 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
1714 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001715 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001716
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001717tune.maxaccept <number>
Willy Tarreau16a21472012-11-19 12:39:59 +01001718 Sets the maximum number of consecutive connections a process may accept in a
1719 row before switching to other work. In single process mode, higher numbers
1720 give better performance at high connection rates. However in multi-process
1721 modes, keeping a bit of fairness between processes generally is better to
1722 increase performance. This value applies individually to each listener, so
1723 that the number of processes a listener is bound to is taken into account.
1724 This value defaults to 64. In multi-process mode, it is divided by twice
1725 the number of processes the listener is bound to. Setting this value to -1
1726 completely disables the limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak
1727 this value.
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001728
1729tune.maxpollevents <number>
1730 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
1731 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
1732 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
1733 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
1734 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
1735
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001736tune.maxrewrite <number>
1737 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
1738 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
1739 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
1740 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
1741 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
1742 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
1743 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
1744 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
1745 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
1746 bufsize.
1747
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02001748tune.pattern.cache-size <number>
1749 Sets the size of the pattern lookup cache to <number> entries. This is an LRU
1750 cache which reminds previous lookups and their results. It is used by ACLs
1751 and maps on slow pattern lookups, namely the ones using the "sub", "reg",
1752 "dir", "dom", "end", "bin" match methods as well as the case-insensitive
1753 strings. It applies to pattern expressions which means that it will be able
1754 to memorize the result of a lookup among all the patterns specified on a
1755 configuration line (including all those loaded from files). It automatically
1756 invalidates entries which are updated using HTTP actions or on the CLI. The
1757 default cache size is set to 10000 entries, which limits its footprint to
1758 about 5 MB on 32-bit systems and 8 MB on 64-bit systems. There is a very low
1759 risk of collision in this cache, which is in the order of the size of the
1760 cache divided by 2^64. Typically, at 10000 requests per second with the
1761 default cache size of 10000 entries, there's 1% chance that a brute force
1762 attack could cause a single collision after 60 years, or 0.1% after 6 years.
1763 This is considered much lower than the risk of a memory corruption caused by
1764 aging components. If this is not acceptable, the cache can be disabled by
1765 setting this parameter to 0.
1766
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02001767tune.pipesize <number>
1768 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
1769 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
1770 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
1771 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
1772 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
1773 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
1774
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02001775tune.pool-low-fd-ratio <number>
1776 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
1777 haproxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors haproxy can
1778 use before we stop putting connection into the idle pool for reuse. The
1779 default is 20.
1780
1781tune.pool-high-fd-ratio <number>
1782 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
1783 haproxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors haproxy can
1784 use before we start killing idle connections when we can't reuse a connection
1785 and we have to create a new one. The default is 25 (one quarter of the file
1786 descriptor will mean that roughly half of the maximum front connections can
1787 keep an idle connection behind, anything beyond this probably doesn't make
1788 much sense in the general case when targetting connection reuse).
1789
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001790tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
1791tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
1792 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
1793 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
1794 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
1795 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001796 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001797 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
1798 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
1799
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01001800tune.recv_enough <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001801 HAProxy uses some hints to detect that a short read indicates the end of the
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01001802 socket buffers. One of them is that a read returns more than <recv_enough>
1803 bytes, which defaults to 10136 (7 segments of 1448 each). This default value
1804 may be changed by this setting to better deal with workloads involving lots
1805 of short messages such as telnet or SSH sessions.
1806
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02001807tune.runqueue-depth <number>
1808 Sets the maxinum amount of task that can be processed at once when running
1809 tasks. The default value is 200. Increasing it may incur latency when
1810 dealing with I/Os, making it too small can incur extra overhead.
1811
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001812tune.sndbuf.client <number>
1813tune.sndbuf.server <number>
1814 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
1815 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
1816 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
1817 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001818 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001819 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
1820 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
1821 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
1822 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
1823 notifying haproxy again.
1824
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001825tune.ssl.cachesize <number>
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001826 Sets the size of the global SSL session cache, in a number of blocks. A block
1827 is large enough to contain an encoded session without peer certificate.
1828 An encoded session with peer certificate is stored in multiple blocks
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001829 depending on the size of the peer certificate. A block uses approximately
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001830 200 bytes of memory. The default value may be forced at build time, otherwise
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001831 defaults to 20000. When the cache is full, the most idle entries are purged
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001832 and reassigned. Higher values reduce the occurrence of such a purge, hence
1833 the number of CPU-intensive SSL handshakes by ensuring that all users keep
1834 their session as long as possible. All entries are pre-allocated upon startup
Emeric Brun22890a12012-12-28 14:41:32 +01001835 and are shared between all processes if "nbproc" is greater than 1. Setting
1836 this value to 0 disables the SSL session cache.
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001837
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02001838tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02001839 This option disables SSL session cache sharing between all processes. It
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02001840 should normally not be used since it will force many renegotiations due to
1841 clients hitting a random process. But it may be required on some operating
1842 systems where none of the SSL cache synchronization method may be used. In
1843 this case, adding a first layer of hash-based load balancing before the SSL
1844 layer might limit the impact of the lack of session sharing.
1845
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01001846tune.ssl.lifetime <timeout>
1847 Sets how long a cached SSL session may remain valid. This time is expressed
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001848 in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 min). It is important to understand that it
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01001849 does not guarantee that sessions will last that long, because if the cache is
1850 full, the longest idle sessions will be purged despite their configured
1851 lifetime. The real usefulness of this setting is to prevent sessions from
1852 being used for too long.
1853
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001854tune.ssl.maxrecord <number>
1855 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at a time. Default
1856 value 0 means there is no limit. Over SSL/TLS, the client can decipher the
1857 data only once it has received a full record. With large records, it means
1858 that clients might have to download up to 16kB of data before starting to
1859 process them. Limiting the value can improve page load times on browsers
1860 located over high latency or low bandwidth networks. It is suggested to find
1861 optimal values which fit into 1 or 2 TCP segments (generally 1448 bytes over
1862 Ethernet with TCP timestamps enabled, or 1460 when timestamps are disabled),
1863 keeping in mind that SSL/TLS add some overhead. Typical values of 1419 and
1864 2859 gave good results during tests. Use "strace -e trace=write" to find the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001865 best value. HAProxy will automatically switch to this setting after an idle
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001866 stream has been detected (see tune.idletimer above).
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001867
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02001868tune.ssl.default-dh-param <number>
1869 Sets the maximum size of the Diffie-Hellman parameters used for generating
1870 the ephemeral/temporary Diffie-Hellman key in case of DHE key exchange. The
1871 final size will try to match the size of the server's RSA (or DSA) key (e.g,
1872 a 2048 bits temporary DH key for a 2048 bits RSA key), but will not exceed
1873 this maximum value. Default value if 1024. Only 1024 or higher values are
1874 allowed. Higher values will increase the CPU load, and values greater than
1875 1024 bits are not supported by Java 7 and earlier clients. This value is not
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001876 used if static Diffie-Hellman parameters are supplied either directly
1877 in the certificate file or by using the ssl-dh-param-file parameter.
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02001878
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02001879tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size <number>
1880 Sets the size of the cache used to store generated certificates to <number>
1881 entries. This is a LRU cache. Because generating a SSL certificate
1882 dynamically is expensive, they are cached. The default cache size is set to
1883 1000 entries.
1884
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +01001885tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size <number>
1886 Sets the maximum size of the buffer used for capturing client-hello cipher
1887 list. If the value is 0 (default value) the capture is disabled, otherwise
1888 a buffer is allocated for each SSL/TLS connection.
1889
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001890tune.vars.global-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01001891tune.vars.proc-max-size <size>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001892tune.vars.reqres-max-size <size>
1893tune.vars.sess-max-size <size>
1894tune.vars.txn-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01001895 These five tunes help to manage the maximum amount of memory used by the
1896 variables system. "global" limits the overall amount of memory available for
1897 all scopes. "proc" limits the memory for the process scope, "sess" limits the
1898 memory for the session scope, "txn" for the transaction scope, and "reqres"
1899 limits the memory for each request or response processing.
1900 Memory accounting is hierarchical, meaning more coarse grained limits include
1901 the finer grained ones: "proc" includes "sess", "sess" includes "txn", and
1902 "txn" includes "reqres".
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001903
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01001904 For example, when "tune.vars.sess-max-size" is limited to 100,
1905 "tune.vars.txn-max-size" and "tune.vars.reqres-max-size" cannot exceed
1906 100 either. If we create a variable "txn.var" that contains 100 bytes,
1907 all available space is consumed.
1908 Notice that exceeding the limits at runtime will not result in an error
1909 message, but values might be cut off or corrupted. So make sure to accurately
1910 plan for the amount of space needed to store all your variables.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001911
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001912tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
1913 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001914 defines how much memory should be allocated for the internal compression
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001915 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001916 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001917 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
1918
1919tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
1920 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
1921 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001922 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
1923 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001924
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020019253.3. Debugging
1926--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001927
1928debug
1929 Enables debug mode which dumps to stdout all exchanges, and disables forking
1930 into background. It is the equivalent of the command-line argument "-d". It
1931 should never be used in a production configuration since it may prevent full
1932 system startup.
1933
1934quiet
1935 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
1936 line argument "-q".
1937
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001938
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010019393.4. Userlists
1940--------------
1941It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
1942http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
1943it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
1944
1945userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001946 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001947 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
1948
1949group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001950 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001951 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
1952 proceeded by "users" keyword.
1953
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001954user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
1955 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001956 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
1957 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01001958 evaluated using the crypt(3) function, so depending on the system's
1959 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example, modern Glibc
1960 based Linux systems support MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512, and, of course, the
1961 classic DES-based method of encrypting passwords.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001962
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01001963 Attention: Be aware that using encrypted passwords might cause significantly
1964 increased CPU usage, depending on the number of requests, and the algorithm
1965 used. For any of the hashed variants, the password for each request must
1966 be processed through the chosen algorithm, before it can be compared to the
1967 value specified in the config file. Most current algorithms are deliberately
1968 designed to be expensive to compute to achieve resistance against brute
1969 force attacks. They do not simply salt/hash the clear text password once,
1970 but thousands of times. This can quickly become a major factor in haproxy's
1971 overall CPU consumption!
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001972
1973 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001974 userlist L1
1975 group G1 users tiger,scott
1976 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001977
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001978 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
1979 user scott insecure-password elgato
1980 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001981
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001982 userlist L2
1983 group G1
1984 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001985
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001986 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
1987 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
1988 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001989
1990 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001991
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001992
19933.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001994----------
Emeric Brun94900952015-06-11 18:25:54 +02001995It is possible to propagate entries of any data-types in stick-tables between
1996several haproxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each
1997instance pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. The pushed
1998values overwrite remote ones without aggregation. Interrupted exchanges are
1999automatically detected and recovered from the last known point.
2000In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to the new one
2001using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new process
2002tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication during a
2003reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large tables.
2004Note that Server IDs are used to identify servers remotely, so it is important
2005that configurations look similar or at least that the same IDs are forced on
2006each server on all participants.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002007
2008peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002009 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002010 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
2011
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002012bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
2013 Defines the binding parameters of the local peer of this "peers" section.
2014 Such lines are not supported with "peer" line in the same "peers" section.
2015
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02002016disabled
2017 Disables a peers section. It disables both listening and any synchronization
2018 related to this section. This is provided to disable synchronization of stick
2019 tables without having to comment out all "peers" references.
2020
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002021default-bind [param*]
2022 Defines the binding parameters for the local peer, excepted its address.
2023
2024default-server [param*]
2025 Change default options for a server in a "peers" section.
2026
2027 Arguments:
2028 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
2029 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
2030 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
2031 details.
2032
2033
2034 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
2035
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02002036enable
2037 This re-enables a disabled peers section which was previously disabled.
2038
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002039peer <peername> <ip>:<port> [param*]
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002040 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
2041 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
2042 using "-L" command line option), haproxy will listen for incoming remote peer
2043 connection on <ip>:<port>. Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to
2044 to join the remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to
2045 identify and validate the remote peer on the server side.
2046
2047 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
2048 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
2049
2050 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
2051 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument to change the local
2052 peer name. This makes it easier to maintain coherent configuration files
2053 across all peers.
2054
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002055 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
2056 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002057
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002058 Note: "peer" keyword may transparently be replaced by "server" keyword (see
2059 "server" keyword explanation below).
2060
2061server <peername> [<ip>:<port>] [param*]
2062 As previously mentionned, "peer" keyword may be replaced by "server" keyword
2063 with a support for all "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph.
2064 If the underlying peer is local, <ip>:<port> parameters must not be present.
2065 These parameters must be provided on a "bind" line (see "bind" keyword
2066 of this "peers" section).
2067 Some of these parameters are irrelevant for "peers" sections.
2068
2069
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002070 Example:
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002071 # The old way.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002072 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01002073 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
2074 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
2075 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002076
2077 backend mybackend
2078 mode tcp
2079 balance roundrobin
2080 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
2081 stick on src
2082
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01002083 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
2084 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002085
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002086 Example:
2087 peers mypeers
2088 bind 127.0.0.11:10001 ssl crt mycerts/pem
2089 default-server ssl verify none
2090 server hostA 127.0.0.10:10000
2091 server hostB #local peer
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002092
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01002093
2094table <tablename> type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
2095 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [store <data_type>]*
2096
2097 Configure a stickiness table for the current section. This line is parsed
2098 exactly the same way as the "stick-table" keyword in others section, except
2099 for the "peers" argument which is not required here and with an aditionnal
2100 mandatory first parameter to designate the stick-table. Contrary to others
2101 sections, there may be several "table" lines in "peers" sections (see also
2102 "stick-table" keyword).
2103
2104 Also be aware of the fact that "peers" sections have their own stick-table
2105 namespaces to avoid collisions between stick-table names identical in
2106 different "peers" section. This is internally handled prepending the "peers"
2107 sections names to the name of the stick-tables followed by a '/' character.
2108 If somewhere else in the configuration file you have to refer to such
2109 stick-tables declared in "peers" sections you must use the prefixed version
2110 of the stick-table name as follows:
2111
2112 peers mypeers
2113 peer A ...
2114 peer B ...
2115 table t1 ...
2116
2117 frontend fe1
2118 tcp-request content track-sc0 src table mypeers/t1
2119
2120 This is also this prefixed version of the stick-table names which must be
2121 used to refer to stick-tables through the CLI.
2122
2123 About "peers" protocol, as only "peers" belonging to the same section may
2124 communicate with each others, there is no need to do such a distinction.
2125 Several "peers" sections may declare stick-tables with the same name.
2126 This is shorter version of the stick-table name which is sent over the network.
2127 There is only a '/' character as prefix to avoid stick-table name collisions between
2128 stick-tables declared as backends and stick-table declared in "peers" sections
2129 as follows in this weird but supported configuration:
2130
2131 peers mypeers
2132 peer A ...
2133 peer B ...
2134 table t1 type string size 10m store gpc0
2135
2136 backend t1
2137 stick-table type string size 10m store gpc0 peers mypeers
2138
2139 Here "t1" table declared in "mypeeers" section has "mypeers/t1" as global name.
2140 "t1" table declared as a backend as "t1" as global name. But at peer protocol
2141 level the former table is named "/t1", the latter is again named "t1".
2142
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +090021433.6. Mailers
2144------------
2145It is possible to send email alerts when the state of servers changes.
2146If configured email alerts are sent to each mailer that is configured
2147in a mailers section. Email is sent to mailers using SMTP.
2148
Pieter Baauw386a1272015-08-16 15:26:24 +02002149mailers <mailersect>
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002150 Creates a new mailer list with the name <mailersect>. It is an
2151 independent section which is referenced by one or more proxies.
2152
2153mailer <mailername> <ip>:<port>
2154 Defines a mailer inside a mailers section.
2155
2156 Example:
2157 mailers mymailers
2158 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
2159 mailer smtp2 192.168.0.2:587
2160
2161 backend mybackend
2162 mode tcp
2163 balance roundrobin
2164
2165 email-alert mailers mymailers
2166 email-alert from test1@horms.org
2167 email-alert to test2@horms.org
2168
2169 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
2170 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
2171
Pieter Baauw235fcfc2016-02-13 15:33:40 +01002172timeout mail <time>
2173 Defines the time available for a mail/connection to be made and send to
2174 the mail-server. If not defined the default value is 10 seconds. To allow
2175 for at least two SYN-ACK packets to be send during initial TCP handshake it
2176 is advised to keep this value above 4 seconds.
2177
2178 Example:
2179 mailers mymailers
2180 timeout mail 20s
2181 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002182
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020021834. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002184----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002185
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002186Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
William Lallemand6e62fb62015-04-28 16:55:23 +02002187 - defaults [<name>]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002188 - frontend <name>
2189 - backend <name>
2190 - listen <name>
2191
2192A "defaults" section sets default parameters for all other sections following
2193its declaration. Those default parameters are reset by the next "defaults"
2194section. See below for the list of parameters which can be set in a "defaults"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002195section. The name is optional but its use is encouraged for better readability.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002196
2197A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
2198connections.
2199
2200A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
2201to forward incoming connections.
2202
2203A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
2204parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
2205
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002206All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
2207'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
2208case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
2209
2210Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
2211logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
2212proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
2213However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
2214name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
2215
2216Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
2217and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002218bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002219protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
2220modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
2221arbitrary criteria.
2222
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002223In HTTP mode, the processing applied to requests and responses flowing over
2224a connection depends in the combination of the frontend's HTTP options and
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002225the backend's. HAProxy supports 4 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002226
2227 - KAL : keep alive ("option http-keep-alive") which is the default mode : all
2228 requests and responses are processed, and connections remain open but idle
2229 between responses and new requests.
2230
2231 - TUN: tunnel ("option http-tunnel") : this was the default mode for versions
2232 1.0 to 1.5-dev21 : only the first request and response are processed, and
2233 everything else is forwarded with no analysis at all. This mode should not
Christopher Faulet6c9bbb22019-03-26 21:37:23 +01002234 be used as it creates lots of trouble with logging and HTTP processing.
2235 And because it cannot work in HTTP/2, this option is deprecated and it is
2236 only supported on legacy HTTP frontends. In HTX, it is ignored and a
2237 warning is emitted during HAProxy startup.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002238
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002239 - SCL: server close ("option http-server-close") : the server-facing
2240 connection is closed after the end of the response is received, but the
2241 client-facing connection remains open.
2242
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002243 - CLO: close ("option httpclose"): the connection is closed after the end of
2244 the response and "Connection: close" appended in both directions.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002245
2246The effective mode that will be applied to a connection passing through a
2247frontend and a backend can be determined by both proxy modes according to the
2248following matrix, but in short, the modes are symmetric, keep-alive is the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002249weakest option and close is the strongest.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002250
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002251 Backend mode
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002252
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002253 | KAL | SCL | CLO
2254 ----+-----+-----+----
2255 KAL | KAL | SCL | CLO
2256 ----+-----+-----+----
2257 TUN | TUN | SCL | CLO
2258 Frontend ----+-----+-----+----
2259 mode SCL | SCL | SCL | CLO
2260 ----+-----+-----+----
2261 CLO | CLO | CLO | CLO
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002262
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002263
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002264
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020022654.1. Proxy keywords matrix
2266--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002267
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002268The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
2269limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
2270they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
2271limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002272marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, e.g. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002273option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +02002274and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
2275with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
2276specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002277
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002278
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002279 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
2280------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
2281acl - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002282backlog X X X -
2283balance X - X X
2284bind - X X -
2285bind-process X X X X
Jarno Huuskonen8c8c3492016-12-28 18:50:29 +02002286block (deprecated) - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002287capture cookie - X X -
2288capture request header - X X -
2289capture response header - X X -
2290clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002291compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002292contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
2293cookie X - X X
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02002294declare capture - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002295default-server X - X X
2296default_backend X X X -
2297description - X X X
2298disabled X X X X
2299dispatch - - X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002300email-alert from X X X X
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09002301email-alert level X X X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002302email-alert mailers X X X X
2303email-alert myhostname X X X X
2304email-alert to X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002305enabled X X X X
2306errorfile X X X X
2307errorloc X X X X
2308errorloc302 X X X X
2309-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2310errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01002311force-persist - - X X
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02002312filter - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002313fullconn X - X X
2314grace X X X X
2315hash-type X - X X
2316http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002317http-check expect - - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02002318http-check send-state X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002319http-request - X X X
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02002320http-response - X X X
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02002321http-reuse X - X X
Baptiste Assmann2c42ef52013-10-09 21:57:02 +02002322http-send-name-header - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002323id - X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01002324ignore-persist - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02002325load-server-state-from-file X - X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02002326log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01002327log-format X X X -
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02002328log-format-sd X X X -
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01002329log-tag X X X X
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02002330max-keep-alive-queue X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002331maxconn X X X -
2332mode X X X X
2333monitor fail - X X -
2334monitor-net X X X -
2335monitor-uri X X X -
2336option abortonclose (*) X - X X
2337option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
2338option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
2339option allbackups (*) X - X X
2340option checkcache (*) X - X X
2341option clitcpka (*) X X X -
2342option contstats (*) X X X -
2343option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
2344option dontlognull (*) X X X -
Tim Duesterhus44864ac2019-05-06 01:19:53 +02002345option forceclose (deprecated) (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002346-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2347option forwardfor X X X X
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02002348option http-buffer-request (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau82649f92015-05-01 22:40:51 +02002349option http-ignore-probes (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01002350option http-keep-alive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02002351option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02002352option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002353option http-server-close (*) X X X X
Christopher Faulet6c9bbb22019-03-26 21:37:23 +01002354option http-tunnel (deprecated) (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002355option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau68ad3a42018-10-22 11:49:15 +02002356option http-use-htx (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002357option httpchk X - X X
2358option httpclose (*) X X X X
Freddy Spierenburge88b7732019-03-25 14:35:17 +01002359option httplog X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002360option http_proxy (*) X X X X
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002361option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02002362option ldap-check X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09002363option external-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002364option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
2365option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
2366option logasap (*) X X X -
2367option mysql-check X - X X
2368option nolinger (*) X X X X
2369option originalto X X X X
2370option persist (*) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann809e22a2015-10-12 20:22:55 +02002371option pgsql-check X - X X
2372option prefer-last-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002373option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02002374option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002375option smtpchk X - X X
2376option socket-stats (*) X X X -
2377option splice-auto (*) X X X X
2378option splice-request (*) X X X X
2379option splice-response (*) X X X X
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01002380option spop-check - - - X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002381option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
2382option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
2383-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01002384option tcp-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002385option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
2386option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
2387option tcpka X X X X
2388option tcplog X X X X
2389option transparent (*) X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09002390external-check command X - X X
2391external-check path X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002392persist rdp-cookie X - X X
2393rate-limit sessions X X X -
2394redirect - X X X
2395redisp (deprecated) X - X X
2396redispatch (deprecated) X - X X
2397reqadd - X X X
2398reqallow - X X X
2399reqdel - X X X
2400reqdeny - X X X
2401reqiallow - X X X
2402reqidel - X X X
2403reqideny - X X X
2404reqipass - X X X
2405reqirep - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002406reqitarpit - X X X
2407reqpass - X X X
2408reqrep - X X X
2409-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002410reqtarpit - X X X
2411retries X - X X
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02002412retry-on X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002413rspadd - X X X
2414rspdel - X X X
2415rspdeny - X X X
2416rspidel - X X X
2417rspideny - X X X
2418rspirep - X X X
2419rsprep - X X X
2420server - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02002421server-state-file-name X - X X
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02002422server-template - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002423source X - X X
2424srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann5a549212015-10-12 20:30:24 +02002425stats admin - X X X
2426stats auth X X X X
2427stats enable X X X X
2428stats hide-version X X X X
2429stats http-request - X X X
2430stats realm X X X X
2431stats refresh X X X X
2432stats scope X X X X
2433stats show-desc X X X X
2434stats show-legends X X X X
2435stats show-node X X X X
2436stats uri X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002437-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2438stick match - - X X
2439stick on - - X X
2440stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02002441stick store-response - - X X
Adam Spiers68af3c12017-04-06 16:31:39 +01002442stick-table - X X X
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02002443tcp-check connect - - X X
2444tcp-check expect - - X X
2445tcp-check send - - X X
2446tcp-check send-binary - - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02002447tcp-request connection - X X -
2448tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02002449tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02002450tcp-request session - X X -
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02002451tcp-response content - - X X
2452tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002453timeout check X - X X
2454timeout client X X X -
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02002455timeout client-fin X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002456timeout clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
2457timeout connect X - X X
2458timeout contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
2459timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
2460timeout http-request X X X X
2461timeout queue X - X X
2462timeout server X - X X
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02002463timeout server-fin X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002464timeout srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
2465timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02002466timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002467transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01002468unique-id-format X X X -
2469unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002470use_backend - X X -
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02002471use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002472------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
2473 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002474
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002475
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020024764.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
2477---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002478
2479This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
2480
2481
2482acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
2483 Declare or complete an access list.
2484 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2485 no | yes | yes | yes
2486 Example:
2487 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
2488 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
2489 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
2490
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002491 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002492
2493
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01002494backlog <conns>
2495 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
2496 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2497 yes | yes | yes | no
2498 Arguments :
2499 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
2500 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002501 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01002502
2503 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
2504 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
2505 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
2506 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
2507 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
2508 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
2509 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
2510 backlog parameter.
2511
2512 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
2513 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
2514 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
2515
2516 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
2517
2518
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002519balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002520balance url_param <param> [check_post]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002521 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
2522 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2523 yes | no | yes | yes
2524 Arguments :
2525 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
2526 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
2527 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
2528 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
2529
2530 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
2531 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
2532 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
2533 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02002534 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
Godbacha34bdc02013-07-22 07:44:53 +08002535 design to 4095 active servers per backend. Note that in some
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02002536 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
2537 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
2538 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
2539 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
2540 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
2541 it, so that you don't worry.
2542
2543 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
2544 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
2545 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
2546 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
2547 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
2548 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
2549 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
2550 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002551
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01002552 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
2553 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
2554 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
2555 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
2556 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
2557 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
2558 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
2559 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance.
2560
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002561 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002562 connection. The servers are chosen from the lowest numeric
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002563 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
2564 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02002565 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002566 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
2567 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
2568 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
2569 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
2570 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02002571 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
2572 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
2573 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
2574 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
2575 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
2576 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002577
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002578 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
2579 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
2580 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
2581 address will always reach the same server as long as no
2582 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
2583 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
2584 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
2585 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002586 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002587 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002588 static by default, which means that changing a server's
2589 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
2590 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002591
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01002592 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
2593 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
2594 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
2595 the running servers. The result designates which server will
2596 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
2597 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
2598 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
2599 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
2600 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
2601 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2602 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2603 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002604
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01002605 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02002606 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
2607 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
2608 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
2609 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
2610 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
2611 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
2612 URIs start with a leading "/".
2613
2614 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
2615 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
2616 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
2617 evaluation stops when either is reached.
2618
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002619 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002620 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
2621
2622 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002623 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
2624 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002625 ('?') in the URL. The message body will only start to be
2626 analyzed once either the advertised amount of data has been
2627 received or the request buffer is full. In the unlikely event
2628 that chunked encoding is used, only the first chunk is
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002629 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002630 be randomly balanced if at all. This keyword used to support
2631 an optional <max_wait> parameter which is now ignored.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002632
2633 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
2634 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
2635 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
2636 server will receive the request.
2637
2638 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
2639 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
2640 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
2641 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
2642 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002643 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
2644 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
2645 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002646
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002647 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
2648 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
2649 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
2650 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
2651 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002652
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002653 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002654 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
2655 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
2656 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
2657
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002658 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2659 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2660 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
2661
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01002662 random
2663 random(<draws>)
2664 A random number will be used as the key for the consistent
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02002665 hashing function. This means that the servers' weights are
2666 respected, dynamic weight changes immediately take effect, as
2667 well as new server additions. Random load balancing can be
2668 useful with large farms or when servers are frequently added
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01002669 or removed as it may avoid the hammering effect that could
2670 result from roundrobin or leastconn in this situation. The
2671 hash-balance-factor directive can be used to further improve
2672 fairness of the load balancing, especially in situations
2673 where servers show highly variable response times. When an
2674 argument <draws> is present, it must be an integer value one
2675 or greater, indicating the number of draws before selecting
2676 the least loaded of these servers. It was indeed demonstrated
2677 that picking the least loaded of two servers is enough to
2678 significantly improve the fairness of the algorithm, by
2679 always avoiding to pick the most loaded server within a farm
2680 and getting rid of any bias that could be induced by the
2681 unfair distribution of the consistent list. Higher values N
2682 will take away N-1 of the highest loaded servers at the
2683 expense of performance. With very high values, the algorithm
2684 will converge towards the leastconn's result but much slower.
2685 The default value is 2, which generally shows very good
2686 distribution and performance. This algorithm is also known as
2687 the Power of Two Random Choices and is described here :
2688 http://www.eecs.harvard.edu/~michaelm/postscripts/handbook2001.pdf
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02002689
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002690 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02002691 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002692 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
2693 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
2694 with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
2695 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
2696 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
2697 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002698 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002699 used instead.
2700
2701 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
2702 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
2703 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
2704 a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
2705
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002706 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2707 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2708 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
2709
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002710 See also the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09002711
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002712 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02002713 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
2714 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002715
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01002716 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
2717 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
2718 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002719
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02002720 With authentication schemes that require the same connection like NTLM, URI
2721 based alghoritms must not be used, as they would cause subsequent requests
2722 to be routed to different backend servers, breaking the invalid assumptions
2723 NTLM relies on.
2724
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002725 Examples :
2726 balance roundrobin
2727 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002728 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002729 balance hdr(User-Agent)
2730 balance hdr(host)
2731 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002732
2733 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
2734 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
2735
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002736 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002737 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
2738 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
2739 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
2740 the body. (see acl reqideny http_end)
2741
2742 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
2743 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
2744 defaults to 16 kB.
2745
2746 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
2747 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
2748
2749 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
2750 Round Robin.
2751
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00002752 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC7230 3.3.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002753 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
2754 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
2755 actually appeared in the first chunk).
2756
2757 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
2758
2759 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002760 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002761 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
2762 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
2763 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002764
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02002765 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "transparent", "hash-type" and "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002766
2767
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002768bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
2769bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002770 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
2771 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2772 no | yes | yes | no
2773 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01002774 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
2775 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
2776 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
2777 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01002778 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01002779 Optionally, an address family prefix may be used before the
2780 address to force the family regardless of the address format,
2781 which can be useful to specify a path to a unix socket with
2782 no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
2783 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
2784 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
2785 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreau70f72e02014-07-08 00:37:50 +02002786 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only).
2787 Note: since abstract sockets are not "rebindable", they
2788 do not cope well with multi-process mode during
2789 soft-restart, so it is better to avoid them if
2790 nbproc is greater than 1. The effect is that if the
2791 new process fails to start, only one of the old ones
2792 will be able to rebind to the socket.
Willy Tarreau40aa0702013-03-10 23:51:38 +01002793 - 'fd@<n>' -> use file descriptor <n> inherited from the
2794 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already
2795 be listening.
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +02002796 - 'sockpair@<n>'-> like fd@ but you must use the fd of a
2797 connected unix socket or of a socketpair. The bind waits
2798 to receive a FD over the unix socket and uses it as if it
2799 was the FD of an accept(). Should be used carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002800 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
2801 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
2802 variables.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01002803
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002804 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
2805 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002806 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
2807 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
2808 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002809 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
2810 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
2811 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
2812 the range.
2813
2814 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
2815 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
2816 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
2817 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
2818 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
2819 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
2820 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002821 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002822 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002823
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002824 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002825 alternative to the TCP listening port. HAProxy will then
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002826 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
2827 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
2828 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
2829 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
2830 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
2831 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
2832
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002833 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
2834 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
2835 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
2836 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002837
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002838 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
2839 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
2840 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
2841 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
2842 in a frontend.
2843
2844 Example :
2845 listen http_proxy
2846 bind :80,:443
2847 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002848 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002849
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002850 listen http_https_proxy
2851 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02002852 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002853
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01002854 listen http_https_proxy_explicit
2855 bind ipv6@:80
2856 bind ipv4@public_ssl:443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
2857 bind unix@ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
2858
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002859 listen external_bind_app1
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002860 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002861
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02002862 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
2863 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
2864 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
2865 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
2866 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
2867
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002868 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002869 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002870
2871
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01002872bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[<process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002873 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
2874 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2875 yes | yes | yes | yes
2876 Arguments :
2877 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
2878 may be used to override a default value.
2879
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002880 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...63. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002881 option may be combined with other numbers.
2882
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002883 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...64. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002884 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
2885 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
2886 missing from all processes.
2887
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01002888 process_num The instance will be enabled on this process number or range,
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002889 whose values must all be between 1 and 32 or 64 depending on
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01002890 the machine's word size. Ranges can be partially defined. The
2891 higher bound can be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by
2892 the corresponding maximum value. If a proxy is bound to
2893 process numbers greater than the configured global.nbproc, it
2894 will either be forced to process #1 if a single process was
Willy Tarreau102df612014-05-07 23:56:38 +02002895 specified, or to all processes otherwise.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002896
2897 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
2898 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
2899 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
2900 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
2901 and 'even' instances.
2902
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002903 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 or 64 processes
2904 using this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups.
2905 Please note that 'all' really means all processes regardless of the machine's
2906 word size, and is not limited to the first 32 or 64.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002907
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02002908 Each "bind" line may further be limited to a subset of the proxy's processes,
2909 please consult the "process" bind keyword in section 5.1.
2910
Willy Tarreaub369a042014-09-16 13:21:03 +02002911 When a frontend has no explicit "bind-process" line, it tries to bind to all
2912 the processes referenced by its "bind" lines. That means that frontends can
2913 easily adapt to their listeners' processes.
2914
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002915 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
2916 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
2917
2918 Example :
2919 listen app_ip1
2920 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02002921 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002922
2923 listen app_ip2
2924 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02002925 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002926
2927 listen management
2928 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02002929 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002930
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01002931 listen management
2932 bind 10.0.0.4:80
2933 bind-process 1-4
2934
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02002935 See also : "nbproc" in global section, and "process" in section 5.1.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002936
2937
Jarno Huuskonen8c8c3492016-12-28 18:50:29 +02002938block { if | unless } <condition> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002939 Block a layer 7 request if/unless a condition is matched
2940 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2941 no | yes | yes | yes
2942
2943 The HTTP request will be blocked very early in the layer 7 processing
2944 if/unless <condition> is matched. A 403 error will be returned if the request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002945 is blocked. The condition has to reference ACLs (see section 7). This is
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02002946 typically used to deny access to certain sensitive resources if some
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002947 conditions are met or not met. There is no fixed limit to the number of
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +03002948 "block" statements per instance. To block connections at layer 4 (without
2949 sending a 403 error) see "tcp-request connection reject" and
2950 "tcp-request content reject" rules.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002951
Jarno Huuskonen8c8c3492016-12-28 18:50:29 +02002952 This form is deprecated, do not use it in any new configuration, use the new
2953 "http-request deny" instead.
2954
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002955 Example:
2956 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
2957 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
2958 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +03002959 # block is deprecated. Use http-request deny instead:
2960 #block if invalid_src || local_dst
2961 http-request deny if invalid_src || local_dst
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002962
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +03002963 See also : section 7 about ACL usage, "http-request deny",
2964 "http-response deny", "tcp-request connection reject" and
2965 "tcp-request content reject".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002966
2967capture cookie <name> len <length>
2968 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
2969 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2970 no | yes | yes | no
2971 Arguments :
2972 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
2973 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
2974 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
2975 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002976 and value (e.g. ASPSESSIONXXX).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002977
2978 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
2979 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
2980 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
2981 right if it exceeds <length>.
2982
2983 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
2984 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
2985 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
2986 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
2987
2988 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
2989 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
2990 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
2991
2992 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
2993 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
2994 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01002995 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is set
2996 by the global "tune.http.cookielen" setting and defaults to 63 characters. It
2997 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002998
2999 Example:
3000 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
3001
3002 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003003 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003004
3005
3006capture request header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003007 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified request header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003008 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3009 no | yes | yes | no
3010 Arguments :
3011 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003012 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003013 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
3014 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
3015 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
3016
3017 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
3018 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
3019 it exceeds <length>.
3020
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003021 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003022 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
3023 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003024 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
3025 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
3026 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
3027 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003028 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003029 environments to find where the request came from.
3030
3031 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
3032 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
3033 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
3034 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003035
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01003036 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers nor to their
3037 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
3038 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
3039 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
3040 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003041
3042 Example:
3043 capture request header Host len 15
3044 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
Cyril Bontéd1b0f7c2015-10-26 22:37:39 +01003045 capture request header Referer len 15
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003046
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003047 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003048 about logging.
3049
3050
3051capture response header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003052 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified response header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003053 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3054 no | yes | yes | no
3055 Arguments :
3056 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003057 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003058 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
3059 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
3060 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
3061
3062 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
3063 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
3064 it exceeds <length>.
3065
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003066 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003067 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
3068 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
3069 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003070 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
3071 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
3072 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
3073 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003074
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01003075 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers nor to their
3076 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
3077 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
3078 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
3079 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003080
3081 Example:
3082 capture response header Content-length len 9
3083 capture response header Location len 15
3084
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003085 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003086 about logging.
3087
3088
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003089clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003090 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
3091 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3092 yes | yes | yes | no
3093 Arguments :
3094 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
3095 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
3096 as explained at the top of this document.
3097
3098 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
3099 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
3100 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
3101 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
3102 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
3103 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
3104 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
3105 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003106 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003107 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003108 (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003109
3110 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
3111 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
3112 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
3113 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
3114 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
3115 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
3116
3117 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
3118 Please use "timeout client" instead.
3119
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01003120 See also : "timeout client", "timeout http-request", "timeout server", and
3121 "srvtimeout".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003122
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003123compression algo <algorithm> ...
3124compression type <mime type> ...
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02003125compression offload
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003126 Enable HTTP compression.
3127 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3128 yes | yes | yes | yes
3129 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003130 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms.
3131 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed.
3132 offload makes haproxy work as a compression offloader only (see notes).
3133
3134 The currently supported algorithms are :
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003135 identity this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developing
3136 the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
3137 data.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003138
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003139 gzip applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01003140 support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003141
3142 deflate same as "gzip", but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
3143 Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many
3144 browsers and no support at all from recent ones. It is
3145 strongly recommended not to use it for anything else than
3146 experimentation. This setting is only available when support
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01003147 for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003148
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003149 raw-deflate same as "deflate" without the zlib wrapper, and used as an
3150 alternative when the browser wants "deflate". All major
3151 browsers understand it and despite violating the standards,
3152 it is known to work better than "deflate", at least on MSIE
3153 and some versions of Safari. Do not use it in conjunction
3154 with "deflate", use either one or the other since both react
3155 to the same Accept-Encoding token. This setting is only
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01003156 available when support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003157
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04003158 Compression will be activated depending on the Accept-Encoding request
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003159 header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04003160 If backend servers support HTTP compression, these directives
3161 will be no-op: haproxy will see the compressed response and will not
3162 compress again. If backend servers do not support HTTP compression and
3163 there is Accept-Encoding header in request, haproxy will compress the
3164 matching response.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02003165
3166 The "offload" setting makes haproxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
3167 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
3168 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
3169 will be done on the single point where haproxy is located. However in some
3170 deployment scenarios, haproxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04003171 with broken HTTP compression implementation which can't be turned off.
3172 In that case haproxy can be used to prevent that gateway from emitting
3173 invalid payloads. In this case, simply removing the header in the
3174 configuration does not work because it applies before the header is parsed,
3175 so that prevents haproxy from compressing. The "offload" setting should
Willy Tarreauffea9fd2014-07-12 16:37:02 +02003176 then be used for such scenarios. Note: for now, the "offload" setting is
3177 ignored when set in a defaults section.
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003178
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01003179 Compression is disabled when:
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01003180 * the request does not advertise a supported compression algorithm in the
3181 "Accept-Encoding" header
3182 * the response message is not HTTP/1.1
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01003183 * HTTP status code is not one of 200, 201, 202, or 203
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01003184 * response contain neither a "Content-Length" header nor a
3185 "Transfer-Encoding" whose last value is "chunked"
3186 * response contains a "Content-Type" header whose first value starts with
3187 "multipart"
3188 * the response contains the "no-transform" value in the "Cache-control"
3189 header
3190 * User-Agent matches "Mozilla/4" unless it is MSIE 6 with XP SP2, or MSIE 7
3191 and later
3192 * The response contains a "Content-Encoding" header, indicating that the
3193 response is already compressed (see compression offload)
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01003194 * The response contains an invalid "ETag" header or multiple ETag headers
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01003195
Tim Duesterhusb229f012019-01-29 16:38:56 +01003196 Note: The compression does not emit the Warning header.
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01003197
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003198 Examples :
3199 compression algo gzip
3200 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003201
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003202
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003203contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003204 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
3205 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3206 yes | no | yes | yes
3207 Arguments :
3208 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
3209 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
3210 as explained at the top of this document.
3211
3212 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003213 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003214 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003215 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003216 connect timeout also presets the queue timeout to the same value if this one
3217 has not been specified. Historically, the contimeout was also used to set the
3218 tarpit timeout in a listen section, which is not possible in a pure frontend.
3219
3220 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
3221 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
3222 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
3223 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
3224 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
3225 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
3226
3227 This parameter is provided for backwards compatibility but is currently
3228 deprecated. Please use "timeout connect", "timeout queue" or "timeout tarpit"
3229 instead.
3230
3231 See also : "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout tarpit",
3232 "timeout server", "contimeout".
3233
3234
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003235cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02003236 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
3237 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003238 [ dynamic ]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003239 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
3240 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3241 yes | no | yes | yes
3242 Arguments :
3243 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
3244 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
3245 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
3246 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
3247 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
3248 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003249 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (e.g.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003250 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
3251 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
3252
3253 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
3254 server and that haproxy will have to modify its value to set the
3255 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
3256 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
3257 headers is left to the application. The application can then
3258 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003259 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode
3260 doesn't work in HTTP tunnel mode. Unless the application
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003261 behavior is very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003262 start with this mode for new deployments. This keyword is
3263 incompatible with "insert" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003264
3265 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003266 be inserted by haproxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003267
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003268 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003269 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
3270 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be remove before
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003271 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003272 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
3273 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
3274 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
3275 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
3276 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
3277 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
3278 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003279
3280 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
3281 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
3282 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
3283 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
3284 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
3285 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
3286 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
3287 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
3288 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003289 this mode doesn't work with tunnel mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02003290 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
3291 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
3292 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003293
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003294 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
3295 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
3296 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003297 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
3298 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
3299 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
3300 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02003301 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
3302 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
3303 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003304
3305 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
3306 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
3307 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
3308 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
3309 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
3310 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
3311 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
3312 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
3313 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
3314
3315 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
3316 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
3317 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
3318 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
3319 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
3320 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
3321 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
3322 persistence cookie in the cache.
3323 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
3324
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003325 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
3326 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
3327 case, if a cookie is found in the response, haproxy will leave it
3328 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
3329 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003330 emit a cookie with an invalid value (e.g. empty) or with a date in
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003331 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
3332 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
3333 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
3334 they logout.
3335
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02003336 httponly This option tells haproxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
3337 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
3338 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
3339 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
3340
3341 secure This option tells haproxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
3342 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
3343 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
3344 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
3345 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
3346 this attribute.
3347
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02003348 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003349 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01003350 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
3351 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
3352 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
3353 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
3354 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
3355 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02003356
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003357 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
3358 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
3359 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
3360 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
3361 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
3362 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
3363 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
3364 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003365 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). When
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003366 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
3367 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
3368 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
3369 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
3370 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
3371 the site.
3372
3373 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
3374 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
3375 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
3376 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
3377 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
3378 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
3379 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
3380 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
3381 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
3382 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
3383 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
3384 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
3385 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003386 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). This
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003387 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
3388 redispatch after some absolute delay.
3389
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003390 dynamic Activate dynamic cookies. When used, a session cookie is
3391 dynamically created for each server, based on the IP and port
3392 of the server, and a secret key, specified in the
3393 "dynamic-cookie-key" backend directive.
3394 The cookie will be regenerated each time the IP address change,
3395 and is only generated for IPv4/IPv6.
3396
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003397 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
3398 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
3399 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
3400 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003401
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003402 Examples :
3403 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
3404 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
3405 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003406 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003407
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02003408 See also : "balance source", "capture cookie", "server" and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003409
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003410
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02003411declare capture [ request | response ] len <length>
3412 Declares a capture slot.
3413 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3414 no | yes | yes | no
3415 Arguments:
3416 <length> is the length allowed for the capture.
3417
3418 This declaration is only available in the frontend or listen section, but the
3419 reserved slot can be used in the backends. The "request" keyword allocates a
3420 capture slot for use in the request, and "response" allocates a capture slot
3421 for use in the response.
3422
3423 See also: "capture-req", "capture-res" (sample converters),
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +02003424 "capture.req.hdr", "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches),
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02003425 "http-request capture" and "http-response capture".
3426
3427
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003428default-server [param*]
3429 Change default options for a server in a backend
3430 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3431 yes | no | yes | yes
3432 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003433 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
3434 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
3435 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
3436 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003437
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003438 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003439 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
3440
3441 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003442
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003443
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003444default_backend <backend>
3445 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
3446 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3447 yes | yes | yes | no
3448 Arguments :
3449 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
3450
3451 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
3452 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
3453 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
3454 will catch all undetermined requests.
3455
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003456 Example :
3457
3458 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
3459 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
3460 default_backend dynamic
3461
Willy Tarreau98d04852015-05-26 12:18:29 +02003462 See also : "use_backend"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003463
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003464
Baptiste Assmann27f51342013-10-09 06:51:49 +02003465description <string>
3466 Describe a listen, frontend or backend.
3467 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3468 no | yes | yes | yes
3469 Arguments : string
3470
3471 Allows to add a sentence to describe the related object in the HAProxy HTML
3472 stats page. The description will be printed on the right of the object name
3473 it describes.
3474 No need to backslash spaces in the <string> arguments.
3475
3476
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003477disabled
3478 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
3479 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3480 yes | yes | yes | yes
3481 Arguments : none
3482
3483 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
3484 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
3485 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
3486 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
3487 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
3488 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
3489 keyword in a "defaults" section.
3490
3491 See also : "enabled"
3492
3493
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003494dispatch <address>:<port>
3495 Set a default server address
3496 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3497 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003498 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003499
3500 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
3501 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
3502 during start-up.
3503
3504 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
3505 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
3506 possible with normal servers.
3507
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02003508 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003509 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
3510 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
3511 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
3512 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
3513
3514 See also : "server"
3515
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003516
3517dynamic-cookie-key <string>
3518 Set the dynamic cookie secret key for a backend.
3519 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3520 yes | no | yes | yes
3521 Arguments : The secret key to be used.
3522
3523 When dynamic cookies are enabled (see the "dynamic" directive for cookie),
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003524 a dynamic cookie is created for each server (unless one is explicitly
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003525 specified on the "server" line), using a hash of the IP address of the
3526 server, the TCP port, and the secret key.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003527 That way, we can ensure session persistence across multiple load-balancers,
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003528 even if servers are dynamically added or removed.
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003529
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003530enabled
3531 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
3532 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3533 yes | yes | yes | yes
3534 Arguments : none
3535
3536 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
3537 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
3538
3539 See also : "disabled"
3540
3541
3542errorfile <code> <file>
3543 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3544 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3545 yes | yes | yes | yes
3546 Arguments :
3547 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Olivier Houchard51a76d82017-10-02 16:12:07 +02003548 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 405, 408, 425, 429, 500, 502,
3549 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003550
3551 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003552 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003553 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003554 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
3555 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003556
3557 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3558 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3559 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3560
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003561 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3562
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003563 The files are returned verbatim on the TCP socket. This allows any trick such
3564 as redirections to another URL or site, as well as tricks to clean cookies,
3565 force enable or disable caching, etc... The package provides default error
3566 files returning the same contents as default errors.
3567
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003568 The files should not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFSIZE), which
3569 generally is 8 or 16 kB, otherwise they will be truncated. It is also wise
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003570 not to put any reference to local contents (e.g. images) in order to avoid
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003571 loops between the client and HAProxy when all servers are down, causing an
3572 error to be returned instead of an image. For better HTTP compliance, it is
3573 recommended that all header lines end with CR-LF and not LF alone.
3574
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003575 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
3576 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
3577 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003578 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003579 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
3580
3581 See also : "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
3582
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003583 Example :
3584 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01003585 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003586 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
3587 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
3588
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003589
3590errorloc <code> <url>
3591errorloc302 <code> <url>
3592 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3593 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3594 yes | yes | yes | yes
3595 Arguments :
3596 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Olivier Houchard51a76d82017-10-02 16:12:07 +02003597 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 405, 408, 425, 429, 500, 502,
3598 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003599
3600 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
3601 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
3602 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
3603 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003604 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003605
3606 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3607 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3608 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3609
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003610 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3611
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003612 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
3613 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
3614 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
3615 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01003616 work around this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003617 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
3618 request.
3619
3620 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc303"
3621
3622
3623errorloc303 <code> <url>
3624 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3625 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3626 yes | yes | yes | yes
3627 Arguments :
3628 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Olivier Houchard51a76d82017-10-02 16:12:07 +02003629 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 405, 408, 425, 429, 500, 502,
3630 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003631
3632 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
3633 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
3634 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
3635 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003636 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003637
3638 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3639 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3640 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3641
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003642 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3643
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003644 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
3645 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
3646 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
3647 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003648 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003649
3650 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
3651
3652
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003653email-alert from <emailaddr>
3654 Declare the from email address to be used in both the envelope and header
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003655 of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent from.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003656 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3657 yes | yes | yes | yes
3658
3659 Arguments :
3660
3661 <emailaddr> is the from email address to use when sending email alerts
3662
3663 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
3664 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3665
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003666 See also : "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02003667 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to", section 3.6 about
3668 mailers.
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003669
3670
3671email-alert level <level>
3672 Declare the maximum log level of messages for which email alerts will be
3673 sent. This acts as a filter on the sending of email alerts.
3674 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3675 yes | yes | yes | yes
3676
3677 Arguments :
3678
3679 <level> One of the 8 syslog levels:
3680 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
3681 The above syslog levels are ordered from lowest to highest.
3682
3683 By default level is alert
3684
3685 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
3686 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
3687 for the proxy.
3688
Simon Horman1421e212015-04-30 13:10:35 +09003689 Alerts are sent when :
3690
3691 * An un-paused server is marked as down and <level> is alert or lower
3692 * A paused server is marked as down and <level> is notice or lower
3693 * A server is marked as up or enters the drain state and <level>
3694 is notice or lower
3695 * "option log-health-checks" is enabled, <level> is info or lower,
3696 and a health check status update occurs
3697
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003698 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers",
3699 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003700 section 3.6 about mailers.
3701
3702
3703email-alert mailers <mailersect>
3704 Declare the mailers to be used when sending email alerts
3705 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3706 yes | yes | yes | yes
3707
3708 Arguments :
3709
3710 <mailersect> is the name of the mailers section to send email alerts.
3711
3712 Also requires "email-alert from" and "email-alert to" to be set
3713 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3714
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003715 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert myhostname",
3716 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003717
3718
3719email-alert myhostname <hostname>
3720 Declare the to hostname address to be used when communicating with
3721 mailers.
3722 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3723 yes | yes | yes | yes
3724
3725 Arguments :
3726
Baptiste Assmann738bad92015-12-21 15:27:53 +01003727 <hostname> is the hostname to use when communicating with mailers
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003728
3729 By default the systems hostname is used.
3730
3731 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
3732 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
3733 for the proxy.
3734
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003735 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
3736 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003737
3738
3739email-alert to <emailaddr>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003740 Declare both the recipient address in the envelope and to address in the
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003741 header of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent to.
3742 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3743 yes | yes | yes | yes
3744
3745 Arguments :
3746
3747 <emailaddr> is the to email address to use when sending email alerts
3748
3749 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
3750 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3751
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003752 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003753 "email-alert myhostname", section 3.6 about mailers.
3754
3755
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003756force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
3757 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
3758 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01003759 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003760
3761 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
3762 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
3763 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
3764 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
3765 marked down for maintenance operations.
3766
3767 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
3768 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
3769 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
3770 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
3771 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
3772 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
3773 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
3774 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
3775 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
3776
3777 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
3778 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
3779 is used.
3780
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02003781 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02003782 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003783
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003784
3785filter <name> [param*]
3786 Add the filter <name> in the filter list attached to the proxy.
3787 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3788 no | yes | yes | yes
3789 Arguments :
3790 <name> is the name of the filter. Officially supported filters are
3791 referenced in section 9.
3792
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01003793 <param*> is a list of parameters accepted by the filter <name>. The
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003794 parsing of these parameters are the responsibility of the
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01003795 filter. Please refer to the documentation of the corresponding
3796 filter (section 9) for all details on the supported parameters.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003797
3798 Multiple occurrences of the filter line can be used for the same proxy. The
3799 same filter can be referenced many times if needed.
3800
3801 Example:
3802 listen
3803 bind *:80
3804
3805 filter trace name BEFORE-HTTP-COMP
3806 filter compression
3807 filter trace name AFTER-HTTP-COMP
3808
3809 compression algo gzip
3810 compression offload
3811
3812 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
3813
3814 See also : section 9.
3815
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003816
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003817fullconn <conns>
3818 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
3819 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3820 yes | no | yes | yes
3821 Arguments :
3822 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
3823 servers use the maximal number of connections.
3824
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003825 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003826 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003827 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003828 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
3829 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
3830 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
3831 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
3832 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003833 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003834
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02003835 Since it's hard to get this value right, haproxy automatically sets it to
3836 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01003837 backend (based on "use_backend" and "default_backend" rules). That way it's
3838 safe to leave it unset. However, "use_backend" involving dynamic names are
3839 not counted since there is no way to know if they could match or not.
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02003840
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003841 Example :
3842 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
3843 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
3844 # connections.
3845 backend dynamic
3846 fullconn 10000
3847 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
3848 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
3849
3850 See also : "maxconn", "server"
3851
3852
3853grace <time>
3854 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
3855 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01003856 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003857 Arguments :
3858 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
3859 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
3860 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
3861
3862 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
3863 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003864 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003865 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
3866
3867 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
3868 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
3869 simplify it.
3870
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003871
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04003872hash-balance-factor <factor>
3873 Specify the balancing factor for bounded-load consistent hashing
3874 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3875 yes | no | no | yes
3876 Arguments :
3877 <factor> is the control for the maximum number of concurrent requests to
3878 send to a server, expressed as a percentage of the average number
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01003879 of concurrent requests across all of the active servers.
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04003880
3881 Specifying a "hash-balance-factor" for a server with "hash-type consistent"
3882 enables an algorithm that prevents any one server from getting too many
3883 requests at once, even if some hash buckets receive many more requests than
3884 others. Setting <factor> to 0 (the default) disables the feature. Otherwise,
3885 <factor> is a percentage greater than 100. For example, if <factor> is 150,
3886 then no server will be allowed to have a load more than 1.5 times the average.
3887 If server weights are used, they will be respected.
3888
3889 If the first-choice server is disqualified, the algorithm will choose another
3890 server based on the request hash, until a server with additional capacity is
3891 found. A higher <factor> allows more imbalance between the servers, while a
3892 lower <factor> means that more servers will be checked on average, affecting
3893 performance. Reasonable values are from 125 to 200.
3894
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02003895 This setting is also used by "balance random" which internally relies on the
3896 consistent hashing mechanism.
3897
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04003898 See also : "balance" and "hash-type".
3899
3900
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003901hash-type <method> <function> <modifier>
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003902 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
3903 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3904 yes | no | yes | yes
3905 Arguments :
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003906 <method> is the method used to select a server from the hash computed by
3907 the <function> :
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003908
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003909 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
3910 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but
3911 will be static in that weight changes while a server is up
3912 will be ignored. This means that there will be no slow start.
3913 Also, since a server is selected by its position in the array,
3914 most mappings are changed when the server count changes. This
3915 means that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is
3916 added to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to
3917 different servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for
3918 instance.
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01003919
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003920 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
3921 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
3922 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
3923 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
3924 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
3925 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a
3926 server is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings
3927 are redistributed, making it an ideal method for caches.
3928 However, due to its principle, the distribution will never be
3929 very smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a
3930 server's weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution.
3931 In order to get the same distribution on multiple load
3932 balancers, it is important that all servers have the exact
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003933 same IDs. Note: consistent hash uses sdbm and avalanche if no
3934 hash function is specified.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003935
3936 <function> is the hash function to be used :
3937
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003938 sdbm this function was created initially for sdbm (a public-domain
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003939 reimplementation of ndbm) database library. It was found to do
3940 well in scrambling bits, causing better distribution of the keys
3941 and fewer splits. It also happens to be a good general hashing
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003942 function with good distribution, unless the total server weight
3943 is a multiple of 64, in which case applying the avalanche
3944 modifier may help.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003945
3946 djb2 this function was first proposed by Dan Bernstein many years ago
3947 on comp.lang.c. Studies have shown that for certain workload this
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003948 function provides a better distribution than sdbm. It generally
3949 works well with text-based inputs though it can perform extremely
3950 poorly with numeric-only input or when the total server weight is
3951 a multiple of 33, unless the avalanche modifier is also used.
3952
Willy Tarreaua0f42712013-11-14 14:30:35 +01003953 wt6 this function was designed for haproxy while testing other
3954 functions in the past. It is not as smooth as the other ones, but
3955 is much less sensible to the input data set or to the number of
3956 servers. It can make sense as an alternative to sdbm+avalanche or
3957 djb2+avalanche for consistent hashing or when hashing on numeric
3958 data such as a source IP address or a visitor identifier in a URL
3959 parameter.
3960
Willy Tarreau324f07f2015-01-20 19:44:50 +01003961 crc32 this is the most common CRC32 implementation as used in Ethernet,
3962 gzip, PNG, etc. It is slower than the other ones but may provide
3963 a better distribution or less predictable results especially when
3964 used on strings.
3965
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003966 <modifier> indicates an optional method applied after hashing the key :
3967
3968 avalanche This directive indicates that the result from the hash
3969 function above should not be used in its raw form but that
3970 a 4-byte full avalanche hash must be applied first. The
3971 purpose of this step is to mix the resulting bits from the
3972 previous hash in order to avoid any undesired effect when
3973 the input contains some limited values or when the number of
3974 servers is a multiple of one of the hash's components (64
3975 for SDBM, 33 for DJB2). Enabling avalanche tends to make the
3976 result less predictable, but it's also not as smooth as when
3977 using the original function. Some testing might be needed
3978 with some workloads. This hash is one of the many proposed
3979 by Bob Jenkins.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003980
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003981 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages. The
3982 default function is "sdbm", the selection of a function should be based on
3983 the range of the values being hashed.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003984
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04003985 See also : "balance", "hash-balance-factor", "server"
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003986
3987
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003988http-check disable-on-404
3989 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
3990 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003991 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003992 Arguments : none
3993
3994 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
3995 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
3996 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
3997 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
3998 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
3999 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
4000 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
4001 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004002 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
4003 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
4004 responses will still be considered as soft-stop.
4005
4006 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check expect"
4007
4008
4009http-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004010 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004011 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02004012 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004013 Arguments :
4014 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
4015 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004016 "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004017 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
4018 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
4019 details on the supported keywords.
4020
4021 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
4022 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
4023 with the usual backslash ('\').
4024
4025 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
4026 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
4027 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
4028 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
4029 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
4030
4031 status <string> : test the exact string match for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004032 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004033 response's status code is exactly this string. If the
4034 "status" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
4035 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
4036
4037 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004038 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004039 response's status code matches the expression. If the
4040 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
4041 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
4042 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
4043
4044 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004045 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004046 response's body contains this exact string. If the
4047 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
4048 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
4049 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
4050 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004051 specific error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004052 trace).
4053
4054 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004055 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004056 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
4057 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
4058 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
4059 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
4060 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004061 error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack trace).
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004062
4063 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
4064 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
4065 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
4066 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
4067 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
4068 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
4069 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
4070 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
4071
Cyril Bonté32602d22015-01-30 00:07:07 +01004072 Also "http-check expect" doesn't support HTTP keep-alive. Keep in mind that it
4073 will automatically append a "Connection: close" header, meaning that this
4074 header should not be present in the request provided by "option httpchk".
4075
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004076 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
4077 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
4078
4079 Examples :
4080 # only accept status 200 as valid
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01004081 http-check expect status 200
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004082
4083 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01004084 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004085
4086 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01004087 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004088
4089 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03004090 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*--></html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004091
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004092 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004093
4094
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01004095http-check send-state
4096 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
4097 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4098 yes | no | yes | yes
4099 Arguments : none
4100
4101 When this option is set, haproxy will systematically send a special header
4102 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
4103 how they are seen by haproxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
4104 manipulated without access to haproxy and the operator needs to know whether
4105 haproxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
4106
4107 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
4108 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
4109 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
4110 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
4111 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
Joseph Lynch514061c2015-01-15 17:52:59 -08004112 - a variable "address", containing the address of the backend server.
4113 This corresponds to the <address> field in the server declaration. For
4114 unix domain sockets, it will read "unix".
4115
4116 - a variable "port", containing the port of the backend server. This
4117 corresponds to the <port> field in the server declaration. For unix
4118 domain sockets, it will read "unix".
4119
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01004120 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
4121 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
4122 checked in multiple backends.
4123
4124 - a variable "node" containing the name of the haproxy node, as set in the
4125 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
4126
4127 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
4128 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
4129 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
4130 one fails.
4131
4132 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
4133 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
4134 connections on all servers of the same backend.
4135
4136 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
4137 server's queue.
4138
4139 Example of a header received by the application server :
4140 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
4141 scur=13/22; qcur=0
4142
4143 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
4144
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004145
4146http-request <action> [options...] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004147 Access control for Layer 7 requests
4148
4149 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4150 no | yes | yes | yes
4151
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004152 The http-request statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
4153 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
4154 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
4155 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
4156 if the condition is true.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004157
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004158 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
4159 below.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004160
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004161 There is no limit to the number of http-request statements per instance.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004162
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004163 It is important to know that http-request rules are processed very early in
4164 the HTTP processing, just after "block" rules and before "reqdel" or "reqrep"
4165 or "reqadd" rules. That way, headers added by "add-header"/"set-header" are
4166 visible by almost all further ACL rules.
Willy Tarreau53275e82017-11-24 07:52:01 +01004167
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004168 Using "reqadd"/"reqdel"/"reqrep" to manipulate request headers is discouraged
4169 in newer versions (>= 1.5). But if you need to use regular expression to
4170 delete headers, you can still use "reqdel". Also please use
4171 "http-request deny/allow/tarpit" instead of "reqdeny"/"reqpass"/"reqtarpit".
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01004172
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004173 Example:
4174 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
4175 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
4176 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004177
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004178 http-request allow if nagios
4179 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
4180 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
4181 http-request deny
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01004182
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004183 Example:
4184 acl key req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key) -m found
4185 acl add path /addacl
4186 acl del path /delacl
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004187
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004188 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004189
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004190 http-request add-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key add
4191 http-request del-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key del
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02004192
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004193 Example:
4194 acl value req.hdr(X-Value) -m found
4195 acl setmap path /setmap
4196 acl delmap path /delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004197
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004198 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004199
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004200 http-request set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[req.hdr(X-Value)] if setmap value
4201 http-request del-map(map.lst) %[src] if delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004202
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004203 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
4204 about ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004205
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004206http-request add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004207
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004208 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
4209 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
4210 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4211 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
4212 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values. This
4213 lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
4214 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
4215 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004216
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004217http-request add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004218
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004219 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and
4220 whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see
4221 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
4222 connection-specific information to the server (e.g. the client's SSL
4223 certificate), or to combine several headers into one. This rule is not
4224 final, so it is possible to add other similar rules. Note that header
4225 addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse the resulting
4226 header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004227
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004228http-request allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004229
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004230 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the request pass the check.
4231 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004232
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004233
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004234http-request auth [realm <realm>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004235
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004236 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately responds with an
4237 HTTP 401 or 407 error code to invite the user to present a valid user name
4238 and password. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated. An optional
4239 "realm" parameter is supported, it sets the authentication realm that is
4240 returned with the response (typically the application's name).
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004241
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004242 Example:
4243 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
4244 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004245
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02004246http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004247
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004248 See section 10.2 about cache setup.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004249
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004250http-request capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ]
4251 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004252
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004253 This captures sample expression <sample> from the request buffer, and
4254 converts it to a string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is
4255 stored into the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next
4256 to some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs,
4257 and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it
4258 into headers or anything. The length should be limited given that this size
4259 will be allocated for each capture during the whole session life.
4260 Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture request header" for
4261 more information.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004262
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004263 If the keyword "id" is used instead of "len", the action tries to store the
4264 captured string in a previously declared capture slot. This is useful to run
4265 captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a previous directive
4266 "http-request capture" or with the "declare capture" keyword. If the slot
4267 <id> doesn't exist, then HAProxy fails parsing the configuration to prevent
4268 unexpected behavior at run time.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004269
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004270http-request del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004271
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004272 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
4273 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
4274 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4275 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4276 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
4277 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004278
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004279http-request del-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02004280
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004281 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>.
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02004282
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004283http-request del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02004284
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004285 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
4286 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
4287 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4288 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4289 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
4290 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02004291
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004292http-request deny [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04004293
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004294 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the request
4295 and emits an HTTP 403 error, or optionally the status code specified as an
4296 argument to "deny_status". The list of permitted status codes is limited to
4297 those that can be overridden by the "errorfile" directive.
4298 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04004299
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +01004300http-request do-resolve(<var>,<resolvers>,[ipv4,ipv6]) <expr> :
4301
4302 This action performs a DNS resolution of the output of <expr> and stores
4303 the result in the variable <var>. It uses the DNS resolvers section
4304 pointed by <resolvers>.
4305 It is possible to choose a resolution preference using the optional
4306 arguments 'ipv4' or 'ipv6'.
4307 When performing the DNS resolution, the client side connection is on
4308 pause waiting till the end of the resolution.
4309 If an IP address can be found, it is stored into <var>. If any kind of
4310 error occurs, then <var> is not set.
4311 One can use this action to discover a server IP address at run time and
4312 based on information found in the request (IE a Host header).
4313 If this action is used to find the server's IP address (using the
4314 "set-dst" action), then the server IP address in the backend must be set
4315 to 0.0.0.0.
4316
4317 Example:
4318 resolvers mydns
4319 nameserver local 127.0.0.53:53
4320 nameserver google 8.8.8.8:53
4321 timeout retry 1s
4322 hold valid 10s
4323 hold nx 3s
4324 hold other 3s
4325 hold obsolete 0s
4326 accepted_payload_size 8192
4327
4328 frontend fe
4329 bind 10.42.0.1:80
4330 http-request do-resolve(txn.myip,mydns,ipv4) hdr(Host),lower
4331 http-request capture var(txn.myip) len 40
4332
4333 # return 503 when the variable is not set,
4334 # which mean DNS resolution error
4335 use_backend b_503 unless { var(txn.myip) -m found }
4336
4337 default_backend be
4338
4339 backend b_503
4340 # dummy backend used to return 503.
4341 # one can use the errorfile directive to send a nice
4342 # 503 error page to end users
4343
4344 backend be
4345 # rule to prevent HAProxy from reconnecting to services
4346 # on the local network (forged DNS name used to scan the network)
4347 http-request deny if { var(txn.myip) -m ip 127.0.0.0/8 10.0.0.0/8 }
4348 http-request set-dst var(txn.myip)
4349 server clear 0.0.0.0:0
4350
4351 NOTE: Don't forget to set the "protection" rules to ensure HAProxy won't
4352 be used to scan the network or worst won't loop over itself...
4353
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01004354http-request early-hint <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4355
4356 This is used to build an HTTP 103 Early Hints response prior to any other one.
4357 This appends an HTTP header field to this response whose name is specified in
4358 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules
4359 (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
Frédéric Lécaille3aac1062018-11-13 09:42:13 +01004360 to the client some Link headers to preload resources required to render the
4361 HTML documents.
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01004362
4363 See RFC 8297 for more information.
4364
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004365http-request redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004366
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004367 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule. This is exactly
4368 the same as the "redirect" statement except that it inserts a redirect rule
4369 which can be processed in the middle of other "http-request" rules and that
4370 these rules use the "log-format" strings. See the "redirect" keyword for the
4371 rule's syntax.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004372
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004373http-request reject [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004374
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004375 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately closes the connection
4376 without sending any response. It acts similarly to the
4377 "tcp-request content reject" rules. It can be useful to force an immediate
4378 connection closure on HTTP/2 connections.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004379
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004380http-request replace-header <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
4381 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02004382
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004383 This matches the regular expression in all occurrences of header field
4384 <name> according to <match-regex>, and replaces them with the
4385 <replace-fmt> argument. Format characters are allowed in replace-fmt and
4386 work like in <fmt> arguments in "http-request add-header". The match is
4387 only case-sensitive. It is important to understand that this action only
4388 considers whole header lines, regardless of the number of values they may
4389 contain. This usage is suited to headers naturally containing commas in
4390 their value, such as If-Modified-Since and so on.
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02004391
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004392 Example:
4393 http-request replace-header Cookie foo=([^;]*);(.*) foo=\1;ip=%bi;\2
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01004394
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004395 # applied to:
4396 Cookie: foo=foobar; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004397
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004398 # outputs:
4399 Cookie: foo=foobar;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004400
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004401 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004402
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004403http-request replace-value <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
4404 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004405
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004406 This works like "replace-header" except that it matches the regex against
4407 every comma-delimited value of the header field <name> instead of the
4408 entire header. This is suited for all headers which are allowed to carry
4409 more than one value. An example could be the Accept header.
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004410
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004411 Example:
4412 http-request replace-value X-Forwarded-For ^192\.168\.(.*)$ 172.16.\1
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02004413
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004414 # applied to:
4415 X-Forwarded-For: 192.168.10.1, 192.168.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02004416
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004417 # outputs:
4418 X-Forwarded-For: 172.16.10.1, 172.16.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01004419
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004420http-request sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4421http-request sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004422
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004423 This actions increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
4424 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
4425 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004426
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004427http-request sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004428
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004429 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated by
4430 <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If an error
4431 occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004432
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004433http-request set-dst <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004434
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004435 This is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
4436 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites destination IP,
4437 but provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask the IP for
4438 privacy. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0' as a
4439 server address in the backend.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004440
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004441 Arguments:
4442 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
4443 by some converters.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004444
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004445 Example:
4446 http-request set-dst hdr(x-dst)
4447 http-request set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004448
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004449 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as the
4450 address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004451
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004452http-request set-dst-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004453
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004454 This is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
4455 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0'
4456 as a server address in the backend.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004457
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004458 Arguments:
4459 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4460 followed by some converters.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004461
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004462 Example:
4463 http-request set-dst-port hdr(x-port)
4464 http-request set-dst-port int(4000)
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004465
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004466 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
4467 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
4468 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004469
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004470http-request set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004471
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004472 This does the same as "http-request add-header" except that the header name
4473 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
4474 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
4475 external users. Note that the new value is computed before the removal so it
4476 is possible to concatenate a value to an existing header.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004477
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004478 Example:
4479 http-request set-header X-Haproxy-Current-Date %T
4480 http-request set-header X-SSL %[ssl_fc]
4481 http-request set-header X-SSL-Session_ID %[ssl_fc_session_id,hex]
4482 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-Verify %[ssl_c_verify]
4483 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-DN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn]
4484 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-CN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn(cn)]
4485 http-request set-header X-SSL-Issuer %{+Q}[ssl_c_i_dn]
4486 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotBefore %{+Q}[ssl_c_notbefore]
4487 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotAfter %{+Q}[ssl_c_notafter]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004488
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004489http-request set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004490
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004491 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
4492 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
4493 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
4494 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule
4495 can be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004496
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004497http-request set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
4498 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004499
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004500 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
4501 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
4502 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
4503 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
4504 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
4505 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
4506 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
4507 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
4508 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004509
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004510http-request set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004511
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004512 This is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the client to
4513 the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
4514 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and by the routing
4515 table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by
4516 "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different route
4517 (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on Linux
4518 kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges.
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02004519
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004520http-request set-method <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004521
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004522 This rewrites the request method with the result of the evaluation of format
4523 string <fmt>. There should be very few valid reasons for having to do so as
4524 this is more likely to break something than to fix it.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004525
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004526http-request set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004527
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004528 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed. It only
4529 has effect against the other requests being processed at the same time.
4530 The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the "bind"
4531 line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the nicest
4532 the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important than
4533 other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
4534 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
4535 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004536
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004537http-request set-path <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02004538
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004539 This rewrites the request path with the result of the evaluation of format
4540 string <fmt>. The query string, if any, is left intact. If a scheme and
4541 authority is found before the path, they are left intact as well. If the
4542 request doesn't have a path ("*"), this one is replaced with the format.
4543 This can be used to prepend a directory component in front of a path for
4544 example. See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02004545
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004546 Example :
4547 # prepend the host name before the path
4548 http-request set-path /%[hdr(host)]%[path]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004549
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004550http-request set-priority-class <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +02004551
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004552 This is used to set the queue priority class of the current request.
4553 The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer in the
4554 range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be truncated.
4555 The priority class determines the order in which queued requests are
4556 processed. Lower values have higher priority.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004557
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004558http-request set-priority-offset <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004559
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004560 This is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset of the current
4561 request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer
4562 in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be truncated.
4563 When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority class, then by
4564 the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in milliseconds. Lower
4565 values have higher priority.
4566 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision
4567 for 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
4568 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
4569 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
4570 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004571
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004572http-request set-query <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004573
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004574 This rewrites the request's query string which appears after the first
4575 question mark ("?") with the result of the evaluation of format string <fmt>.
4576 The part prior to the question mark is left intact. If the request doesn't
4577 contain a question mark and the new value is not empty, then one is added at
4578 the end of the URI, followed by the new value. If a question mark was
4579 present, it will never be removed even if the value is empty. This can be
4580 used to add or remove parameters from the query string.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08004581
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004582 See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004583
4584 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004585 # replace "%3D" with "=" in the query string
4586 http-request set-query %[query,regsub(%3D,=,g)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004587
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004588http-request set-src <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4589 This is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
4590 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites source IP, but
4591 provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask source IP for
4592 privacy.
4593
4594 Arguments :
4595 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
4596 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004597
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01004598 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004599 http-request set-src hdr(x-forwarded-for)
4600 http-request set-src src,ipmask(24)
4601
4602 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
4603 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
4604
4605http-request set-src-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4606
4607 This is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
4608 expression.
4609
4610 Arguments:
4611 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
4612 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004613
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004614 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004615 http-request set-src-port hdr(x-port)
4616 http-request set-src-port int(4000)
4617
4618 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long as
4619 the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source address to
4620 IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
4621
4622http-request set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4623
4624 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
4625 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this. This value
4626 represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be expressed both in
4627 decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that only the 6 higher
4628 bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are always 0. This can
4629 be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers based on some
4630 information from the request.
4631
4632 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
4633
4634http-request set-uri <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4635
4636 This rewrites the request URI with the result of the evaluation of format
4637 string <fmt>. The scheme, authority, path and query string are all replaced
4638 at once. This can be used to rewrite hosts in front of proxies, or to
4639 perform complex modifications to the URI such as moving parts between the
4640 path and the query string.
4641 See also "http-request set-path" and "http-request set-query".
4642
4643http-request set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4644
4645 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
4646 inline.
4647
4648 Arguments:
4649 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
4650 scope. The scopes allowed are:
4651 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
4652 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
4653 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
4654 (request and response)
4655 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
4656 processing
4657 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
4658 processing
4659 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
4660 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9'
4661 and '_'.
4662
4663 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4664 followed by some converters.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004665
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004666 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004667 http-request set-var(req.my_var) req.fhdr(user-agent),lower
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004668
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004669http-request send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
4670 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004671
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004672 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
4673 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
4674 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
4675 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
4676 agent name must be used.
4677
4678 Arguments:
4679 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
4680
4681 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
4682 configuration.
4683
4684http-request silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4685
4686 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
4687 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
4688 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
4689 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
4690 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
4691 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
4692 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
4693 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
4694 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
4695 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
4696 action.
4697 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
4698 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
4699 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
4700 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
4701 you fully understand how it works.
4702
4703http-request tarpit [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4704
4705 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately blocks the request
4706 without responding for a delay specified by "timeout tarpit" or
4707 "timeout connect" if the former is not set. After that delay, if the client
4708 is still connected, an HTTP error 500 (or optionally the status code
4709 specified as an argument to "deny_status") is returned so that the client
4710 does not suspect it has been tarpitted. Logs will report the flags "PT".
4711 The goal of the tarpit rule is to slow down robots during an attack when
4712 they're limited on the number of concurrent requests. It can be very
4713 efficient against very dumb robots, and will significantly reduce the load
4714 on firewalls compared to a "deny" rule. But when facing "correctly"
4715 developed robots, it can make things worse by forcing haproxy and the front
4716 firewall to support insane number of concurrent connections.
4717 See also the "silent-drop" action.
4718
4719http-request track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4720http-request track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4721http-request track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4722
4723 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current request. These rules do
4724 not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The number of counters
4725 that may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection is set in
4726 MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in haproxy -vv) which defaults to 3,
4727 so the track-sc number is between 0 and (MAX_SESS_STCKTR-1). The first
4728 "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
4729 table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking
4730 of the counters of the specified table as the second set. The first
4731 "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
4732 table as the third set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of
4733 counters for the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend
4734 ones. But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
4735
4736 Arguments :
4737 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described in
4738 section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming request or
4739 connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined, and used to
4740 select which table entry to update the counters.
4741
4742 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one, which
4743 is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All the counters
4744 for the matches and updates for the key will then be performed in
4745 that table until the session ends.
4746
4747 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table and if
4748 it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to that entry
4749 is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's counters are updated
4750 as often as possible, every time the session's counters are updated, and also
4751 systematically when the session ends. Counters are only updated for events
4752 that happen after the tracking has been started. As an exception, connection
4753 counters and request counters are systematically updated so that they reflect
4754 useful information.
4755
4756 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is counted
4757 for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not expire during
4758 that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance advantage over just
4759 checking the keys, because only one table lookup is performed for all ACL
4760 checks that make use of it.
4761
4762http-request unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4763
4764 This is used to unset a variable. See above for details about <var-name>.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004765
4766 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004767 http-request unset-var(req.my_var)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004768
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004769http-request wait-for-handshake [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004770
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004771 This will delay the processing of the request until the SSL handshake
4772 happened. This is mostly useful to delay processing early data until we're
4773 sure they are valid.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004774
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01004775
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004776http-response <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004777 Access control for Layer 7 responses
4778
4779 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4780 no | yes | yes | yes
4781
4782 The http-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
4783 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
4784 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
4785 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
4786 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
4787 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
4788
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004789 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
4790 below.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004791
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004792 There is no limit to the number of http-response statements per instance.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004793
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004794 It is important to know that http-response rules are processed very early in
4795 the HTTP processing, before "rspdel" or "rsprep" or "rspadd" rules. That way,
4796 headers added by "add-header"/"set-header" are visible by almost all further
4797 ACL rules.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004798
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004799 Using "rspadd"/"rspdel"/"rsprep" to manipulate request headers is discouraged
4800 in newer versions (>= 1.5). But if you need to use regular expression to
4801 delete headers, you can still use "rspdel". Also please use
4802 "http-response deny" instead of "rspdeny".
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004803
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004804 Example:
4805 acl key_acl res.hdr(X-Acl-Key) -m found
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02004806
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004807 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004808
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004809 http-response add-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
4810 http-response del-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004811
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004812 Example:
4813 acl value res.hdr(X-Value) -m found
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004814
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004815 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004816
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004817 http-response set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[res.hdr(X-Value)] if value
4818 http-response del-map(map.lst) %[src] if ! value
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004819
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004820 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
4821 ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004822
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004823http-response add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004824
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004825 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
4826 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
4827 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4828 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
4829 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
4830 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
4831 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
4832 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004833
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004834http-response add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004835
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004836 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and whose
4837 value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see Custom Log
4838 Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send a cookie to a client for
4839 example, or to pass some internal information.
4840 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
4841 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
4842 the resulting header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004843
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004844http-response allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004845
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004846 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response pass the check.
4847 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated for the current section.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004848
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02004849http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004850
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004851 See section 10.2 about cache setup.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004852
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004853http-response capture <sample> id <id> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004854
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004855 This captures sample expression <sample> from the response buffer, and
4856 converts it to a string. The resulting string is stored into the next request
4857 "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to some captured HTTP
4858 headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs, and it will be
4859 possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it into headers or
4860 anything. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and
4861 "capture response header" for more information.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02004862
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004863 The keyword "id" is the id of the capture slot which is used for storing the
4864 string. The capture slot must be defined in an associated frontend.
4865 This is useful to run captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a
4866 previous directive "http-response capture" or with the "declare capture"
4867 keyword.
4868 If the slot <id> doesn't exist, then HAProxy fails parsing the configuration
4869 to prevent unexpected behavior at run time.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02004870
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004871http-response del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02004872
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004873 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
4874 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
4875 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4876 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4877 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
4878 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02004879
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004880http-response del-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02004881
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004882 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>.
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02004883
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004884http-response del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02004885
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004886 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
4887 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
4888 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4889 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4890 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
4891 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004892
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004893http-response deny [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004894
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004895 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the response
4896 and emits an HTTP 502 error. No further "http-response" rules are evaluated.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004897
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004898http-response redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004899
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004900 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
4901 This supports a format string similarly to "http-request redirect" rules,
4902 with the exception that only the "location" type of redirect is possible on
4903 the response. See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax. When a
4904 redirect rule is applied during a response, connections to the server are
4905 closed so that no data can be forwarded from the server to the client.
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02004906
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004907http-response replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
4908 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02004909
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004910 This matches the regular expression in all occurrences of header field <name>
4911 according to <match-regex>, and replaces them with the <replace-fmt> argument.
4912 Format characters are allowed in replace-fmt and work like in <fmt> arguments
4913 in "add-header". The match is only case-sensitive. It is important to
4914 understand that this action only considers whole header lines, regardless of
4915 the number of values they may contain. This usage is suited to headers
4916 naturally containing commas in their value, such as Set-Cookie, Expires and
4917 so on.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01004918
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004919 Example:
4920 http-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
Willy Tarreau51d861a2015-05-22 17:30:48 +02004921
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004922 # applied to:
4923 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004924
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004925 # outputs:
4926 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004927
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004928 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004929
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004930http-response replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
4931 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004932
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004933 This works like "replace-header" except that it matches the regex against
4934 every comma-delimited value of the header field <name> instead of the entire
4935 header. This is suited for all headers which are allowed to carry more than
4936 one value. An example could be the Accept header.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004937
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004938 Example:
4939 http-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004940
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004941 # applied to:
4942 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004943
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004944 # outputs:
4945 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004946
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004947http-response sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4948http-response sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Ruoshan Huange4edc6b2016-07-14 15:07:45 +08004949
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004950 This action increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
4951 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
4952 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02004953
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004954http-response sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02004955
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004956 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated by
4957 <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If an error
4958 occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01004959
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004960http-response send-spoe-group [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02004961
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004962 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
4963 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
4964 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
4965 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
4966 agent name must be used.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004967
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004968 Arguments:
4969 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004970
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004971 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
4972 configuration.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004973
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004974http-response set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004975
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004976 This does the same as "add-header" except that the header name is first
4977 removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security information to
4978 the server, where the header must not be manipulated by external users.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004979
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004980http-response set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4981
4982 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
4983 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
4984 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
4985 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule can
4986 be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
4987
4988http-response set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
4989
4990 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
4991 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
4992 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
4993 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
4994 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry. It performs a
4995 lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
4996 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
4997 It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the stats socket, but can
4998 be triggered by an HTTP response.
4999
5000http-response set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5001
5002 This is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the client to
5003 the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
5004 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and by the routing
5005 table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed
5006 by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different
5007 route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on
5008 Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges.
5009
5010http-response set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5011
5012 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
5013 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
5014 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
5015 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
5016 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important
5017 than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
5018 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
5019 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
5020
5021http-response set-status <status> [reason <str>]
5022 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5023
5024 This replaces the response status code with <status> which must be an integer
5025 between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be provided defined
5026 by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code will be used as a
5027 fallback.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08005028
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005029 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005030 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
5031 http-response set-status 431
5032 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
5033 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down".
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005034
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005035http-response set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005036
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005037 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
5038 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
5039 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
5040 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that
5041 only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are
5042 always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers
5043 based on some information from the request.
5044
5045 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
5046
5047http-response set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5048
5049 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
5050 inline.
5051
5052 Arguments:
5053 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
5054 scope. The scopes allowed are:
5055 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
5056 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
5057 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
5058 (request and response)
5059 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
5060 processing
5061 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
5062 processing
5063 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
5064 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.'
5065 and '_'.
5066
5067 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
5068 followed by some converters.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005069
5070 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005071 http-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005072
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005073http-response silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005074
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005075 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
5076 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
5077 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
5078 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
5079 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
5080 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
5081 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
5082 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
5083 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
5084 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
5085 action.
5086 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
5087 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
5088 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
5089 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
5090 you fully understand how it works.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005091
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005092http-response track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5093http-response track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5094http-response track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02005095
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005096 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current response. Please refer
5097 to "http-request track-sc" for a complete description. The only difference
5098 from "http-request track-sc" is the <key> sample expression can only make use
5099 of samples in response (e.g. res.*, status etc.) and samples below Layer 6
5100 (e.g. SSL-related samples, see section 7.3.4). If the sample is not
5101 supported, haproxy will fail and warn while parsing the config.
5102
5103http-response unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5104
5105 This is used to unset a variable. See "http-response set-var" for details
5106 about <var-name>.
5107
5108 Example:
5109 http-response unset-var(sess.last_redir)
5110
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02005111
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005112http-reuse { never | safe | aggressive | always }
5113 Declare how idle HTTP connections may be shared between requests
5114
5115 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5116 yes | no | yes | yes
5117
5118 By default, a connection established between haproxy and the backend server
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01005119 which is considered safe for reuse is moved back to the server's idle
5120 connections pool so that any other request can make use of it. This is the
5121 "safe" strategy below.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005122
5123 The argument indicates the desired connection reuse strategy :
5124
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01005125 - "never" : idle connections are never shared between sessions. This mode
5126 may be enforced to cancel a different strategy inherited from
5127 a defaults section or for troubleshooting. For example, if an
5128 old bogus application considers that multiple requests over
5129 the same connection come from the same client and it is not
5130 possible to fix the application, it may be desirable to
5131 disable connection sharing in a single backend. An example of
5132 such an application could be an old haproxy using cookie
5133 insertion in tunnel mode and not checking any request past the
5134 first one.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005135
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01005136 - "safe" : this is the default and the recommended strategy. The first
5137 request of a session is always sent over its own connection,
5138 and only subsequent requests may be dispatched over other
5139 existing connections. This ensures that in case the server
5140 closes the connection when the request is being sent, the
5141 browser can decide to silently retry it. Since it is exactly
5142 equivalent to regular keep-alive, there should be no side
5143 effects.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005144
5145 - "aggressive" : this mode may be useful in webservices environments where
5146 all servers are not necessarily known and where it would be
5147 appreciable to deliver most first requests over existing
5148 connections. In this case, first requests are only delivered
5149 over existing connections that have been reused at least once,
5150 proving that the server correctly supports connection reuse.
5151 It should only be used when it's sure that the client can
5152 retry a failed request once in a while and where the benefit
5153 of aggressive connection reuse significantly outweights the
5154 downsides of rare connection failures.
5155
5156 - "always" : this mode is only recommended when the path to the server is
5157 known for never breaking existing connections quickly after
5158 releasing them. It allows the first request of a session to be
5159 sent to an existing connection. This can provide a significant
5160 performance increase over the "safe" strategy when the backend
5161 is a cache farm, since such components tend to show a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005162 consistent behavior and will benefit from the connection
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005163 sharing. It is recommended that the "http-keep-alive" timeout
5164 remains low in this mode so that no dead connections remain
5165 usable. In most cases, this will lead to the same performance
5166 gains as "aggressive" but with more risks. It should only be
5167 used when it improves the situation over "aggressive".
5168
5169 When http connection sharing is enabled, a great care is taken to respect the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005170 connection properties and compatibility. Specifically :
5171 - connections made with "usesrc" followed by a client-dependent value
5172 ("client", "clientip", "hdr_ip") are marked private and never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005173
5174 - connections sent to a server with a TLS SNI extension are marked private
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005175 and are never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005176
Lukas Tribusfd9b68c2018-10-27 20:06:59 +02005177 - connections with certain bogus authentication schemes (relying on the
5178 connection) like NTLM are detected, marked private and are never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005179
5180 No connection pool is involved, once a session dies, the last idle connection
5181 it was attached to is deleted at the same time. This ensures that connections
5182 may not last after all sessions are closed.
5183
5184 Note: connection reuse improves the accuracy of the "server maxconn" setting,
5185 because almost no new connection will be established while idle connections
5186 remain available. This is particularly true with the "always" strategy.
5187
5188 See also : "option http-keep-alive", "server maxconn"
5189
5190
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005191http-send-name-header [<header>]
5192 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
5193
5194 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5195 yes | no | yes | yes
5196
5197 Arguments :
5198
5199 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
5200
5201 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the name of the target
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005202 server to be added to the headers of an HTTP request. The name
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005203 is added with the header string proved.
5204
5205 See also : "server"
5206
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01005207id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02005208 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
5209 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5210 no | yes | yes | yes
5211 Arguments : none
5212
5213 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
5214 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
5215 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01005216
5217
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005218ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
5219 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
5220 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01005221 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005222
5223 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
5224 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
5225 and running).
5226
5227 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
5228 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
5229 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005230 often don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005231 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
5232
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005233 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
5234 "unless" condition is met.
5235
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03005236 Example:
5237 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
5238 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
5239 ignore-persist if url_static
5240
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005241 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
5242
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005243load-server-state-from-file { global | local | none }
5244 Allow seamless reload of HAProxy
5245 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5246 yes | no | yes | yes
5247
5248 This directive points HAProxy to a file where server state from previous
5249 running process has been saved. That way, when starting up, before handling
5250 traffic, the new process can apply old states to servers exactly has if no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005251 reload occurred. The purpose of the "load-server-state-from-file" directive is
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005252 to tell haproxy which file to use. For now, only 2 arguments to either prevent
5253 loading state or load states from a file containing all backends and servers.
5254 The state file can be generated by running the command "show servers state"
5255 over the stats socket and redirect output.
5256
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005257 The format of the file is versioned and is very specific. To understand it,
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005258 please read the documentation of the "show servers state" command (chapter
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02005259 9.3 of Management Guide).
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005260
5261 Arguments:
5262 global load the content of the file pointed by the global directive
5263 named "server-state-file".
5264
5265 local load the content of the file pointed by the directive
5266 "server-state-file-name" if set. If not set, then the backend
5267 name is used as a file name.
5268
5269 none don't load any stat for this backend
5270
5271 Notes:
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01005272 - server's IP address is preserved across reloads by default, but the
5273 order can be changed thanks to the server's "init-addr" setting. This
5274 means that an IP address change performed on the CLI at run time will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005275 be preserved, and that any change to the local resolver (e.g. /etc/hosts)
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01005276 will possibly not have any effect if the state file is in use.
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005277
5278 - server's weight is applied from previous running process unless it has
5279 has changed between previous and new configuration files.
5280
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005281 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005282
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005283 global
5284 stats socket /tmp/socket
5285 server-state-file /tmp/server_state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005286
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005287 defaults
5288 load-server-state-from-file global
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005289
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005290 backend bk
5291 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
5292 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005293
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005294
5295 Then one can run :
5296
5297 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state" > /tmp/server_state
5298
5299 Content of the file /tmp/server_state would be like this:
5300
5301 1
5302 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
5303 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
5304 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
5305
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005306 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005307
5308 global
5309 stats socket /tmp/socket
5310 server-state-base /etc/haproxy/states
5311
5312 defaults
5313 load-server-state-from-file local
5314
5315 backend bk
5316 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
5317 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
5318
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005319
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005320 Then one can run :
5321
5322 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state bk" > /etc/haproxy/states/bk
5323
5324 Content of the file /etc/haproxy/states/bk would be like this:
5325
5326 1
5327 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
5328 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
5329 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
5330
5331 See also: "server-state-file", "server-state-file-name", and
5332 "show servers state"
5333
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005334
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005335log global
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02005336log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>]
5337 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02005338no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005339 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
5340 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5341 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02005342
5343 Prefix :
5344 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
5345 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
5346 prefix does not allow arguments.
5347
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005348 Arguments :
5349 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
5350 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
5351 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
5352 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
5353 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
5354 parameter.
5355
5356 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
5357 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
5358
5359 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
5360 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
5361 standard syslog port).
5362
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01005363 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
5364 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
5365 standard syslog port).
5366
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005367 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
5368 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
5369 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005370 appropriately writable).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005371
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01005372 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may
5373 point to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered
5374 logs are used and one writev() call per log is performed. This
5375 is a bit expensive but acceptable for most workloads. Messages
5376 sent this way will not be truncated but may be dropped, in
5377 which case the DroppedLogs counter will be incremented. The
5378 writev() call is atomic even on pipes for messages up to
5379 PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least 512 and
5380 which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
5381 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other
5382 processes. Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file
5383 descriptor may also be directed to a file, but doing so will
5384 significantly slow haproxy down as non-blocking calls will be
5385 ignored. Also there will be no way to purge nor rotate this
5386 file without restarting the process. Note that the configured
5387 syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable for use
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01005388 with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
5389 formats below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01005390
5391 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1"
5392 and "fd@2", see above.
5393
5394 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
5395 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01005396
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02005397 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this
5398 value will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that
5399 syslog servers act differently on log line length. All servers
5400 support the default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop
5401 larger lines while others do log them. If a server supports long
5402 lines, it may make sense to set this value here in order to avoid
5403 truncating long lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines,
5404 it is preferable to truncate them before sending them. Accepted
5405 values are 80 to 65535 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is
5406 generally fine for all standard usages. Some specific cases of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005407 long captures or JSON-formatted logs may require larger values.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02005408
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02005409 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
5410 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
5411 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
5412 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must
5413 be set with <sample_size> parameter.
5414
5415 <sample_size>
5416 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
5417 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
5418 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
5419 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
5420 (see also <ranges> parameter).
5421
Willy Tarreauadb345d2018-11-12 07:56:13 +01005422 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
5423 one of the following :
5424
5425 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format. This is the default.
5426 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
5427
5428 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
5429 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
5430
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01005431 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
5432 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
5433 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
5434 local log server. This format is compatible with what the
5435 systemd logger consumes.
5436
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01005437 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
5438 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to
5439 be used in containers or during development, where the severity
5440 only depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
5441
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005442 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
5443
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01005444 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
5445 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
5446 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
5447
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01005448 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
5449 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
5450 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
5451 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005452
5453 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
5454 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
5455 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02005456 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
5457 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
5458 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
5459 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
5460 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005461
5462 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
5463
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02005464 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
5465 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
5466 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01005467
5468 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
5469 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
5470 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
5471 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
5472
5473 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
5474 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005475
5476 Example :
5477 log global
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01005478 log stdout format short daemon # send log to systemd
5479 log stdout format raw daemon # send everything to stdout
5480 log stderr format raw daemon notice # send important events to stderr
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02005481 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
5482 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output level
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02005483 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01005484
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005485
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01005486log-format <string>
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01005487 Specifies the log format string to use for traffic logs
5488 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5489 yes | yes | yes | no
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01005490
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01005491 This directive specifies the log format string that will be used for all logs
5492 resulting from traffic passing through the frontend using this line. If the
5493 directive is used in a defaults section, all subsequent frontends will use
5494 the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4 which covers the log format
5495 string in depth.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01005496
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02005497 "log-format" directive overrides previous "option tcplog", "log-format" and
5498 "option httplog" directives.
5499
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02005500log-format-sd <string>
5501 Specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string
5502 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5503 yes | yes | yes | no
5504
5505 This directive specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string that
5506 will be used for all logs resulting from traffic passing through the frontend
5507 using this line. If the directive is used in a defaults section, all
5508 subsequent frontends will use the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4
5509 which covers the log format string in depth.
5510
5511 See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3 for more information
5512 about the RFC5424 structured-data part.
5513
5514 Note : This log format string will be used only for loggers that have set
5515 log format to "rfc5424".
5516
5517 Example :
5518 log-format-sd [exampleSDID@1234\ bytes=\"%B\"\ status=\"%ST\"]
5519
5520
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01005521log-tag <string>
5522 Specifies the log tag to use for all outgoing logs
5523 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5524 yes | yes | yes | yes
5525
5526 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
5527 log-tag set in the global section, otherwise the program name as launched
5528 from the command line, which usually is "haproxy". Sometimes it can be useful
5529 to differentiate between multiple processes running on the same host, or to
5530 differentiate customer instances running in the same process. In the backend,
5531 logs about servers up/down will use this tag. As a hint, it can be convenient
5532 to set a log-tag related to a hosted customer in a defaults section then put
5533 all the frontends and backends for that customer, then start another customer
5534 in a new defaults section. See also the global "log-tag" directive.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005535
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02005536max-keep-alive-queue <value>
5537 Set the maximum server queue size for maintaining keep-alive connections
5538 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5539 yes | no | yes | yes
5540
5541 HTTP keep-alive tries to reuse the same server connection whenever possible,
5542 but sometimes it can be counter-productive, for example if a server has a lot
5543 of connections while other ones are idle. This is especially true for static
5544 servers.
5545
5546 The purpose of this setting is to set a threshold on the number of queued
5547 connections at which haproxy stops trying to reuse the same server and prefers
5548 to find another one. The default value, -1, means there is no limit. A value
5549 of zero means that keep-alive requests will never be queued. For very close
5550 servers which can be reached with a low latency and which are not sensible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005551 breaking keep-alive, a low value is recommended (e.g. local static server can
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02005552 use a value of 10 or less). For remote servers suffering from a high latency,
5553 higher values might be needed to cover for the latency and/or the cost of
5554 picking a different server.
5555
5556 Note that this has no impact on responses which are maintained to the same
5557 server consecutively to a 401 response. They will still go to the same server
5558 even if they have to be queued.
5559
5560 See also : "option http-server-close", "option prefer-last-server", server
5561 "maxconn" and cookie persistence.
5562
Olivier Houcharda4d4fdf2018-12-14 19:27:06 +01005563max-session-srv-conns <nb>
5564 Set the maximum number of outgoing connections we can keep idling for a given
5565 client session. The default is 5 (it precisely equals MAX_SRV_LIST which is
5566 defined at build time).
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02005567
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005568maxconn <conns>
5569 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
5570 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5571 yes | yes | yes | no
5572 Arguments :
5573 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
5574 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
5575 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
5576 closes.
5577
5578 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
5579 very high so that haproxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
5580 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
5581 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
Baptiste Assmann79fb45d2016-03-06 23:34:31 +01005582 of tune.bufsize (16kB by default) each, as well as some other data resulting
5583 in about 33 kB of RAM being consumed per established connection. That means
5584 that a medium system equipped with 1GB of RAM can withstand around
5585 20000-25000 concurrent connections if properly tuned.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005586
5587 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
5588 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
5589 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
5590
Willy Tarreauc8d5b952019-02-27 17:25:52 +01005591 When this value is set to zero, which is the default, the global "maxconn"
5592 value is used.
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02005593
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005594 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
5595
5596
5597mode { tcp|http|health }
5598 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
5599 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5600 yes | yes | yes | yes
5601 Arguments :
5602 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
5603 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
5604 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
5605 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
5606
5607 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
5608 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
5609 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
5610 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
5611 brings HAProxy most of its value.
5612
5613 health The instance will work in "health" mode. It will just reply "OK"
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02005614 to incoming connections and close the connection. Alternatively,
5615 If the "httpchk" option is set, "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" will be sent
5616 instead. Nothing will be logged in either case. This mode is used
5617 to reply to external components health checks. This mode is
5618 deprecated and should not be used anymore as it is possible to do
5619 the same and even better by combining TCP or HTTP modes with the
5620 "monitor" keyword.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005621
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005622 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
5623 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
5624 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005625
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005626 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005627 defaults http_instances
5628 mode http
5629
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005630 See also : "monitor", "monitor-net"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005631
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005632
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01005633monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005634 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005635 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5636 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005637 Arguments :
5638 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
5639 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005640 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005641 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
5642 backend and its backup.
5643
5644 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
5645 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
5646 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
5647 servers in a list of backends.
5648
5649 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
5650 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
5651 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
5652 conditions above is met, haproxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
5653 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
5654 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
5655 haproxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02005656 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
5657 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005658
5659 Example:
5660 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005661 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005662 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
5663 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
5664 monitor-uri /site_alive
5665 monitor fail if site_dead
5666
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02005667 See also : "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005668
5669
5670monitor-net <source>
5671 Declare a source network which is limited to monitor requests
5672 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5673 yes | yes | yes | no
5674 Arguments :
5675 <source> is the source IPv4 address or network which will only be able to
5676 get monitor responses to any request. It can be either an IPv4
5677 address, a host name, or an address followed by a slash ('/')
5678 followed by a mask.
5679
5680 In TCP mode, any connection coming from a source matching <source> will cause
5681 the connection to be immediately closed without any log. This allows another
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005682 equipment to probe the port and verify that it is still listening, without
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005683 forwarding the connection to a remote server.
5684
5685 In HTTP mode, a connection coming from a source matching <source> will be
5686 accepted, the following response will be sent without waiting for a request,
5687 then the connection will be closed : "HTTP/1.0 200 OK". This is normally
5688 enough for any front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02005689 running without forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that this
5690 response is sent in raw format, without any transformation. This is important
5691 as it means that it will not be SSL-encrypted on SSL listeners.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005692
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02005693 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after tcp-request connection
5694 ACLs which are the only ones able to block them. These connections are short
5695 lived and never wait for any data from the client. They cannot be logged, and
5696 it is the intended purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to
5697 an upper component, nothing more. Please note that "monitor fail" rules do
5698 not apply to connections intercepted by "monitor-net".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005699
Willy Tarreau95cd2832010-03-04 23:36:33 +01005700 Last, please note that only one "monitor-net" statement can be specified in
5701 a frontend. If more than one is found, only the last one will be considered.
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005702
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005703 Example :
5704 # addresses .252 and .253 are just probing us.
5705 frontend www
5706 monitor-net 192.168.0.252/31
5707
5708 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-uri"
5709
5710
5711monitor-uri <uri>
5712 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
5713 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5714 yes | yes | yes | no
5715 Arguments :
5716 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
5717 health status instead of forwarding the request.
5718
5719 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
5720 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
5721 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
5722 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
5723 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
5724 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
5725 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
5726 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
5727
Willy Tarreau721d8e02017-12-01 18:25:08 +01005728 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after the request is parsed
5729 and even before any "http-request" or "block" rulesets. The only rulesets
5730 applied before are the tcp-request ones. They cannot be logged either, and it
5731 is the intended purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an
5732 upper component, nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of
5733 conditions using "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted
5734 to whatever check can be imagined (most often the number of available servers
5735 in a backend).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005736
5737 Example :
5738 # Use /haproxy_test to report haproxy's status
5739 frontend www
5740 mode http
5741 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
5742
5743 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-net"
5744
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005745
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005746option abortonclose
5747no option abortonclose
5748 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
5749 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5750 yes | no | yes | yes
5751 Arguments : none
5752
5753 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
5754 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
5755 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
5756 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005757 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005758 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
5759 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
5760 encountered while delivering the response.
5761
5762 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
5763 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
5764 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
5765 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
5766 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
5767 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005768 support this behavior (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005769 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005770 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005771 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
5772 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
5773 still not served and not pollute the servers.
5774
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005775 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behavior using the option
5776 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behavior is HTTP
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005777 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
5778 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
5779 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
5780 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
5781 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
5782 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005783 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005784
5785 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5786 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5787
5788 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
5789
5790
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005791option accept-invalid-http-request
5792no option accept-invalid-http-request
5793 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
5794 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5795 yes | yes | yes | no
5796 Arguments : none
5797
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02005798 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005799 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005800 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005801 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
5802 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
5803 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
5804 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
5805 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01005806 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
5807 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
5808 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
5809 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005810 not allowed at all. HAProxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02005811 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled. This
Willy Tarreau13317662015-05-01 13:47:08 +02005812 option also relaxes the test on the HTTP version, it allows HTTP/0.9 requests
5813 to pass through (no version specified) and multiple digits for both the major
5814 and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005815
5816 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
5817 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
5818 been confirmed.
5819
5820 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
5821 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01005822 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
5823 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005824 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
5825
5826 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5827 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5828
5829 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
5830 stats socket.
5831
5832
5833option accept-invalid-http-response
5834no option accept-invalid-http-response
5835 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
5836 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5837 yes | no | yes | yes
5838 Arguments : none
5839
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02005840 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005841 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005842 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005843 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
5844 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
5845 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
5846 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
5847 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02005848 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. This option also
5849 relaxes the test on the HTTP version format, it allows multiple digits for
5850 both the major and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005851
5852 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
5853 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
5854 been confirmed.
5855
5856 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
5857 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
5858 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
5859 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
5860
5861 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5862 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5863
5864 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
5865 stats socket.
5866
5867
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005868option allbackups
5869no option allbackups
5870 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
5871 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5872 yes | no | yes | yes
5873 Arguments : none
5874
5875 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
5876 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
5877 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
5878 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
5879 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
5880 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
5881 order between the backup servers anymore.
5882
5883 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
5884 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
5885
5886 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5887 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5888
5889
5890option checkcache
5891no option checkcache
Godbach7056a352013-12-11 20:01:07 +08005892 Analyze all server responses and block responses with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005893 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5894 yes | no | yes | yes
5895 Arguments : none
5896
5897 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
5898 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005899 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005900 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
5901 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02005902 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005903
5904 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005905 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005906 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005907 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
5908 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005909 to the client are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005910 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header;
Willy Tarreauc55ddce2017-12-21 11:41:38 +01005911 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 204, 206, 300, 301,
5912 404, 405, 410, 414, 501, provided that the server has not set a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005913 "Cache-control: public" header field;
Willy Tarreau24ea0bc2017-12-21 11:32:55 +01005914 - all those that result from a request using a method other than GET, HEAD,
5915 OPTIONS, TRACE, provided that the server has not set a 'Cache-Control:
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005916 public' header field;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005917 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
5918 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
5919 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
5920 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
5921 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
5922 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
5923 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
5924 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
5925 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
5926
5927 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005928 just as if it was from an "rspdeny" filter, with an "HTTP 502 bad gateway".
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005929 The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the response
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005930 during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in the logs so
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005931 that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
5932
5933 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
5934 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01005935 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005936 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviors.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005937
5938 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5939 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5940
5941
5942option clitcpka
5943no option clitcpka
5944 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
5945 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5946 yes | yes | yes | no
5947 Arguments : none
5948
5949 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
5950 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005951 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005952 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
5953
5954 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
5955 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
5956 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
5957 operating system and its tuning parameters.
5958
5959 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
5960 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
5961 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
5962 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
5963 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
5964
5965 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
5966
5967 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
5968 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
5969 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
5970
5971 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5972 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5973
5974 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
5975
5976
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005977option contstats
5978 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
5979 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5980 yes | yes | yes | no
5981 Arguments : none
5982
5983 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
5984 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
5985 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
5986 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from haproxy counters looks like
Willy Tarreaudef0d222016-11-08 22:03:00 +01005987 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented frequently
5988 along the session, typically every 5 seconds, which is often enough to
5989 produce clean graphs. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so it is not
5990 not enabled by default, as it can cause a lot of wakeups for very large
5991 session counts and cause a small performance drop.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005992
5993
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02005994option dontlog-normal
5995no option dontlog-normal
5996 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
5997 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5998 yes | yes | yes | no
5999 Arguments : none
6000
6001 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
6002 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
6003 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
6004 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
6005 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
6006 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
6007 logged.
6008
6009 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
6010 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
6011 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
6012
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006013 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02006014 logging.
6015
6016
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006017option dontlognull
6018no option dontlognull
6019 Enable or disable logging of null connections
6020 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6021 yes | yes | yes | no
6022 Arguments : none
6023
6024 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
6025 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
6026 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
6027 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
6028 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
6029 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02006030 which typically corresponds to those probes. Note that errors will still be
6031 returned to the client and accounted for in the stats. If this is not what is
6032 desired, option http-ignore-probes can be used instead.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006033
6034 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006035 environments (e.g. internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006036 would not be logged.
6037
6038 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6039 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6040
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02006041 See also : "log", "http-ignore-probes", "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", and
6042 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006043
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006044
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006045option forceclose (deprecated)
6046no option forceclose (deprecated)
6047 This is an alias for "option httpclose". Thus this option is deprecated.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006048
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006049 See also : "option httpclose" and "option http-pretend-keepalive"
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006050
6051
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02006052option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006053 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
6054 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6055 yes | yes | yes | yes
6056 Arguments :
6057 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
6058 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006059 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006060 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006061
6062 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
6063 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
6064 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
6065 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
6066 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
6067 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
6068 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006069 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
6070 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
6071 possible that the client has already brought one.
6072
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006073 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006074 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006075 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (e.g. stunnel),
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006076 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006077 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (e.g. Zeus Web Servers
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006078 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006079
6080 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
6081 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
6082 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
6083 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
6084 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
6085 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
6086 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
6087
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02006088 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
6089 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
6090 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching haproxy
6091 are under the control of the end-user.
6092
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006093 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006094 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
6095 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02006096 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
6097 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
6098 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006099
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02006100 Example :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006101 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
6102 frontend www
6103 mode http
6104 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
6105
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006106 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
6107 backend www
6108 mode http
6109 option forwardfor header X-Client
6110
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02006111 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006112 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006113
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006114
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02006115option http-buffer-request
6116no option http-buffer-request
6117 Enable or disable waiting for whole HTTP request body before proceeding
6118 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6119 yes | yes | yes | yes
6120 Arguments : none
6121
6122 It is sometimes desirable to wait for the body of an HTTP request before
6123 taking a decision. This is what is being done by "balance url_param" for
6124 example. The first use case is to buffer requests from slow clients before
6125 connecting to the server. Another use case consists in taking the routing
6126 decision based on the request body's contents. This option placed in a
6127 frontend or backend forces the HTTP processing to wait until either the whole
6128 body is received, or the request buffer is full, or the first chunk is
6129 complete in case of chunked encoding. It can have undesired side effects with
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01006130 some applications abusing HTTP by expecting unbuffered transmissions between
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02006131 the frontend and the backend, so this should definitely not be used by
6132 default.
6133
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +01006134 See also : "option http-no-delay", "timeout http-request"
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02006135
6136
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02006137option http-ignore-probes
6138no option http-ignore-probes
6139 Enable or disable logging of null connections and request timeouts
6140 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6141 yes | yes | yes | no
6142 Arguments : none
6143
6144 Recently some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature
6145 consisting in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites
6146 just in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
6147 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408 Request
6148 Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when the browser
6149 decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log and feed the error
6150 counters. There was already "option dontlognull" but it's insufficient in
6151 this case. Instead, this option does the following things :
6152 - prevent any 400/408 message from being sent to the client if nothing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006153 was received over a connection before it was closed;
6154 - prevent any log from being emitted in this situation;
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02006155 - prevent any error counter from being incremented
6156
6157 That way the empty connection is silently ignored. Note that it is better
6158 not to use this unless it is clear that it is needed, because it will hide
6159 real problems. The most common reason for not receiving a request and seeing
6160 a 408 is due to an MTU inconsistency between the client and an intermediary
6161 element such as a VPN, which blocks too large packets. These issues are
6162 generally seen with POST requests as well as GET with large cookies. The logs
6163 are often the only way to detect them.
6164
6165 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6166 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6167
6168 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "errorfile", and section 8 about logging.
6169
6170
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006171option http-keep-alive
6172no option http-keep-alive
6173 Enable or disable HTTP keep-alive from client to server
6174 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6175 yes | yes | yes | yes
6176 Arguments : none
6177
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006178 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
6179 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006180 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
6181 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
6182 as "option http-server-close", "option httpclose" or "option http-tunnel".
6183 This option allows to set back the keep-alive mode, which can be useful when
6184 another mode was used in a defaults section.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006185
6186 Setting "option http-keep-alive" enables HTTP keep-alive mode on the client-
6187 and server- sides. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006188 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side at the expense
6189 of maintaining idle connections to the servers. In general, it is possible
6190 with this option to achieve approximately twice the request rate that the
6191 "http-server-close" option achieves on small objects. There are mainly two
6192 situations where this option may be useful :
6193
6194 - when the server is non-HTTP compliant and authenticates the connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006195 instead of requests (e.g. NTLM authentication)
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006196
6197 - when the cost of establishing the connection to the server is significant
6198 compared to the cost of retrieving the associated object from the server.
6199
6200 This last case can happen when the server is a fast static server of cache.
6201 In this case, the server will need to be properly tuned to support high enough
6202 connection counts because connections will last until the client sends another
6203 request.
6204
6205 If the client request has to go to another backend or another server due to
6206 content switching or the load balancing algorithm, the idle connection will
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01006207 immediately be closed and a new one re-opened. Option "prefer-last-server" is
6208 available to try optimize server selection so that if the server currently
6209 attached to an idle connection is usable, it will be used.
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006210
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006211 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
6212 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
6213 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
6214 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
6215 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
6216 not set.
6217
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01006218 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006219 http-server-close" or "option http-tunnel". When backend and frontend options
6220 differ, all of these 4 options have precedence over "option http-keep-alive".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006221
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006222 See also : "option httpclose",, "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01006223 "option prefer-last-server", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01006224 and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006225
6226
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02006227option http-no-delay
6228no option http-no-delay
6229 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
6230 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6231 yes | yes | yes | yes
6232 Arguments : none
6233
6234 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
6235 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
6236 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
6237 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
6238 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
6239 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
6240 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
6241 haproxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
6242 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
6243 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
6244 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
6245 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
6246 affected.
6247
6248 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
6249 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
6250 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
6251 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
6252 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
6253 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
6254 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
6255 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
6256 latency environments.
6257
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02006258 See also : "option http-buffer-request"
6259
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02006260
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006261option http-pretend-keepalive
6262no option http-pretend-keepalive
6263 Define whether haproxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
6264 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02006265 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006266 Arguments : none
6267
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006268 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose", haproxy
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006269 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
6270 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
6271 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
6272 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents haproxy from
6273 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
6274 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
6275 consider the response complete.
6276
6277 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", haproxy will make the server
6278 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
6279 to the abnormal undesired above. When haproxy gets the whole response, it
6280 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006281 "option httpclose". That way the client gets a normal response and the
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006282 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
6283
6284 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
6285 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
6286 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
6287 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
6288 worth noting that when this option is enabled, haproxy will have slightly
6289 less work to do. So if haproxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
6290 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
6291
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02006292 This option may be set in backend and listen sections. Using it in a frontend
6293 section will be ignored and a warning will be reported during startup. It is
6294 a backend related option, so there is no real reason to set it on a
6295 frontend. This option may be combined with "option httpclose", which will
6296 cause keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to
6297 the client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006298
6299 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6300 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6301
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006302 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close", and
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006303 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006304
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006305
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01006306option http-server-close
6307no option http-server-close
6308 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
6309 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6310 yes | yes | yes | yes
6311 Arguments : none
6312
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006313 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
6314 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
6315 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
6316 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006317 as "option http-server-close", "option httpclose" or "option http-tunnel".
6318 Setting "option http-server-close" enables HTTP connection-close mode on the
6319 server side while keeping the ability to support HTTP keep-alive and
6320 pipelining on the client side. This provides the lowest latency on the client
6321 side (slow network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side to save
6322 server resources, similarly to "option httpclose". It also permits
6323 non-keepalive capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode to the clients
6324 if they conform to the requirements of RFC7230. Please note that some servers
6325 do not always conform to those requirements when they see "Connection: close"
6326 in the request. The effect will be that keep-alive will never be used. A
6327 workaround consists in enabling "option http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01006328
6329 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
6330 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
6331 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
6332 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01006333 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
6334 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01006335
6336 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
6337 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006338 It disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option http-tunnel"
6339 or "option http-keep-alive". Please check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how
6340 this option combines with others when frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01006341
6342 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6343 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6344
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006345 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
6346 "option http-keep-alive", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01006347
6348
Christopher Faulet6c9bbb22019-03-26 21:37:23 +01006349option http-tunnel (deprecated)
6350no option http-tunnel (deprecated)
6351 Disable or enable HTTP connection processing after first transaction.
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01006352 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet4212a302018-09-21 10:42:19 +02006353 yes | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01006354 Arguments : none
6355
Christopher Faulet6c9bbb22019-03-26 21:37:23 +01006356 Warning : Because it cannot work in HTTP/2, this option is deprecated and it
6357 is only supported on legacy HTTP frontends. In HTX, it is ignored and a
6358 warning is emitted during HAProxy startup.
6359
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006360 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
6361 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
6362 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
6363 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006364 as "option http-server-close", "option httpclose" or "option http-tunnel".
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006365
6366 Option "http-tunnel" disables any HTTP processing past the first request and
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006367 the first response. This is the mode which was used by default in versions
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006368 1.0 to 1.5-dev21. It is the mode with the lowest processing overhead, which
6369 is normally not needed anymore unless in very specific cases such as when
6370 using an in-house protocol that looks like HTTP but is not compatible, or
6371 just to log one request per client in order to reduce log size. Note that
6372 everything which works at the HTTP level, including header parsing/addition,
6373 cookie processing or content switching will only work for the first request
6374 and will be ignored after the first response.
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01006375
Christopher Faulet4212a302018-09-21 10:42:19 +02006376 This option may be set on frontend and listen sections. Using it on a backend
6377 section will be ignored and a warning will be reported during the startup. It
6378 is a frontend related option, so there is no real reason to set it on a
6379 backend.
6380
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01006381 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6382 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6383
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006384 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
6385 "option http-keep-alive", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01006386
6387
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006388option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01006389no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006390 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
6391 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6392 yes | yes | yes | no
6393 Arguments : none
6394
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00006395 While RFC7230 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006396 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
6397 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
6398 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
6399 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
6400 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
6401 haproxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
6402
6403 By setting this option in a frontend, haproxy can automatically switch to use
6404 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01006405 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. This
6406 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode. Note that this option can only be
6407 specified in a frontend and will affect the request along its whole life.
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006408
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01006409 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
6410 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
6411 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
6412 front of an existing proxy.
6413
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006414 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
6415
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006416 See also : "option httpclose", and "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006417
6418
Willy Tarreau68ad3a42018-10-22 11:49:15 +02006419option http-use-htx
6420no option http-use-htx
6421 Switch to the new HTX internal representation for HTTP protocol elements
6422 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6423 yes | yes | yes | yes
6424 Arguments : none
6425
Christopher Faulet1d2b5862019-04-12 16:10:51 +02006426 Historically, the HTTP protocol is processed as-is. Inserting, deleting, or
Willy Tarreau68ad3a42018-10-22 11:49:15 +02006427 modifying a header field requires to rewrite the affected part in the buffer
Christopher Faulet1d2b5862019-04-12 16:10:51 +02006428 and to move the buffer's tail accordingly. This mode is known as the legacy
6429 HTTP mode. Since this principle has deep roots in haproxy, the HTTP/2
6430 protocol is converted to HTTP/1.1 before being processed this way. It also
6431 results in the inability to establish HTTP/2 connections to servers because
6432 of the loss of HTTP/2 semantics in the HTTP/1 representation.
Willy Tarreau68ad3a42018-10-22 11:49:15 +02006433
6434 HTX is the name of a totally new native internal representation for the HTTP
6435 protocol, that is agnostic to the version and aims at preserving semantics
6436 all along the chain. It relies on a fast parsing, tokenizing and indexing of
6437 the protocol elements so that no more memory moves are necessary and that
Christopher Faulet1d2b5862019-04-12 16:10:51 +02006438 most elements are directly accessed. It supports using either HTTP/1 or
6439 HTTP/2 on any side regardless of the other side's version. It also supports
6440 upgrades from TCP to HTTP and implicit ones from HTTP/1 to HTTP/2 (matching
6441 the HTTP/2 preface).
Willy Tarreau68ad3a42018-10-22 11:49:15 +02006442
Christopher Faulet1d2b5862019-04-12 16:10:51 +02006443 This option indicates that HTX needs to be used. Since the version 2.0-dev3,
6444 the HTX is the default mode. To switch back on the legacy HTTP mode, the
6445 option must be explicitly disabled using the "no" prefix. For prior versions,
6446 the feature has incomplete functional coverage, so it is not enabled by
6447 default.
Willy Tarreau68ad3a42018-10-22 11:49:15 +02006448
6449 See also : "mode http"
6450
6451
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006452option httpchk
6453option httpchk <uri>
6454option httpchk <method> <uri>
6455option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
6456 Enable HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
6457 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6458 yes | no | yes | yes
6459 Arguments :
6460 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
6461 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
6462 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
6463 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
6464 ones.
6465
6466 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
6467 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
6468 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
6469
6470 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
6471 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
6472 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
6473 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, and as a trick, it is possible to pass it
6474 after "\r\n" following the version string.
6475
6476 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
6477 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
6478 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
6479 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
6480 the lack of any response.
6481
6482 The port and interval are specified in the server configuration.
6483
6484 This option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works with
6485 plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts bound
6486 to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon.
6487
6488 Examples :
6489 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
6490 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
6491 backend https_relay
6492 mode tcp
6493 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1\r\nHost:\ www
6494 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
6495
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09006496 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
6497 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
6498 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006499
6500
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006501option httpclose
6502no option httpclose
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006503 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006504 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6505 yes | yes | yes | yes
6506 Arguments : none
6507
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006508 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
6509 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
6510 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
6511 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006512 as "option http-server-close", "option httpclose" or "option http-tunnel".
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006513
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006514 If "option httpclose" is set, HAProxy will close connections with the server
6515 and the client as soon as the request and the response are received. It will
6516 alos check if a "Connection: close" header is already set in each direction,
6517 and will add one if missing. Any "Connection" header different from "close"
6518 will also be removed.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006519
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006520 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
6521 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
6522 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006523
6524 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
6525 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01006526 It disables and replaces any previous "option http-server-close",
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006527 "option http-keep-alive" or "option http-tunnel". Please check section 4
6528 ("Proxies") to see how this option combines with others when frontend and
6529 backend options differ.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006530
6531 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6532 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6533
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006534 See also : "option http-server-close" and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006535
6536
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02006537option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006538 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
6539 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01006540 yes | yes | yes | no
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02006541 Arguments :
6542 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
6543 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
6544 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006545 log analyzer which only support the CLF format and which is not
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02006546 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006547
6548 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
6549 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
6550 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
6551 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
6552 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
6553 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
6554 ports.
6555
PiBa-NLbd556bf2014-12-11 21:31:54 +01006556 Specifying only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode
6557 if it was set by default.
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02006558
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02006559 "option httplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
6560
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006561 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006562
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006563
6564option http_proxy
6565no option http_proxy
6566 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
6567 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6568 yes | yes | yes | yes
6569 Arguments : none
6570
6571 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
6572 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
6573 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
6574 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
6575 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
6576
6577 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
6578 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01006579 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. This
6580 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode.
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006581
6582 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6583 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6584
6585 Example :
6586 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
6587 backend direct_forward
6588 option httpclose
6589 option http_proxy
6590
6591 See also : "option httpclose"
6592
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006593
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006594option independent-streams
6595no option independent-streams
6596 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02006597 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6598 yes | yes | yes | yes
6599 Arguments : none
6600
6601 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
6602 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
6603 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
6604 receive data or not.
6605
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006606 While this default behavior is desirable for almost all applications, there
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02006607 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
6608 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
6609 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
6610 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
6611 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
6612 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
6613 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
6614 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
6615 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
6616 socket buffers.
6617
6618 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
6619 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
6620 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
6621 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
6622 slow lines, so use it with caution.
6623
Lukas Tribus745f15e2018-11-08 12:41:42 +01006624 Note: older versions used to call this setting "option independant-streams"
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006625 with a spelling mistake. This spelling is still supported but
6626 deprecated.
6627
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02006628 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02006629
6630
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02006631option ldap-check
6632 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
6633 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6634 yes | no | yes | yes
6635 Arguments : none
6636
6637 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
6638 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
6639 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
6640 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
6641
6642 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
6643 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
6644
6645 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
6646 configure it.
6647
6648 Example :
6649 option ldap-check
6650
6651 See also : "option httpchk"
6652
6653
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006654option external-check
6655 Use external processes for server health checks
6656 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6657 yes | no | yes | yes
6658
6659 It is possible to test the health of a server using an external command.
6660 This is achieved by running the executable set using "external-check
6661 command".
6662
6663 Requires the "external-check" global to be set.
6664
6665 See also : "external-check", "external-check command", "external-check path"
6666
6667
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006668option log-health-checks
6669no option log-health-checks
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006670 Enable or disable logging of health checks status updates
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006671 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6672 yes | no | yes | yes
6673 Arguments : none
6674
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006675 By default, failed health check are logged if server is UP and successful
6676 health checks are logged if server is DOWN, so the amount of additional
6677 information is limited.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006678
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006679 When this option is enabled, any change of the health check status or to
6680 the server's health will be logged, so that it becomes possible to know
6681 that a server was failing occasional checks before crashing, or exactly when
6682 it failed to respond a valid HTTP status, then when the port started to
6683 reject connections, then when the server stopped responding at all.
6684
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006685 Note that status changes not caused by health checks (e.g. enable/disable on
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006686 the CLI) are intentionally not logged by this option.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006687
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006688 See also: "option httpchk", "option ldap-check", "option mysql-check",
6689 "option pgsql-check", "option redis-check", "option smtpchk",
6690 "option tcp-check", "log" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006691
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02006692
6693option log-separate-errors
6694no option log-separate-errors
6695 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
6696 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6697 yes | yes | yes | no
6698 Arguments : none
6699
6700 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes haproxy
6701 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
6702 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
6703 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
6704 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
6705 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
6706 provides very important information.
6707
6708 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
6709 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
6710 error logs.
6711
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006712 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02006713 logging.
6714
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006715
6716option logasap
6717no option logasap
6718 Enable or disable early logging of HTTP requests
6719 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6720 yes | yes | yes | no
6721 Arguments : none
6722
6723 By default, HTTP requests are logged upon termination so that the total
6724 transfer time and the number of bytes appear in the logs. When large objects
6725 are being transferred, it may take a while before the request appears in the
6726 logs. Using "option logasap", the request gets logged as soon as the server
6727 sends the complete headers. The only missing information in the logs will be
6728 the total number of bytes which will indicate everything except the amount
6729 of data transferred, and the total time which will not take the transfer
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006730 time into account. In such a situation, it's a good practice to capture the
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006731 "Content-Length" response header so that the logs at least indicate how many
6732 bytes are expected to be transferred.
6733
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01006734 Examples :
6735 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
6736 mode http
6737 option httplog
6738 option logasap
6739 log 192.168.2.200 local3
6740
6741 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
6742 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
6743 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
6744 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
6745
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006746 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006747 logging.
6748
6749
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02006750option mysql-check [ user <username> [ post-41 ] ]
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006751 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01006752 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6753 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006754 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006755 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
6756 server.
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02006757 post-41 Send post v4.1 client compatible checks
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006758
6759 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
6760 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006761 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialization packet and/or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006762 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
6763 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires adding an authorization
6764 in the MySQL table, like this :
6765
6766 USE mysql;
6767 INSERT INTO user (Host,User) values ('<ip_of_haproxy>','<username>');
6768 FLUSH PRIVILEGES;
6769
6770 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006771 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialization packet or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006772 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
6773 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
6774 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
6775 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
6776 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
6777 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
6778 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
6779
6780 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
6781 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01006782
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02006783 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01006784
6785 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
6786 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
6787 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
6788 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02006789 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL
6790 server to route the client via the machine hosting haproxy.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01006791
6792 See also: "option httpchk"
6793
6794
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006795option nolinger
6796no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006797 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006798 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6799 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006800 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006801
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006802 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (e.g. they are
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006803 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
6804 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
6805 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
6806 connections.
6807
6808 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
6809 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
6810 the session is instantly purged from the system's tables. This usually has
6811 side effects such as increased number of TCP resets due to old retransmits
6812 getting immediately rejected. Some firewalls may sometimes complain about
6813 this too.
6814
6815 For this reason, it is not recommended to use this option when not absolutely
6816 needed. You know that you need it when you have thousands of FIN_WAIT1
6817 sessions on your system (TIME_WAIT ones do not count).
6818
6819 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
6820 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
6821 for servers.
6822
6823 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6824 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6825
6826
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006827option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
6828 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
6829 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6830 yes | yes | yes | yes
6831 Arguments :
6832 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
6833 matching <network>
6834 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
6835 header name.
6836
6837 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
6838 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
6839 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
6840 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
6841 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
6842 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
6843 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
6844 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
6845 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
6846 possible that the client has already brought one.
6847
6848 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
6849 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
6850 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
6851 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
6852 header and requires different one.
6853
6854 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
6855 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
6856 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
6857 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
6858 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
6859 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
6860 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
6861
6862 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
6863 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
6864 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
6865 both are defined.
6866
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006867 Examples :
6868 # Original Destination address
6869 frontend www
6870 mode http
6871 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
6872
6873 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
6874 backend www
6875 mode http
6876 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
6877
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006878 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006879
6880
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006881option persist
6882no option persist
6883 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
6884 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6885 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006886 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006887
6888 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
6889 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
6890 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
6891 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
6892 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
6893 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
6894 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
6895 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
6896 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
6897 redirected to another valid server.
6898
6899 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6900 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6901
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01006902 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006903
6904
Willy Tarreau0c122822013-12-15 18:49:01 +01006905option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
6906 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
6907 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6908 yes | no | yes | yes
6909 Arguments :
6910 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
6911 PostgreSQL server.
6912
6913 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
6914 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
6915 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
6916 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
6917
6918 See also: "option httpchk"
6919
6920
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01006921option prefer-last-server
6922no option prefer-last-server
6923 Allow multiple load balanced requests to remain on the same server
6924 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6925 yes | no | yes | yes
6926 Arguments : none
6927
6928 When the load balancing algorithm in use is not deterministic, and a previous
6929 request was sent to a server to which haproxy still holds a connection, it is
6930 sometimes desirable that subsequent requests on a same session go to the same
6931 server as much as possible. Note that this is different from persistence, as
6932 we only indicate a preference which haproxy tries to apply without any form
6933 of warranty. The real use is for keep-alive connections sent to servers. When
6934 this option is used, haproxy will try to reuse the same connection that is
6935 attached to the server instead of rebalancing to another server, causing a
6936 close of the connection. This can make sense for static file servers. It does
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01006937 not make much sense to use this in combination with hashing algorithms. Note,
6938 haproxy already automatically tries to stick to a server which sends a 401 or
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02006939 to a proxy which sends a 407 (authentication required), when the load
6940 balancing algorithm is not deterministic. This is mandatory for use with the
6941 broken NTLM authentication challenge, and significantly helps in
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01006942 troubleshooting some faulty applications. Option prefer-last-server might be
6943 desirable in these environments as well, to avoid redistributing the traffic
6944 after every other response.
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01006945
6946 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6947 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6948
6949 See also: "option http-keep-alive"
6950
6951
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006952option redispatch
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07006953option redispatch <interval>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006954no option redispatch
6955 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
6956 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6957 yes | no | yes | yes
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07006958 Arguments :
6959 <interval> The optional integer value that controls how often redispatches
6960 occur when retrying connections. Positive value P indicates a
6961 redispatch is desired on every Pth retry, and negative value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006962 N indicate a redispatch is desired on the Nth retry prior to the
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07006963 last retry. For example, the default of -1 preserves the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006964 historical behavior of redispatching on the last retry, a
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07006965 positive value of 1 would indicate a redispatch on every retry,
6966 and a positive value of 3 would indicate a redispatch on every
6967 third retry. You can disable redispatches with a value of 0.
6968
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006969
6970 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
6971 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
6972 be able to access the service anymore.
6973
Willy Tarreau59884a62019-01-02 14:48:31 +01006974 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break cookie or
6975 consistent hash based persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006976
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07006977 It also allows to retry connections to another server in case of multiple
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006978 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
6979 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006980
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006981 This form is the preferred form, which replaces both the "redispatch" and
6982 "redisp" keywords.
6983
6984 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6985 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6986
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01006987 See also : "redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006988
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006989
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02006990option redis-check
6991 Use redis health checks for server testing
6992 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6993 yes | no | yes | yes
6994 Arguments : none
6995
6996 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
6997 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
6998 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
6999 find the "+PONG" response message.
7000
7001 Example :
7002 option redis-check
7003
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03007004 See also : "option httpchk", "option tcp-check", "tcp-check expect"
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02007005
7006
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007007option smtpchk
7008option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
7009 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
7010 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7011 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007012 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007013 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02007014 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESMTP). All other
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007015 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
7016
7017 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
7018 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
7019 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
7020
7021 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
7022 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
7023 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
7024 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
7025 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
7026 dead server.
7027
7028 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
7029 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007030 so you may want to experiment to improve the behavior. Using telnet on port
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007031 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
7032
7033 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
7034 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
7035 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
7036 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02007037 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007038
7039 Example :
7040 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
7041
7042 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
7043
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007044
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02007045option socket-stats
7046no option socket-stats
7047
7048 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
7049 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7050 yes | yes | yes | no
7051
7052 Arguments : none
7053
7054
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01007055option splice-auto
7056no option splice-auto
7057 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
7058 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7059 yes | yes | yes | yes
7060 Arguments : none
7061
7062 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
7063 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007064 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. HAProxy
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01007065 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007066 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01007067 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
7068 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
7069 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
7070 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
7071
7072 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
7073 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
7074 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
7075 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
7076 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
7077 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
7078 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
7079 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
7080 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
7081 keyword.
7082
7083 Example :
7084 option splice-auto
7085
7086 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7087 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7088
7089 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
7090 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
7091
7092
7093option splice-request
7094no option splice-request
7095 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
7096 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7097 yes | yes | yes | yes
7098 Arguments : none
7099
7100 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007101 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01007102 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
7103 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
7104 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
7105 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
7106
7107 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
7108
7109 Example :
7110 option splice-request
7111
7112 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7113 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7114
7115 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
7116 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
7117
7118
7119option splice-response
7120no option splice-response
7121 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
7122 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7123 yes | yes | yes | yes
7124 Arguments : none
7125
7126 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007127 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01007128 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
7129 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
7130 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
7131 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
7132
7133 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
7134
7135 Example :
7136 option splice-response
7137
7138 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7139 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7140
7141 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
7142 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
7143
7144
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01007145option spop-check
7146 Use SPOP health checks for server testing
7147 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7148 no | no | no | yes
7149 Arguments : none
7150
7151 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks SPOP protocol instead
7152 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
7153 a HELLO handshake is performed between HAProxy and the server, and the
7154 response is analyzed to check no error is reported.
7155
7156 Example :
7157 option spop-check
7158
7159 See also : "option httpchk"
7160
7161
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007162option srvtcpka
7163no option srvtcpka
7164 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
7165 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7166 yes | no | yes | yes
7167 Arguments : none
7168
7169 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
7170 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007171 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007172 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
7173
7174 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
7175 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
7176 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
7177 operating system and its tuning parameters.
7178
7179 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
7180 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
7181 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
7182 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
7183 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
7184
7185 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
7186
7187 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
7188 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
7189 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
7190
7191 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7192 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7193
7194 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
7195
7196
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007197option ssl-hello-chk
7198 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
7199 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7200 yes | no | yes | yes
7201 Arguments : none
7202
7203 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
7204 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
7205 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
7206 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
7207 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
7208 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
7209 hello message.
7210
7211 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
7212 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
7213 messages, which is appreciable.
7214
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007215 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into haproxy
7216 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
7217 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007218
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007219 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
7220
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007221
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007222option tcp-check
7223 Perform health checks using tcp-check send/expect sequences
7224 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7225 yes | no | yes | yes
7226
7227 This health check method is intended to be combined with "tcp-check" command
7228 lists in order to support send/expect types of health check sequences.
7229
7230 TCP checks currently support 4 modes of operations :
7231 - no "tcp-check" directive : the health check only consists in a connection
7232 attempt, which remains the default mode.
7233
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007234 - "tcp-check send" or "tcp-check send-binary" only is mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007235 used to send a string along with a connection opening. With some
7236 protocols, it helps sending a "QUIT" message for example that prevents
7237 the server from logging a connection error for each health check. The
7238 check result will still be based on the ability to open the connection
7239 only.
7240
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007241 - "tcp-check expect" only is mentioned : this is used to test a banner.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007242 The connection is opened and haproxy waits for the server to present some
7243 contents which must validate some rules. The check result will be based
7244 on the matching between the contents and the rules. This is suited for
7245 POP, IMAP, SMTP, FTP, SSH, TELNET.
7246
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007247 - both "tcp-check send" and "tcp-check expect" are mentioned : this is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007248 used to test a hello-type protocol. HAProxy sends a message, the server
7249 responds and its response is analyzed. the check result will be based on
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007250 the matching between the response contents and the rules. This is often
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007251 suited for protocols which require a binding or a request/response model.
7252 LDAP, MySQL, Redis and SSL are example of such protocols, though they
7253 already all have their dedicated checks with a deeper understanding of
7254 the respective protocols.
7255 In this mode, many questions may be sent and many answers may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007256 analyzed.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007257
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007258 A fifth mode can be used to insert comments in different steps of the
7259 script.
7260
7261 For each tcp-check rule you create, you can add a "comment" directive,
7262 followed by a string. This string will be reported in the log and stderr
7263 in debug mode. It is useful to make user-friendly error reporting.
7264 The "comment" is of course optional.
7265
7266
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007267 Examples :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007268 # perform a POP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007269 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007270 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready comment POP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007271
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007272 # perform an IMAP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007273 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007274 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready comment IMAP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007275
7276 # look for the redis master server after ensuring it speaks well
7277 # redis protocol, then it exits properly.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007278 # (send a command then analyze the response 3 times)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007279 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007280 tcp-check comment PING\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007281 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02007282 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007283 tcp-check comment role\ check
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007284 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
7285 tcp-check expect string role:master
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007286 tcp-check comment QUIT\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007287 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
7288 tcp-check expect string +OK
7289
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007290 forge a HTTP request, then analyze the response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007291 (send many headers before analyzing)
7292 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007293 tcp-check comment forge\ and\ send\ HTTP\ request
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007294 tcp-check send HEAD\ /\ HTTP/1.1\r\n
7295 tcp-check send Host:\ www.mydomain.com\r\n
7296 tcp-check send User-Agent:\ HAProxy\ tcpcheck\r\n
7297 tcp-check send \r\n
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007298 tcp-check expect rstring HTTP/1\..\ (2..|3..) comment check\ HTTP\ response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007299
7300
7301 See also : "tcp-check expect", "tcp-check send"
7302
7303
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02007304option tcp-smart-accept
7305no option tcp-smart-accept
7306 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
7307 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7308 yes | yes | yes | no
7309 Arguments : none
7310
7311 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
7312 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
7313 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
7314 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
7315 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
7316 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
7317
7318 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
7319 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
7320 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
7321 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
7322
7323 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
7324 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
7325 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007326 fall back to normal behavior by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02007327
7328 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
7329 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
7330 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
7331
7332 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
7333 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
7334 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
7335
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02007336 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
7337
7338
7339option tcp-smart-connect
7340no option tcp-smart-connect
7341 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
7342 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7343 yes | no | yes | yes
7344 Arguments : none
7345
7346 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
7347 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
7348 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
7349 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
7350 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
7351
7352 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
7353 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
7354 complex.
7355
7356 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
7357 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
7358 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
7359
7360 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7361 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7362
7363 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
7364
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02007365
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007366option tcpka
7367 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
7368 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7369 yes | yes | yes | yes
7370 Arguments : none
7371
7372 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
7373 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007374 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007375 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
7376
7377 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
7378 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
7379 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
7380 operating system and its tuning parameters.
7381
7382 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
7383 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
7384 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
7385 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
7386 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
7387
7388 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
7389
7390 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
7391 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
7392 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
7393 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
7394 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
7395 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
7396 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
7397 backends.
7398
7399 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
7400
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007401
7402option tcplog
7403 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
7404 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01007405 yes | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007406 Arguments : none
7407
7408 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
7409 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
7410 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
7411 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
7412 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
7413 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
7414 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
7415 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
7416
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02007417 "option tcplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
7418
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007419 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007420
7421
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007422option transparent
7423no option transparent
7424 Enable client-side transparent proxying
7425 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01007426 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007427 Arguments : none
7428
7429 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
7430 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
7431 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
7432 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
7433 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
7434 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
7435 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
7436 appropriate server.
7437
7438 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
7439 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
7440
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01007441 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007442 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007443
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007444
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007445external-check command <command>
7446 Executable to run when performing an external-check
7447 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7448 yes | no | yes | yes
7449
7450 Arguments :
7451 <command> is the external command to run
7452
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007453 The arguments passed to the to the command are:
7454
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01007455 <proxy_address> <proxy_port> <server_address> <server_port>
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007456
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01007457 The <proxy_address> and <proxy_port> are derived from the first listener
7458 that is either IPv4, IPv6 or a UNIX socket. In the case of a UNIX socket
7459 listener the proxy_address will be the path of the socket and the
7460 <proxy_port> will be the string "NOT_USED". In a backend section, it's not
7461 possible to determine a listener, and both <proxy_address> and <proxy_port>
7462 will have the string value "NOT_USED".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007463
Cyril Bonté72cda2a2014-12-27 22:28:39 +01007464 Some values are also provided through environment variables.
7465
7466 Environment variables :
7467 HAPROXY_PROXY_ADDR The first bind address if available (or empty if not
7468 applicable, for example in a "backend" section).
7469
7470 HAPROXY_PROXY_ID The backend id.
7471
7472 HAPROXY_PROXY_NAME The backend name.
7473
7474 HAPROXY_PROXY_PORT The first bind port if available (or empty if not
7475 applicable, for example in a "backend" section or
7476 for a UNIX socket).
7477
7478 HAPROXY_SERVER_ADDR The server address.
7479
7480 HAPROXY_SERVER_CURCONN The current number of connections on the server.
7481
7482 HAPROXY_SERVER_ID The server id.
7483
7484 HAPROXY_SERVER_MAXCONN The server max connections.
7485
7486 HAPROXY_SERVER_NAME The server name.
7487
7488 HAPROXY_SERVER_PORT The server port if available (or empty for a UNIX
7489 socket).
7490
7491 PATH The PATH environment variable used when executing
7492 the command may be set using "external-check path".
7493
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007494 If the command executed and exits with a zero status then the check is
7495 considered to have passed, otherwise the check is considered to have
7496 failed.
7497
7498 Example :
7499 external-check command /bin/true
7500
7501 See also : "external-check", "option external-check", "external-check path"
7502
7503
7504external-check path <path>
7505 The value of the PATH environment variable used when running an external-check
7506 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7507 yes | no | yes | yes
7508
7509 Arguments :
7510 <path> is the path used when executing external command to run
7511
7512 The default path is "".
7513
7514 Example :
7515 external-check path "/usr/bin:/bin"
7516
7517 See also : "external-check", "option external-check",
7518 "external-check command"
7519
7520
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007521persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007522persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007523 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
7524 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7525 yes | no | yes | yes
7526 Arguments :
7527 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02007528 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
7529 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007530
7531 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
7532 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007533 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analyzed
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007534 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
7535 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
7536 forwarded to this server.
7537
7538 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
7539 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
7540 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007541 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007542 a single "listen" section.
7543
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02007544 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
7545 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
7546 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
7547
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007548 Example :
7549 listen tse-farm
7550 bind :3389
7551 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
7552 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
7553 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
7554 # apply RDP cookie persistence
7555 persist rdp-cookie
7556 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02007557 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007558 balance rdp-cookie
7559 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
7560 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
7561
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09007562 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request", the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL and
7563 the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007564
7565
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01007566rate-limit sessions <rate>
7567 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
7568 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7569 yes | yes | yes | no
7570 Arguments :
7571 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
7572 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
7573
7574 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
7575 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
7576 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
7577 (in system buffers) and haproxy will not even be aware that sessions are
7578 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
7579 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
7580
7581 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
7582 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
7583 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
7584 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
7585
7586 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
7587 listen smtp
7588 mode tcp
7589 bind :25
7590 rate-limit sessions 10
Panagiotis Panagiotopoulos7282d8e2016-02-11 16:37:15 +02007591 server smtp1 127.0.0.1:1025
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01007592
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +02007593 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
7594 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
7595 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01007596
7597 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
7598
7599
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007600redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
7601redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
7602redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007603 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
7604 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7605 no | yes | yes | yes
7606
7607 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01007608 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007609
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007610 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007611 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007612 the HTTP "Location" header. When used in an "http-request" rule,
7613 <loc> value follows the log-format rules and can include some
7614 dynamic values (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007615
7616 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
7617 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
7618 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
7619 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
7620 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007621 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie). When
7622 used in an "http-request" rule, <pfx> value follows the log-format
7623 rules and can include some dynamic values (see Custom Log Format
7624 in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007625
7626 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
7627 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
7628 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
7629 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
7630 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
7631 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007632 returned, which most recent browsers interpret as redirecting to
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007633 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007634 HTTPS. When used in an "http-request" rule, <sch> value follows
7635 the log-format rules and can include some dynamic values (see
7636 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007637
7638 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01007639 is desired. Only codes 301, 302, 303, 307 and 308 are supported,
7640 with 302 used by default if no code is specified. 301 means
7641 "Moved permanently", and a browser may cache the Location. 302
Baptiste Assmannea849c02015-08-03 11:42:50 +02007642 means "Moved temporarily" and means that the browser should not
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01007643 cache the redirection. 303 is equivalent to 302 except that the
7644 browser will fetch the location with a GET method. 307 is just
7645 like 302 but makes it clear that the same method must be reused.
7646 Likewise, 308 replaces 301 if the same method must be used.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007647
7648 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007649 expected behavior of a redirection :
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007650
7651 - "drop-query"
7652 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
7653 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
7654 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
7655 with a location-type redirect.
7656
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01007657 - "append-slash"
7658 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
7659 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
7660 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
7661 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
7662
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007663 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
7664 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
7665 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
7666 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
7667 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
7668 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
7669 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
7670
7671 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
7672 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
7673 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
7674 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
7675 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
7676 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
7677 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007678
7679 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
7680 acl clear dst_port 80
7681 acl secure dst_port 8080
7682 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007683 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01007684 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007685 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
7686
7687 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01007688 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
7689 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
7690 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007691 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007692
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01007693 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
7694 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
7695 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
7696
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007697 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by haproxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +01007698 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007699
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007700 Example: append 'www.' prefix in front of all hosts not having it
Coen Rosdorff596659b2016-04-11 11:33:49 +02007701 http-request redirect code 301 location \
7702 http://www.%[hdr(host)]%[capture.req.uri] \
7703 unless { hdr_beg(host) -i www }
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007704
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007705 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007706
7707
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007708redisp (deprecated)
7709redispatch (deprecated)
7710 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
7711 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7712 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007713 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007714
7715 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
7716 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
7717 be able to access the service anymore.
7718
7719 Specifying "redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their persistence and
7720 redistribute them to a working server.
7721
7722 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
7723 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
7724 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007725
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007726 This form is deprecated, do not use it in any new configuration, use the new
7727 "option redispatch" instead.
7728
7729 See also : "option redispatch"
7730
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007731
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01007732reqadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007733 Add a header at the end of the HTTP request
7734 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7735 no | yes | yes | yes
7736 Arguments :
7737 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
7738 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007739 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007740
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01007741 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7742 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7743
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007744 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
7745 the last header of an HTTP request.
7746
7747 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7748 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7749 responses.
7750
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01007751 Example : add "X-Proto: SSL" to requests coming via port 81
7752 acl is-ssl dst_port 81
7753 reqadd X-Proto:\ SSL if is-ssl
7754
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007755 See also: "rspadd", "http-request", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation,
7756 and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007757
7758
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007759reqallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7760reqiallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007761 Definitely allow an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
7762 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7763 no | yes | yes | yes
7764 Arguments :
7765 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7766 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7767 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7768 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7769 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
7770 "reqallow" keyword strictly matches case while "reqiallow"
7771 ignores case.
7772
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007773 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7774 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7775
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007776 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
7777 <search> will mark the request as allowed, even if any later test would
7778 result in a deny. The test applies both to the request line and to request
7779 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007780 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007781
7782 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
7783 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
7784
7785 Example :
7786 # allow www.* but refuse *.local
7787 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
7788 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
7789
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007790 See also: "reqdeny", "block", "http-request", section 6 about HTTP header
7791 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007792
7793
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007794reqdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7795reqidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007796 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP request
7797 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7798 no | yes | yes | yes
7799 Arguments :
7800 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7801 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7802 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7803 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7804 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqdel"
7805 keyword strictly matches case while "reqidel" ignores case.
7806
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007807 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7808 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7809
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007810 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request
7811 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
7812 and/or dangerous headers or cookies from a request before passing it to the
7813 next servers.
7814
7815 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7816 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7817 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
7818
7819 Example :
7820 # remove X-Forwarded-For header and SERVER cookie
7821 reqidel ^X-Forwarded-For:.*
7822 reqidel ^Cookie:.*SERVER=
7823
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007824 See also: "reqadd", "reqrep", "rspdel", "http-request", section 6 about
7825 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007826
7827
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007828reqdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7829reqideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007830 Deny an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
7831 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7832 no | yes | yes | yes
7833 Arguments :
7834 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7835 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7836 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7837 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7838 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
7839 "reqdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "reqideny" ignores
7840 case.
7841
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007842 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7843 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7844
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007845 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
7846 <search> will mark the request as denied, even if any later test would
7847 result in an allow. The test applies both to the request line and to request
7848 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007849 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007850
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007851 A denied request will generate an "HTTP 403 forbidden" response once the
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007852 complete request has been parsed. This is consistent with what is practiced
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007853 using ACLs.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007854
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007855 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
7856 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
7857
7858 Example :
7859 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*
7860 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
7861 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
7862
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007863 See also: "reqallow", "rspdeny", "block", "http-request", section 6 about
7864 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007865
7866
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007867reqpass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7868reqipass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007869 Ignore any HTTP request line matching a regular expression in next rules
7870 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7871 no | yes | yes | yes
7872 Arguments :
7873 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7874 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7875 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7876 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7877 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
7878 "reqpass" keyword strictly matches case while "reqipass" ignores
7879 case.
7880
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007881 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7882 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7883
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007884 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
7885 <search> will skip next rules, without assigning any deny or allow verdict.
7886 The test applies both to the request line and to request headers. Keep in
7887 mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
7888
7889 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
7890 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
7891
7892 Example :
7893 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*, but ignore "www.private.local"
7894 reqipass ^Host:\ www.private\.local
7895 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
7896 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
7897
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007898 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "block", "http-request", section 6 about
7899 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007900
7901
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007902reqrep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7903reqirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007904 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP request line
7905 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7906 no | yes | yes | yes
7907 Arguments :
7908 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7909 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7910 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7911 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7912 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqrep"
7913 keyword strictly matches case while "reqirep" ignores case.
7914
7915 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
7916 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
7917 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
7918 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007919 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007920
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007921 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7922 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7923
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007924 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request (both
7925 the request line and header lines) will be completely replaced with <string>.
7926 Most common use of this is to rewrite URLs or domain names in "Host" headers.
7927
7928 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7929 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7930 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
7931 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that URLs in
7932 request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
7933
7934 Example :
7935 # replace "/static/" with "/" at the beginning of any request path.
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04007936 reqrep ^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*) \1\ /\2
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007937 # replace "www.mydomain.com" with "www" in the host name.
7938 reqirep ^Host:\ www.mydomain.com Host:\ www
7939
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007940 See also: "reqadd", "reqdel", "rsprep", "tune.bufsize", "http-request",
7941 section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007942
7943
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007944reqtarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7945reqitarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007946 Tarpit an HTTP request containing a line matching a regular expression
7947 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7948 no | yes | yes | yes
7949 Arguments :
7950 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7951 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7952 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7953 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7954 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
7955 "reqtarpit" keyword strictly matches case while "reqitarpit"
7956 ignores case.
7957
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007958 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7959 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7960
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007961 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
7962 <search> will be tarpitted, which means that it will connect to nowhere, will
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007963 be kept open for a pre-defined time, then will return an HTTP error 500 so
7964 that the attacker does not suspect it has been tarpitted. The status 500 will
7965 be reported in the logs, but the completion flags will indicate "PT". The
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007966 delay is defined by "timeout tarpit", or "timeout connect" if the former is
7967 not set.
7968
7969 The goal of the tarpit is to slow down robots attacking servers with
7970 identifiable requests. Many robots limit their outgoing number of connections
7971 and stay connected waiting for a reply which can take several minutes to
7972 come. Depending on the environment and attack, it may be particularly
7973 efficient at reducing the load on the network and firewalls.
7974
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007975 Examples :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007976 # ignore user-agents reporting any flavor of "Mozilla" or "MSIE", but
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007977 # block all others.
7978 reqipass ^User-Agent:\.*(Mozilla|MSIE)
7979 reqitarpit ^User-Agent:
7980
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007981 # block bad guys
7982 acl badguys src 10.1.0.3 172.16.13.20/28
7983 reqitarpit . if badguys
7984
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007985 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "reqpass", "http-request", section 6
7986 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007987
7988
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02007989retries <value>
7990 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
7991 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7992 yes | no | yes | yes
7993 Arguments :
7994 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
7995 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
7996 default value is 3.
7997
7998 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
7999 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
8000 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
8001
8002 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07008003 a turn-around timer of min("timeout connect", one second) is applied before
8004 a retry occurs.
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02008005
8006 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
8007 server even if a cookie references a different server.
8008
8009 See also : "option redispatch"
8010
8011
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02008012retry-on [list of keywords]
8013 Specify when to attempt to automatically retry a failed request
8014 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8015 yes | no | yes | yes
8016 Arguments :
8017 <keywords> is a list of keywords or HTTP status codes, each representing a
8018 type of failure event on which an attempt to retry the request
8019 is desired. Please read the notes at the bottom before changing
8020 this setting. The following keywords are supported :
8021
8022 none never retry
8023
8024 conn-failure retry when the connection or the SSL handshake failed
8025 and the request could not be sent. This is the default.
8026
8027 empty-response retry when the server connection was closed after part
8028 of the request was sent, and nothing was received from
8029 the server. This type of failure may be caused by the
8030 request timeout on the server side, poor network
8031 condition, or a server crash or restart while
8032 processing the request.
8033
Olivier Houcharde3249a92019-05-03 23:01:47 +02008034 junk-response retry when the server returned something not looking
8035 like a complete HTTP response. This includes partial
8036 responses headers as well as non-HTTP contents. It
8037 usually is a bad idea to retry on such events, which
8038 may be caused a configuration issue (wrong server port)
8039 or by the request being harmful to the server (buffer
8040 overflow attack for example).
8041
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02008042 response-timeout the server timeout stroke while waiting for the server
8043 to respond to the request. This may be caused by poor
8044 network condition, the reuse of an idle connection
8045 which has expired on the path, or by the request being
8046 extremely expensive to process. It generally is a bad
8047 idea to retry on such events on servers dealing with
8048 heavy database processing (full scans, etc) as it may
8049 amplify denial of service attacks.
8050
Olivier Houchard865d8392019-05-03 22:46:27 +02008051 0rtt-rejected retry requests which were sent over early data and were
8052 rejected by the server. These requests are generally
8053 considered to be safe to retry.
8054
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02008055 <status> any HTTP status code among "404" (Not Found), "408"
8056 (Request Timeout), "425" (Too Early), "500" (Server
8057 Error), "501" (Not Implemented), "502" (Bad Gateway),
8058 "503" (Service Unavailable), "504" (Gateway Timeout).
8059
8060 Using this directive replaces any previous settings with the new ones; it is
8061 not cumulative.
8062
8063 Please note that using anything other than "none" and "conn-failure" requires
8064 to allocate a buffer and copy the whole request into it, so it has memory and
8065 performance impacts. Requests not fitting in a single buffer will never be
8066 retried (see the global tune.bufsize setting).
8067
8068 You have to make sure the application has a replay protection mechanism built
8069 in such as a unique transaction IDs passed in requests, or that replaying the
8070 same request has no consequence, or it is very dangerous to use any retry-on
8071 value beside "conn-failure" and "none". Static file servers and caches are
8072 generally considered safe against any type of retry. Using a status code can
8073 be useful to quickly leave a server showing an abnormal behavior (out of
8074 memory, file system issues, etc), but in this case it may be a good idea to
8075 immediately redispatch the connection to another server (please see "option
8076 redispatch" for this). Last, it is important to understand that most causes
8077 of failures are the requests themselves and that retrying a request causing a
8078 server to misbehave will often make the situation even worse for this server,
8079 or for the whole service in case of redispatch.
8080
8081 Unless you know exactly how the application deals with replayed requests, you
8082 should not use this directive.
8083
8084 The default is "conn-failure".
8085
8086 See also: "retries", "option redispatch", "tune.bufsize"
8087
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01008088rspadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008089 Add a header at the end of the HTTP response
8090 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8091 no | yes | yes | yes
8092 Arguments :
8093 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
8094 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008095 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008096
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01008097 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
8098 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
8099
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008100 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
8101 the last header of an HTTP response.
8102
8103 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
8104 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
8105 responses.
8106
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08008107 See also: "rspdel" "reqadd", "http-response", section 6 about HTTP header
8108 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008109
8110
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01008111rspdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
8112rspidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008113 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP response
8114 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8115 no | yes | yes | yes
8116 Arguments :
8117 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
8118 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
8119 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
8120 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
8121 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
8122 The "rspdel" keyword strictly matches case while "rspidel"
8123 ignores case.
8124
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01008125 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
8126 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
8127
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008128 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response
8129 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02008130 and/or sensitive headers or cookies from a response before passing it to the
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008131 client.
8132
8133 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
8134 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
8135 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
8136
8137 Example :
8138 # remove the Server header from responses
Willy Tarreau5e80e022013-05-25 08:31:25 +02008139 rspidel ^Server:.*
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008140
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08008141 See also: "rspadd", "rsprep", "reqdel", "http-response", section 6 about
8142 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008143
8144
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01008145rspdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
8146rspideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008147 Block an HTTP response if a line matches a regular expression
8148 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8149 no | yes | yes | yes
8150 Arguments :
8151 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
8152 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
8153 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
8154 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
8155 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
8156 The "rspdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "rspideny"
8157 ignores case.
8158
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01008159 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
8160 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
8161
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008162 A response containing any line which matches extended regular expression
8163 <search> will mark the request as denied. The test applies both to the
8164 response line and to response headers. Keep in mind that header names are not
8165 case-sensitive.
8166
8167 Main use of this keyword is to prevent sensitive information leak and to
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008168 block the response before it reaches the client. If a response is denied, it
8169 will be replaced with an HTTP 502 error so that the client never retrieves
8170 any sensitive data.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008171
8172 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
8173 Rspdeny should be avoided in new designs.
8174
8175 Example :
8176 # Ensure that no content type matching ms-word will leak
8177 rspideny ^Content-type:\.*/ms-word
8178
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08008179 See also: "reqdeny", "acl", "block", "http-response", section 6 about
8180 HTTP header manipulation and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008181
8182
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01008183rsprep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
8184rspirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008185 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP response line
8186 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8187 no | yes | yes | yes
8188 Arguments :
8189 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
8190 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
8191 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
8192 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
8193 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
8194 The "rsprep" keyword strictly matches case while "rspirep"
8195 ignores case.
8196
8197 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
8198 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
8199 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
8200 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008201 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008202
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01008203 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
8204 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
8205
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008206 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response (both
8207 the response line and header lines) will be completely replaced with
8208 <string>. Most common use of this is to rewrite Location headers.
8209
8210 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
8211 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
8212 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
8213 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that header names
8214 are not case-sensitive.
8215
8216 Example :
8217 # replace "Location: 127.0.0.1:8080" with "Location: www.mydomain.com"
8218 rspirep ^Location:\ 127.0.0.1:8080 Location:\ www.mydomain.com
8219
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08008220 See also: "rspadd", "rspdel", "reqrep", "http-response", section 6 about
8221 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008222
8223
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01008224server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008225 Declare a server in a backend
8226 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8227 no | no | yes | yes
8228 Arguments :
8229 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008230 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05008231 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008232
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01008233 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
8234 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
8235 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
8236 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +02008237 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
8238 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
8239 intercepted and haproxy must forward to the original destination
8240 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
8241 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01008242 to report statistics. Optionally, an address family prefix may be
8243 used before the address to force the family regardless of the
8244 address format, which can be useful to specify a path to a unix
8245 socket with no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
8246 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
8247 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
8248 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02008249 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +02008250 - 'sockpair@' -> address is the FD of a connected unix
8251 socket or of a socketpair. During a connection, the
8252 backend creates a pair of connected sockets, and passes
8253 one of them over the FD. The bind part will use the
8254 received socket as the client FD. Should be used
8255 carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02008256 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
8257 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +01008258 variables. The "init-addr" setting can be used to modify the way
8259 IP addresses should be resolved upon startup.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008260
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008261 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008262 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
8263 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
8264 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
8265 adding this value to the client's port.
8266
8267 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
8268 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008269 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008270
8271 Examples :
8272 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
8273 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01008274 server transp ipv4@
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02008275 server backup "${SRV_BACKUP}:1080" backup
8276 server www1_dc1 "${LAN_DC1}.101:80"
8277 server www1_dc2 "${LAN_DC2}.101:80"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008278
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02008279 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
8280 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
8281 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
8282 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
8283 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
8284
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05008285 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
8286 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008287
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02008288server-state-file-name [<file>]
8289 Set the server state file to read, load and apply to servers available in
8290 this backend. It only applies when the directive "load-server-state-from-file"
8291 is set to "local". When <file> is not provided or if this directive is not
8292 set, then backend name is used. If <file> starts with a slash '/', then it is
8293 considered as an absolute path. Otherwise, <file> is concatenated to the
8294 global directive "server-state-file-base".
8295
8296 Example: the minimal configuration below would make HAProxy look for the
8297 state server file '/etc/haproxy/states/bk':
8298
8299 global
8300 server-state-file-base /etc/haproxy/states
8301
8302 backend bk
8303 load-server-state-from-file
8304
8305 See also: "server-state-file-base", "load-server-state-from-file", and
8306 "show servers state"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008307
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02008308server-template <prefix> <num | range> <fqdn>[:<port>] [params*]
8309 Set a template to initialize servers with shared parameters.
8310 The names of these servers are built from <prefix> and <num | range> parameters.
8311 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8312 no | no | yes | yes
8313
8314 Arguments:
8315 <prefix> A prefix for the server names to be built.
8316
8317 <num | range>
8318 If <num> is provided, this template initializes <num> servers
8319 with 1 up to <num> as server name suffixes. A range of numbers
8320 <num_low>-<num_high> may also be used to use <num_low> up to
8321 <num_high> as server name suffixes.
8322
8323 <fqdn> A FQDN for all the servers this template initializes.
8324
8325 <port> Same meaning as "server" <port> argument (see "server" keyword).
8326
8327 <params*>
8328 Remaining server parameters among all those supported by "server"
8329 keyword.
8330
8331 Examples:
8332 # Initializes 3 servers with srv1, srv2 and srv3 as names,
8333 # google.com as FQDN, and health-check enabled.
8334 server-template srv 1-3 google.com:80 check
8335
8336 # or
8337 server-template srv 3 google.com:80 check
8338
8339 # would be equivalent to:
8340 server srv1 google.com:80 check
8341 server srv2 google.com:80 check
8342 server srv3 google.com:80 check
8343
8344
8345
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008346source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008347source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01008348source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008349 Set the source address for outgoing connections
8350 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8351 yes | no | yes | yes
8352 Arguments :
8353 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
8354 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01008355
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008356 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01008357 the most appropriate address to reach its destination. Optionally
8358 an address family prefix may be used before the address to force
8359 the family regardless of the address format, which can be useful
8360 to specify a path to a unix socket with no slash ('/'). Currently
8361 supported prefixes are :
8362 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
8363 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
8364 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02008365 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02008366 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
8367 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008368
8369 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
8370 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02008371 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
8372 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
8373 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008374
8375 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
8376 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
8377 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
8378 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
8379 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
8380 <addr>.
8381
8382 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
8383 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
8384 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
8385 port.
8386
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008387 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
8388 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
8389 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
8390 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +01008391 and to automatically bind to the client's IP address as seen
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008392 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
8393 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
8394 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
8395 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
8396 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
8397 HTTP header.
8398
8399 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
8400 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008401 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008402 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
8403 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
8404 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
8405 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
8406 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
8407 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
8408 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
8409
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01008410 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
8411 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
8412 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
8413 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
8414 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
8415 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
8416
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008417 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
8418 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
8419 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
8420 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
8421
8422 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
8423 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
8424 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
8425 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
8426 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
8427 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
8428
8429 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
8430 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
8431 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
8432 there are two methods :
8433
8434 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
8435 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
8436 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
8437 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
8438 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
8439 of the client ranges may be used.
8440
8441 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
8442 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
8443 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
8444 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
8445 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
8446 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
8447 same session.
8448
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008449 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
8450 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
8451 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008452 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008453
Baptiste Assmann91bd3372015-07-17 21:59:42 +02008454 In order to work, "usesrc" requires root privileges.
8455
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008456 Examples :
8457 backend private
8458 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
8459 source 192.168.1.200
8460
8461 backend transparent_ssl1
8462 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
8463 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
8464
8465 backend transparent_ssl2
8466 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
8467 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
8468 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
8469
8470 backend transparent_ssl3
8471 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
8472 # is more conntrack-friendly.
8473 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
8474
8475 backend transparent_smtp
8476 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
8477 # with Tproxy version 4.
8478 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
8479
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008480 backend transparent_http
8481 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
8482 # proxy.
8483 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
8484
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008485 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008486 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
8487
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008488
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008489srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
8490 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
8491 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8492 yes | no | yes | yes
8493 Arguments :
8494 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
8495 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8496 as explained at the top of this document.
8497
8498 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
8499 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
8500 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
8501 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
8502 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
8503 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
8504 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
8505
8506 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
8507 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
8508 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
8509 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
8510 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01008511 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008512 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008513 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008514
8515 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
8516 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
8517 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
8518 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
8519 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
8520 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
8521
8522 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
8523 Please use "timeout server" instead.
8524
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008525 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout client" and
8526 "clitimeout".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008527
8528
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02008529stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
8530 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
8531 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008532 no | yes | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02008533
8534 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
8535 matched.
8536
8537 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
8538 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
8539
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008540 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
8541 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008542 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008543
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +01008544 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
8545 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
8546 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
8547 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02008548
8549 Example :
8550 # statistics admin level only for localhost
8551 backend stats_localhost
8552 stats enable
8553 stats admin if LOCALHOST
8554
8555 Example :
8556 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
8557 backend stats_auth
8558 stats enable
8559 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
8560 stats admin if TRUE
8561
8562 Example :
8563 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
8564 userlist stats-auth
8565 group admin users admin
8566 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
8567 group readonly users haproxy
8568 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
8569
8570 backend stats_auth
8571 stats enable
8572 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
8573 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
8574 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
8575 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
8576
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008577 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", "nbproc",
8578 "bind-process", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
8579 ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02008580
8581
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008582stats auth <user>:<passwd>
8583 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
8584 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008585 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008586 Arguments :
8587 <user> is a user name to grant access to
8588
8589 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
8590
8591 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
8592 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
8593 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
8594 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
8595 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
8596 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
8597
8598 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
8599 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
8600 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02008601 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008602
8603 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
8604 report using "stats scope".
8605
8606 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8607 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8608 unobvious parameters.
8609
8610 Example :
8611 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8612 backend public_www
8613 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8614 stats enable
8615 stats hide-version
8616 stats scope .
8617 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008618 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008619 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8620 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8621
8622 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8623 backend private_monitoring
8624 stats enable
8625 stats uri /admin?stats
8626 stats refresh 5s
8627
8628 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
8629
8630
8631stats enable
8632 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
8633 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008634 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008635 Arguments : none
8636
8637 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
8638 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
8639 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
8640 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
8641 - stats auth : no authentication
8642 - stats scope : no restriction
8643
8644 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8645 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8646 unobvious parameters.
8647
8648 Example :
8649 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8650 backend public_www
8651 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8652 stats enable
8653 stats hide-version
8654 stats scope .
8655 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008656 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008657 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8658 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8659
8660 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8661 backend private_monitoring
8662 stats enable
8663 stats uri /admin?stats
8664 stats refresh 5s
8665
8666 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
8667
8668
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008669stats hide-version
8670 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008671 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008672 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008673 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008674
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008675 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
8676 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
8677 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
8678 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
8679 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
8680 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008681
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02008682 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8683 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8684 unobvious parameters.
8685
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008686 Example :
8687 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8688 backend public_www
8689 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02008690 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008691 stats hide-version
8692 stats scope .
8693 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008694 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008695 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8696 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008697
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008698 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8699 backend private_monitoring
8700 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008701 stats uri /admin?stats
8702 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +01008703
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008704 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008705
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01008706
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02008707stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
8708 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
8709 Access control for statistics
8710
8711 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8712 no | no | yes | yes
8713
8714 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
8715 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
8716 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
8717 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
8718 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
8719 should be asked to enter a username and password.
8720
8721 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
8722 instance.
8723
8724 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
8725 about ACL usage.
8726
8727
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008728stats realm <realm>
8729 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
8730 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008731 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008732 Arguments :
8733 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
8734 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
8735 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
8736
8737 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
8738 using a backslash ('\').
8739
8740 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
8741 only related to authentication.
8742
8743 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8744 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8745 unobvious parameters.
8746
8747 Example :
8748 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8749 backend public_www
8750 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8751 stats enable
8752 stats hide-version
8753 stats scope .
8754 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008755 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008756 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8757 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8758
8759 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8760 backend private_monitoring
8761 stats enable
8762 stats uri /admin?stats
8763 stats refresh 5s
8764
8765 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
8766
8767
8768stats refresh <delay>
8769 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
8770 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008771 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008772 Arguments :
8773 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
8774 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
8775 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
8776 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
8777 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
8778 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
8779
8780 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
8781 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
8782 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
8783 he wants automatic refresh of the page or not.
8784
8785 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8786 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8787 unobvious parameters.
8788
8789 Example :
8790 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8791 backend public_www
8792 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8793 stats enable
8794 stats hide-version
8795 stats scope .
8796 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008797 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008798 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8799 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8800
8801 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8802 backend private_monitoring
8803 stats enable
8804 stats uri /admin?stats
8805 stats refresh 5s
8806
8807 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
8808
8809
8810stats scope { <name> | "." }
8811 Enable statistics and limit access scope
8812 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008813 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008814 Arguments :
8815 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
8816 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
8817 section in which the statement appears.
8818
8819 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
8820 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
8821 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
8822 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
8823 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
8824 exists.
8825
8826 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8827 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8828 unobvious parameters.
8829
8830 Example :
8831 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8832 backend public_www
8833 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8834 stats enable
8835 stats hide-version
8836 stats scope .
8837 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008838 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008839 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8840 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8841
8842 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8843 backend private_monitoring
8844 stats enable
8845 stats uri /admin?stats
8846 stats refresh 5s
8847
8848 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
8849
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008850
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008851stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008852 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
8853 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008854 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008855
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008856 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008857 description from global section is automatically used instead.
8858
8859 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
8860 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
8861
8862 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8863 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008864 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008865
8866 Example :
8867 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8868 backend private_monitoring
8869 stats enable
8870 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
8871 stats uri /admin?stats
8872 stats refresh 5s
8873
8874 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
8875 global section.
8876
8877
8878stats show-legends
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008879 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page
8880 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8881 yes | yes | yes | yes
8882 Arguments : none
8883
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008884 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page :
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008885 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
8886 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
8887 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
8888 - IP (socket, server)
8889 - cookie (backend, server)
8890
8891 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8892 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008893 unobvious parameters. Default behavior is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008894
8895 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
8896
8897
8898stats show-node [ <name> ]
8899 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
8900 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008901 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008902 Arguments:
8903 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
8904 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
8905
8906 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
8907 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008908 provided for each customer. Default behavior is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008909
8910 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8911 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8912 unobvious parameters.
8913
8914 Example:
8915 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8916 backend private_monitoring
8917 stats enable
8918 stats show-node Europe-1
8919 stats uri /admin?stats
8920 stats refresh 5s
8921
8922 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
8923 section.
8924
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008925
8926stats uri <prefix>
8927 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
8928 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008929 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008930 Arguments :
8931 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
8932 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
8933 query string.
8934
8935 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
8936 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
8937 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
8938 possible to reach it in the application.
8939
8940 The default URI compiled in haproxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008941 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008942 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
8943 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
8944 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
8945 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
8946
8947 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
8948 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
8949 an address or a port to statistics only.
8950
8951 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8952 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8953 unobvious parameters.
8954
8955 Example :
8956 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8957 backend public_www
8958 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8959 stats enable
8960 stats hide-version
8961 stats scope .
8962 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008963 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008964 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8965 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8966
8967 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8968 backend private_monitoring
8969 stats enable
8970 stats uri /admin?stats
8971 stats refresh 5s
8972
8973 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
8974
8975
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008976stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
8977 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008978 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008979 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008980
8981 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008982 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008983 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008984 will be analyzed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008985 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
8986
8987 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
8988 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
8989 the "stick-table" statement.
8990
8991 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
8992 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
8993 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
8994 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
8995 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
8996
8997 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
8998 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
8999 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
9000 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
9001 transformation rules.
9002
9003 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
9004 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
9005 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
9006 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
9007 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
9008 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
9009 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
9010
9011 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
9012 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
9013 ACL based conditions.
9014
9015 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
9016 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
9017 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
9018 matches can be used as fallbacks.
9019
9020 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
9021 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
9022 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
9023 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
9024
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009025 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
9026 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009027 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009028
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009029 Example :
9030 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
9031 # last 30 minutes
9032 backend pop
9033 mode tcp
9034 balance roundrobin
9035 stick store-request src
9036 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
9037 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
9038 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
9039
9040 backend smtp
9041 mode tcp
9042 balance roundrobin
9043 stick match src table pop
9044 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
9045 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
9046
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009047 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009048 about ACLs and samples fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009049
9050
9051stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
9052 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
9053 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9054 no | no | yes | yes
9055
9056 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
9057 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
9058 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
9059 for writing more maintainable configurations.
9060
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009061 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
9062 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009063 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009064
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009065 Examples :
9066 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +01009067 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009068
9069 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
9070 stick match src table pop if !localhost
9071 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
9072
9073
9074 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
9075 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
9076 backend http
9077 mode http
9078 balance roundrobin
9079 stick on src table https
9080 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
9081 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
9082 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
9083
9084 backend https
9085 mode tcp
9086 balance roundrobin
9087 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
9088 stick on src
9089 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
9090 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
9091
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009092 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009093
9094
9095stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
9096 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
9097 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9098 no | no | yes | yes
9099
9100 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009101 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009102 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009103 will be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009104 server is selected.
9105
9106 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
9107 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
9108 the "stick-table" statement.
9109
9110 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
9111 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
9112 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
9113 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
9114 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
9115 address.
9116
9117 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
9118 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
9119 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
9120 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
9121 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
9122 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
9123 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
9124 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
9125 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
9126 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
9127
9128 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
9129 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
9130 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
9131 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
9132 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
9133 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
9134 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
9135
9136 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
9137 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
9138 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
9139 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
9140
9141 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
9142 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
9143 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
9144 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
9145 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
9146 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01009147 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-request rules with
9148 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
9149 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
9150 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
9151 request rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
9152 not be evaluated.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009153
9154 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
9155 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
9156 the request.
9157
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009158 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
9159 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009160 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009161
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009162 Example :
9163 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
9164 # last 30 minutes
9165 backend pop
9166 mode tcp
9167 balance roundrobin
9168 stick store-request src
9169 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
9170 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
9171 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
9172
9173 backend smtp
9174 mode tcp
9175 balance roundrobin
9176 stick match src table pop
9177 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
9178 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
9179
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009180 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009181 about ACLs and sample fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009182
9183
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02009184stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02009185 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>]
9186 [store <data_type>]*
Godbach64cef792013-12-04 16:08:22 +08009187 Configure the stickiness table for the current section
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009188 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02009189 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009190
9191 Arguments :
9192 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
9193 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
9194 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
9195 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
9196
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01009197 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
9198 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
9199 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
9200 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
9201
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009202 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
9203 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
9204 instance.
9205
9206 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
9207 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
9208 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
9209 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
9210 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
9211 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02009212 to 32 characters.
9213
9214 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
9215 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
9216 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009217 being stored. If the block provided by the sample expression
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02009218 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
9219 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009220
9221 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02009222 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
9223 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009224 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
9225 increase.
9226
9227 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01009228 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
9229 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
9230 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009231
9232 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
9233 is full. When not specified and the table is full when haproxy
9234 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
9235 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009236 most often the desired behavior. In some specific cases, it
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009237 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
9238 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
9239 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
9240 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
9241 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
9242 parameter (see below).
9243
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02009244 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
9245 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
9246 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
9247 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
9248 soft restart.
9249
Willy Tarreau1abc6732015-05-01 19:21:02 +02009250 NOTE : each peers section may be referenced only by tables
9251 belonging to the same unique process.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009252
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009253 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
9254 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
9255 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
9256 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
Jarno Huuskonene0ee0be2017-07-04 10:35:12 +03009257 section 2.4 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009258 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009259 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
9260 if not expiration delay is specified.
9261
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02009262 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
9263 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
9264 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
9265 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009266 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
9267 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
9268 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
9269 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
9270 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
9271 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
9272 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
9273 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
9274 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
9275 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
9276 types and their arguments.
9277
9278 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
9279 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
9280 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
9281 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
9282
9283 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
9284 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
9285 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009286 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009287
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02009288 - gpc0_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
9289 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
9290 for anything. Just like <gpc0>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009291 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02009292 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009293 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02009294
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01009295 - gpc1 : second General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
9296 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
9297 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
9298 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
9299
9300 - gpc1_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
9301 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
9302 for anything. Just like <gpc1>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
9303 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
9304 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
9305 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
9306
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009307 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
9308 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
9309 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
9310 they were received.
9311
9312 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
9313 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
9314 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
9315 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
9316 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
9317
9318 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9319 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9320 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9321 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
9322 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
9323
9324 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
9325 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
9326 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
9327
9328 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9329 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9330 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9331 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
9332 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
9333
9334 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
9335 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
9336 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
9337 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
9338 the client side.
9339
9340 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9341 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9342 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9343 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
9344 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
9345 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
9346 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
9347
9348 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
9349 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
9350 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
9351 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
9352 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
9353 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009354 (e.g. vulnerability scan).
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009355
9356 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9357 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9358 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9359 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
9360 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
9361 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
9362
9363 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009364 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes received from clients
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009365 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
9366 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
9367
9368 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9369 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9370 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9371 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
9372 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
9373 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
9374 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
9375 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
9376 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
9377 recommended for better fairness.
9378
9379 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009380 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes sent to clients which
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009381 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
9382 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
9383
9384 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
9385 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9386 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9387 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
9388 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
9389 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
9390 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
9391 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
9392 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
9393 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02009394
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02009395 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
9396 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009397 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
9398 reference it.
9399
9400 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
9401 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
Baptiste Assmann123ff042016-03-06 23:29:28 +01009402 lost upon restart unless peers are properly configured to transfer such
9403 information upon restart (recommended). In general it can be good as a
9404 complement but not always as an exclusive stickiness.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009405
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009406 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
9407 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
9408 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
9409 something that can be ignored.
9410
9411 Example:
9412 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
9413 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
9414 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
9415 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
9416
Jarno Huuskonene0ee0be2017-07-04 10:35:12 +03009417 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.4
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +01009418 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009419
9420
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009421stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
Baptiste Assmann2f2d2ec2016-03-06 23:27:24 +01009422 Define a response pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009423 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9424 no | no | yes | yes
9425
9426 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009427 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009428 describes what elements of the response or connection will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009429 be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009430 server is selected.
9431
9432 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
9433 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
9434 the "stick-table" statement.
9435
9436 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
9437 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
9438 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
9439 when the response is a SSL server hello.
9440
9441 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
9442 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
9443 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
9444 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
9445 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
9446 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009447 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009448 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
9449 rules.
9450
9451 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
9452 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
9453 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
9454 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
9455 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
9456 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
9457 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
9458
9459 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
9460 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
9461 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
9462 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
9463
9464 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
9465 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
9466 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
9467 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
9468 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
9469 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01009470 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-response rules with
9471 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
9472 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
9473 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
9474 response rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
9475 not be evaluated. However, even if a store-request rule references a table, a
9476 store-response rule may also use the same table. This means that each table
9477 may learn exactly one element from the request and one element from the
9478 response at once.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009479
9480 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
9481
9482 Example :
9483 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
9484 backend https
9485 mode tcp
9486 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009487 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009488 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009489
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009490 acl clienthello req_ssl_hello_type 1
9491 acl serverhello rep_ssl_hello_type 2
9492
9493 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
9494 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
9495 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
9496
9497 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
9498 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009499
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009500 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
9501 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
9502 # at offset 44.
9503
9504 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
9505 stick on payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
9506
9507 # Learn on response if server hello.
9508 stick store-response payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009509
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009510 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
9511 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
9512
9513 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
9514 extraction.
9515
9516
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009517tcp-check connect [params*]
9518 Opens a new connection
9519 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9520 no | no | yes | yes
9521
9522 When an application lies on more than a single TCP port or when HAProxy
9523 load-balance many services in a single backend, it makes sense to probe all
9524 the services individually before considering a server as operational.
9525
9526 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
9527 directive, then the 'tcp-check connect port <port>' must be the first step
9528 of the sequence.
9529
9530 In a tcp-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
9531 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
9532 do.
9533
9534 Parameters :
9535 They are optional and can be used to describe how HAProxy should open and
9536 use the TCP connection.
9537
9538 port if not set, check port or server port is used.
9539 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
9540 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to 65535.
9541
9542 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
9543
9544 ssl opens a ciphered connection
9545
9546 Examples:
9547 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
9548 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
9549 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
9550 option tcp-check
9551 tcp-check connect
9552 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
9553 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
9554 tcp-check send \r\n
9555 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
9556 tcp-check connect port 443 ssl
9557 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
9558 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
9559 tcp-check send \r\n
9560 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
9561 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
9562
9563 # check both POP and IMAP from a single server:
9564 option tcp-check
9565 tcp-check connect port 110
9566 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
9567 tcp-check connect port 143
9568 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
9569 server mail 10.0.0.1 check
9570
9571 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check send", "tcp-check expect"
9572
9573
9574tcp-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009575 Specify data to be collected and analyzed during a generic health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009576 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9577 no | no | yes | yes
9578
9579 Arguments :
9580 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
9581 response. The keyword may be one of "string", "rstring" or
9582 binary.
9583 The keyword may be preceded by an exclamation mark ("!") to negate
9584 the match. Spaces are allowed between the exclamation mark and the
9585 keyword. See below for more details on the supported keywords.
9586
9587 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
9588 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
9589 with the usual backslash ('\').
9590 If the match is set to binary, then the pattern must be passed as
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009591 a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number. Each sequence of
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009592 two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal digits may be
9593 used upper or lower case.
9594
9595
9596 The available matches are intentionally similar to their http-check cousins :
9597
9598 string <string> : test the exact string matches in the response buffer.
9599 A health check response will be considered valid if the
9600 response's buffer contains this exact string. If the
9601 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
9602 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
9603 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory pattern
9604 in a protocol response, or to detect a failure when a
9605 specific error appears in a protocol banner.
9606
9607 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer.
9608 A health check response will be considered valid if the
9609 response's buffer matches this expression. If the
9610 "rstring" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
9611 will be considered invalid if the body matches the
9612 expression.
9613
9614 binary <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches
9615 in the response buffer. A health check response will
9616 be considered valid if the response's buffer contains
9617 this exact hexadecimal string.
9618 Purpose is to match data on binary protocols.
9619
9620 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
9621 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
9622 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
9623 "string", "rstring" or binary. If a large response is absolutely required, it
9624 is possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
9625 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
9626 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
9627 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources. Also, in its
9628 current state, the check will not find any string nor regex past a null
9629 character in the response. Similarly it is not possible to request matching
9630 the null character.
9631
9632 Examples :
9633 # perform a POP check
9634 option tcp-check
9635 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
9636
9637 # perform an IMAP check
9638 option tcp-check
9639 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
9640
9641 # look for the redis master server
9642 option tcp-check
9643 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02009644 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009645 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
9646 tcp-check expect string role:master
9647 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
9648 tcp-check expect string +OK
9649
9650
9651 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send",
9652 "tcp-check send-binary", "http-check expect", tune.chksize
9653
9654
9655tcp-check send <data>
9656 Specify a string to be sent as a question during a generic health check
9657 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9658 no | no | yes | yes
9659
9660 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
9661 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
9662
9663 Examples :
9664 # look for the redis master server
9665 option tcp-check
9666 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
9667 tcp-check expect string role:master
9668
9669 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
9670 "tcp-check send-binary", tune.chksize
9671
9672
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009673tcp-check send-binary <hexstring>
9674 Specify a hex digits string to be sent as a binary question during a raw
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009675 tcp health check
9676 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9677 no | no | yes | yes
9678
9679 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
9680 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009681 <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches in the
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009682 response buffer. A health check response will be considered
9683 valid if the response's buffer contains this exact
9684 hexadecimal string.
9685 Purpose is to send binary data to ask on binary protocols.
9686
9687 Examples :
9688 # redis check in binary
9689 option tcp-check
9690 tcp-check send-binary 50494e470d0a # PING\r\n
9691 tcp-check expect binary 2b504F4e47 # +PONG
9692
9693
9694 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
9695 "tcp-check send", tune.chksize
9696
9697
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009698tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9699 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02009700 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9701 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009702 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +02009703 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
9704 below.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02009705
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009706 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009707
9708 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
9709 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009710 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
9711 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
9712 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
9713 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
9714 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
9715 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009716
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009717 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
9718 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
9719 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
9720 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009721
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02009722 Four types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009723 - accept :
9724 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
9725 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
9726 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009727
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009728 - reject :
9729 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
9730 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
9731 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
9732 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
9733 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
9734 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
9735 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
9736 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
9737 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
9738 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
9739 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009740 be used instead, as "tcp-request session" rules will not log either.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009741
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02009742 - expect-proxy layer4 :
9743 configures the client-facing connection to receive a PROXY protocol
9744 header before any byte is read from the socket. This is equivalent to
9745 having the "accept-proxy" keyword on the "bind" line, except that using
9746 the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only for certain
9747 IP address ranges using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple layers
9748 of load balancers are passed through by traffic coming from public
9749 hosts.
9750
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +01009751 - expect-netscaler-cip layer4 :
9752 configures the client-facing connection to receive a NetScaler Client
9753 IP insertion protocol header before any byte is read from the socket.
9754 This is equivalent to having the "accept-netscaler-cip" keyword on the
9755 "bind" line, except that using the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol
9756 to be accepted only for certain IP address ranges using an ACL. This
9757 is convenient when multiple layers of load balancers are passed
9758 through by traffic coming from public hosts.
9759
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02009760 - capture <sample> len <length> :
9761 This only applies to "tcp-request content" rules. It captures sample
9762 expression <sample> from the request buffer, and converts it to a
9763 string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is stored into
9764 the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to
9765 some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the
9766 logs, and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to
9767 feed it into headers or anything. The length should be limited given
9768 that this size will be allocated for each capture during the whole
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02009769 session life. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
9770 request header" for more information.
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02009771
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009772 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009773 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +02009774 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The
9775 number of counters that may be simultaneously tracked by the same
9776 connection is set in MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in
9777 haproxy -vv) whichs defaults to 3, so the track-sc number is between 0
9778 and (MAX_SESS_STCKTR-1). The first "track-sc0" rule executed enables
9779 tracking of the counters of the specified table as the first set. The
9780 first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
9781 specified table as the second set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed
9782 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the third
9783 set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of counters for
9784 the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend ones.
9785 But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009786
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009787 These actions take one or two arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009788 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009789 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009790 request or connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined,
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009791 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
9792 Note that "tcp-request connection" cannot use content-based
9793 fetches.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009794
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009795 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
9796 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
9797 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
9798 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009799
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009800 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
9801 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
9802 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
9803 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
9804 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009805 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
9806 been started. For example, connection counters will not be updated when
9807 tracking layer 7 information, since the connection event happens before
9808 layer7 information is extracted.
9809
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009810 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
9811 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
9812 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
9813 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
9814 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009815
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02009816 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
9817 The "sc-inc-gpc0" increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
9818 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
9819 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
9820
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01009821 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
9822 The "sc-inc-gpc1" increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
9823 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
9824 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
9825
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02009826 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int>:
9827 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated
9828 by <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If
9829 an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
9830 continues.
9831
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02009832 - set-src <expr> :
9833 Is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
9834 expression. Useful if you want to mask source IP for privacy.
9835 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02009836 set-src".
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02009837
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02009838 Arguments:
9839 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9840 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02009841
9842 Example:
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02009843 tcp-request connection set-src src,ipmask(24)
9844
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02009845 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
9846 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02009847
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02009848 - set-src-port <expr> :
9849 Is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
9850 expression.
9851
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02009852 Arguments:
9853 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9854 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02009855
9856 Example:
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02009857 tcp-request connection set-src-port int(4000)
9858
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02009859 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long
9860 as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source
9861 address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02009862
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02009863 - set-dst <expr> :
9864 Is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
9865 expression. Useful if you want to mask IP for privacy in log.
9866 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
9867 set-dst". If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
9868 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
9869
9870 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9871 followed by some converters.
9872
9873 Example:
9874
9875 tcp-request connection set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
9876 tcp-request connection set-dst ipv4(10.0.0.1)
9877
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02009878 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as
9879 the address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
9880
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02009881 - set-dst-port <expr> :
9882 Is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
9883 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
9884 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
9885
9886
9887 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9888 followed by some converters.
9889
9890 Example:
9891
9892 tcp-request connection set-dst-port int(4000)
9893
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02009894 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
9895 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
9896 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
9897
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009898 - "silent-drop" :
9899 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009900 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009901 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
9902 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
9903 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
9904 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
9905 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009906 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
9907 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009908 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
9909 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009910 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009911 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
9912 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
9913 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
9914 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
9915
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009916 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
9917 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
9918 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009919
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009920 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
9921 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
9922 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009923
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009924 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009925 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009926 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009927
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009928 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
9929 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
9930 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009931
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009932 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009933 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
9934 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009935
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02009936 Example: enable the PROXY protocol for traffic coming from all known proxies.
9937
9938 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
9939
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009940 See section 7 about ACL usage.
9941
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009942 See also : "tcp-request session", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009943
9944
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009945tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9946 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009947 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02009948 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009949 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +02009950 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
9951 below.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009952
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009953 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009954
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009955 A request's contents can be analyzed at an early stage of request processing
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009956 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
9957 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
9958 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or the TCP request inspection delay
9959 expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009960
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009961 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
9962 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
9963 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
9964 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01009965 both frontends and backends. In case of HTTP keep-alive with the client, all
9966 tcp-request content rules are evaluated again, so haproxy keeps a record of
9967 what sticky counters were assigned by a "tcp-request connection" versus a
9968 "tcp-request content" rule, and flushes all the content-related ones after
9969 processing an HTTP request, so that they may be evaluated again by the rules
9970 being evaluated again for the next request. This is of particular importance
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009971 when the rule tracks some L7 information or when it is conditioned by an
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01009972 L7-based ACL, since tracking may change between requests.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009973
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009974 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
9975 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
9976 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
9977 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009978
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02009979 Several types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02009980 - accept : the request is accepted
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +01009981 - do-resolve: perform a DNS resolution
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02009982 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
9983 - capture : the specified sample expression is captured
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04009984 - set-priority-class <expr> | set-priority-offset <expr>
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009985 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02009986 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01009987 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Thierry Fournierb9125672016-03-29 19:34:37 +02009988 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int>
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +02009989 - set-dst <expr>
9990 - set-dst-port <expr>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009991 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009992 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009993 - silent-drop
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009994 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009995
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009996 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
9997 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +01009998 For "do-resolve" action, please check the "http-request do-resolve"
9999 configuration section.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010000
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010010001 While there is nothing mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the
10002 track-sc0 in "tcp-request connection" rules, track-sc1 for "tcp-request
10003 content" rules in the frontend, and track-sc2 for "tcp-request content"
10004 rules in the backend, because that makes the configuration more readable
10005 and easier to troubleshoot, but this is just a guideline and all counters
10006 may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010007
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010008 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010009 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
10010 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010011
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010012 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +020010013 rules, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to preliminarily parse the
10014 contents of a buffer before extracting the required data. If the buffered
10015 contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the ACL does not match.
10016 The parser which is involved there is exactly the same as for all other HTTP
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010010017 processing, so there is no risk of parsing something differently. In an HTTP
10018 backend connected to from an HTTP frontend, it is guaranteed that HTTP
10019 contents will always be immediately present when the rule is evaluated first.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010020
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010021 Tracking layer7 information is also possible provided that the information
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020010022 are present when the rule is processed. The rule processing engine is able to
10023 wait until the inspect delay expires when the data to be tracked is not yet
10024 available.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010025
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +020010026 The "set-dst" and "set-dst-port" are used to set respectively the destination
10027 IP and port. More information on how to use it at "http-request set-dst".
10028
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010029 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010030 declared inline. For "tcp-request session" rules, only session-level
10031 variables can be used, without any layer7 contents.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010032
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010033 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
10034 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010010035 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010036 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
10037 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010038 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010039 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010040 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010041 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
10042 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010043 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010010044 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
10045 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010046
10047 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
10048 followed by some converters.
10049
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010010050 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
10051 <var-name>.
10052
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -040010053 The "set-priority-class" is used to set the queue priority class of the
10054 current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an
10055 integer in the range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be
10056 truncated. The priority class determines the order in which queued requests
10057 are processed. Lower values have higher priority.
10058
10059 The "set-priority-offset" is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset
10060 of the current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts
10061 to an integer in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be
10062 truncated. When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority
10063 class, then by the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in
10064 milliseconds. Lower values have higher priority.
10065 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision for
10066 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
10067 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
10068 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
10069 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
10070
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020010071 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
10072 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
10073 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
10074 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
10075 the SPOE agent name must be used.
10076
10077 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
10078
10079 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
10080
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010081 Example:
10082
10083 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010010084 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var2)
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010085
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010086 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010087 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
10088 # and reject everything else.
10089 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
10090 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +020010091 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010092 tcp-request content reject
10093
10094 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010095 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
10096 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
10097 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010098 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010099
10100 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
10101 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
10102 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010103 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010104 tcp-request content reject
10105
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010106 Example:
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030010107 # Track the last IP(stick-table type string) from X-Forwarded-For
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010108 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020010109 tcp-request content track-sc0 hdr(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030010110 # Or track the last IP(stick-table type ip|ipv6) from X-Forwarded-For
10111 tcp-request content track-sc0 req.hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010112
10113 Example:
10114 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
10115 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020010116 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010117
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010118 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030010119 frontend when the backend detects abuse(and marks gpc0).
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010120
10121 frontend http
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010122 # Use General Purpose Counter 0 in SC0 as a global abuse counter
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010123 # protecting all our sites
10124 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010125 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
10126 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010127 ...
10128 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
10129
10130 backend http_dynamic
10131 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010132 # by SC1), block it globally in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010133 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010134 acl click_too_fast sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030010135 acl mark_as_abuser sc0_inc_gpc0(http) gt 0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010136 tcp-request content track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010137 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010138
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010139 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010140
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +030010141 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request session",
10142 "tcp-request inspect-delay", and "http-request".
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010143
10144
10145tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
10146 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
10147 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020010148 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010149 Arguments :
10150 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10151 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10152 as explained at the top of this document.
10153
10154 People using haproxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
10155 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
10156 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
10157 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
10158 data for at most the specified amount of time.
10159
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020010160 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
10161 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
10162 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
10163 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
10164
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010165 Note that when performing content inspection, haproxy will evaluate the whole
10166 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010167 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010168 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +010010169 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, haproxy will not wait at all
10170 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
10171 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
10172 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010173
10174 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
10175 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
10176 it pass through unaffected.
10177
10178 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
10179 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
10180 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010181 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010182 before the server (e.g. SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
10183 data to the server (e.g. SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +020010184 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
10185 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
10186 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010187
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020010188 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010189 "timeout client".
10190
10191
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010192tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
10193 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
10194 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10195 no | no | yes | yes
10196 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020010197 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
10198 below.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010199
10200 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
10201
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010202 Response contents can be analyzed at an early stage of response processing
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010203 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
10204 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020010205 "accept", "close" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection
10206 delay is set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010207
10208 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
10209
10210 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
10211 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
10212 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
10213 inserted.
10214
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020010215 Several types of actions are supported :
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010216 - accept :
10217 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
10218 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
10219 the rules evaluation.
10220
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020010221 - close :
10222 immediately closes the connection with the server if the condition is
10223 true (when used with "if"), or false (when used with "unless"). The
10224 first such rule executed ends the rules evaluation. The main purpose of
10225 this action is to force a connection to be finished between a client
10226 and a server after an exchange when the application protocol expects
10227 some long time outs to elapse first. The goal is to eliminate idle
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010228 connections which take significant resources on servers with certain
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020010229 protocols.
10230
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010231 - reject :
10232 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
10233 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010234 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediately closed.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010235
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010236 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
10237 Sets a variable.
10238
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010010239 - unset-var(<var-name>)
10240 Unsets a variable.
10241
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020010242 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
10243 This action increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
10244 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
10245 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
10246
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010010247 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
10248 This action increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
10249 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
10250 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
10251
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020010252 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> :
10253 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated
10254 by <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If
10255 an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
10256 continues.
10257
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010258 - "silent-drop" :
10259 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010260 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010261 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
10262 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
10263 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
10264 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
10265 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010266 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
10267 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010268 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
10269 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010270 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010271 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
10272 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
10273 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
10274 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
10275
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020010276 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
10277 Send a group of SPOE messages.
10278
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010279 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
10280 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
10281 for changing the default action to a reject.
10282
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010283 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
10284 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
10285 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
10286 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010287 period.
10288
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010289 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
10290 declared inline.
10291
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010292 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
10293 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010010294 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010295 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
10296 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010297 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010298 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010299 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010300 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
10301 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010302 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010010303 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
10304 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010305
10306 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
10307 followed by some converters.
10308
10309 Example:
10310
10311 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
10312
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010010313 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
10314 <var-name>.
10315
10316 Example:
10317
10318 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var)
10319
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020010320 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
10321 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
10322 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
10323 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
10324 the SPOE agent name must be used.
10325
10326 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
10327
10328 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
10329
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010330 See section 7 about ACL usage.
10331
10332 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
10333
10334
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010335tcp-request session <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
10336 Perform an action on a validated session depending on a layer 5 condition
10337 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10338 no | yes | yes | no
10339 Arguments :
10340 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
10341 below.
10342
10343 <condition> is a standard layer5-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
10344
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010345 Once a session is validated, (i.e. after all handshakes have been completed),
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010346 it is possible to evaluate some conditions to decide whether this session
10347 must be accepted or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions
10348 cannot make use of any data contents because no buffers are allocated yet and
10349 the processing cannot wait at this stage. The main use case it to copy some
10350 early information into variables (since variables are accessible in the
10351 session), or to keep track of some information collected after the handshake,
10352 such as SSL-level elements (SNI, ciphers, client cert's CN) or information
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010353 from the PROXY protocol header (e.g. track a source forwarded this way). The
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010354 extracted information can thus be copied to a variable or tracked using
10355 "track-sc" rules. Of course it is also possible to decide to accept/reject as
10356 with other rulesets. Most operations performed here could also be performed
10357 in "tcp-request content" rules, except that in HTTP these rules are evaluated
10358 for each new request, and that might not always be acceptable. For example a
10359 rule might increment a counter on each evaluation. It would also be possible
10360 that a country is resolved by geolocation from the source IP address,
10361 assigned to a session-wide variable, then the source address rewritten from
10362 an HTTP header for all requests. If some contents need to be inspected in
10363 order to take the decision, the "tcp-request content" statements must be used
10364 instead.
10365
10366 The "tcp-request session" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
10367 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
10368 accept the incoming session. There is no specific limit to the number of
10369 rules which may be inserted.
10370
10371 Several types of actions are supported :
10372 - accept : the request is accepted
10373 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
10374 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
10375 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010010376 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010377 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int>
10378 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010010379 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010380 - silent-drop
10381
10382 These actions have the same meaning as their respective counter-parts in
10383 "tcp-request connection" and "tcp-request content", so please refer to these
10384 sections for a complete description.
10385
10386 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
10387 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
10388 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
10389
10390 Example: track the original source address by default, or the one advertised
10391 in the PROXY protocol header for connection coming from the local
10392 proxies. The first connection-level rule enables receipt of the
10393 PROXY protocol for these ones, the second rule tracks whatever
10394 address we decide to keep after optional decoding.
10395
10396 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
10397 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
10398
10399 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
10400 sessions without counting them, and track accepted sessions.
10401 This results in session rate being capped from abusive sources.
10402
10403 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
10404 tcp-request session reject if { src_sess_rate gt 10 }
10405 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
10406
10407 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, count all other
10408 sessions and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
10409 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
10410
10411 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
10412 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
10413 tcp-request session reject if { sc0_sess_rate gt 10 }
10414
10415 See section 7 about ACL usage.
10416
10417 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
10418
10419
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010420tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
10421 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
10422 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10423 no | no | yes | yes
10424 Arguments :
10425 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10426 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10427 as explained at the top of this document.
10428
10429 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
10430
10431
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010432timeout check <timeout>
10433 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
10434 established.
10435
10436 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10437 yes | no | yes | yes
10438 Arguments:
10439 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10440 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10441 as explained at the top of this document.
10442
10443 If set, haproxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
10444 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010445 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (e.g. those
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010446 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +010010447 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
10448 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
10449 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010450
10451 If "timeout check" is not set haproxy uses "inter" for complete check
10452 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
10453
10454 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
10455 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010010456 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010457
10458 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10459 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10460 forget about it.
10461
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010010462 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
10463 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010464
10465
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010466timeout client <timeout>
10467timeout clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
10468 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
10469 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10470 yes | yes | yes | no
10471 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010472 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010473 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10474 as explained at the top of this document.
10475
10476 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
10477 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
10478 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
Baptiste Assmann2e1941e2016-03-06 23:24:12 +010010479 response while it is reading data sent by the server. That said, for the
10480 first phase, it is preferable to set the "timeout http-request" to better
10481 protect HAProxy from Slowloris like attacks. The value is specified in
10482 milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010483 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
10484 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
10485 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010010486 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010487 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010488 (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
10489 sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010490 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels, as well as
10491 "timeout client-fin" for half-closed connections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010492
10493 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
10494 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10495 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
10496 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
10497 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
10498 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
10499
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010010500 This also applies to HTTP/2 connections, which will be closed with GOAWAY.
Lukas Tribus75df9d72017-11-24 19:05:12 +010010501
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010502 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "clitimeout". It is recommended
10503 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout clitimeout" is
10504 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
10505
Baptiste Assmann2e1941e2016-03-06 23:24:12 +010010506 See also : "clitimeout", "timeout server", "timeout tunnel",
10507 "timeout http-request".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010508
10509
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010510timeout client-fin <timeout>
10511 Set the inactivity timeout on the client side for half-closed connections.
10512 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10513 yes | yes | yes | no
10514 Arguments :
10515 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10516 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10517 as explained at the top of this document.
10518
10519 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
10520 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
10521 from "timeout client" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
10522 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
10523 FIN_WAIT state for too long when clients do not disconnect cleanly. This
10524 problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
10525 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
Willy Tarreau599391a2017-11-24 10:16:00 +010010526 down in one direction. It is applied to idle HTTP/2 connections once a GOAWAY
10527 frame was sent, often indicating an expectation that the connection quickly
10528 ends.
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010529
10530 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
10531 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
10532 will use the other timeouts (timeout.client or timeout.tunnel).
10533
10534 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server-fin", and "timeout tunnel".
10535
10536
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010537timeout connect <timeout>
10538timeout contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
10539 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
10540 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10541 yes | no | yes | yes
10542 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010543 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010544 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10545 as explained at the top of this document.
10546
10547 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010010548 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010549 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010550 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010551 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
10552 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010553
10554 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10555 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10556 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
10557 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
10558 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
10559 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
10560
10561 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "contimeout". It is recommended
10562 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout contimeout" is
10563 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
10564
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010010565 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "contimeout",
10566 "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010567
10568
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010569timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
10570 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
10571 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10572 yes | yes | yes | yes
10573 Arguments :
10574 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10575 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10576 as explained at the top of this document.
10577
10578 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
10579 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
10580 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
10581 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
10582 once the request has started to present itself.
10583
10584 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
10585 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
10586 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
10587 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
10588 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
10589
10590 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
10591 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
10592 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
10593 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
10594
10595 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
10596 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010597 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (e.g.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010598 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
10599 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020010600 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010601
10602 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
10603 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
10604 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
10605 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
10606
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010010607 When using HTTP/2 "timeout client" is applied instead. This is so we can keep
10608 using short keep-alive timeouts in HTTP/1.1 while using longer ones in HTTP/2
Lukas Tribus75df9d72017-11-24 19:05:12 +010010609 (where we only have one connection per client and a connection setup).
10610
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010611 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
10612
10613
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010614timeout http-request <timeout>
10615 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
10616 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020010617 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010618 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010619 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010620 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10621 as explained at the top of this document.
10622
10623 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
10624 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
10625 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
10626 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
10627 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
10628 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
10629 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020010630 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time. When the
10631 timeout expires, an HTTP 408 response is sent to the client to inform it
10632 about the problem, and the connection is closed. The logs will report
10633 termination codes "cR". Some recent browsers are having problems with this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010634 standard, well-documented behavior, so it might be needed to hide the 408
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020010635 code using "option http-ignore-probes" or "errorfile 408 /dev/null". See
10636 more details in the explanations of the "cR" termination code in section 8.5.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010637
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010010638 By default, this timeout only applies to the header part of the request,
10639 and not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is
10640 not used anymore. When combined with "option http-buffer-request", this
10641 timeout also applies to the body of the request..
10642 It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010643 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010644
10645 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
10646 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010647 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (e.g. 50 ms) will
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010648 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
10649 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
10650
10651 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020010652 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
10653 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
10654 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010655
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020010656 See also : "errorfile", "http-ignore-probes", "timeout http-keep-alive", and
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010010657 "timeout client", "option http-buffer-request".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010658
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010659
10660timeout queue <timeout>
10661 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
10662 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10663 yes | no | yes | yes
10664 Arguments :
10665 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10666 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10667 as explained at the top of this document.
10668
10669 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
10670 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
10671 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
10672 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
10673 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
10674
10675 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
10676 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
10677 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
10678 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
10679
10680 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
10681
10682
10683timeout server <timeout>
10684timeout srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
10685 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
10686 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10687 yes | no | yes | yes
10688 Arguments :
10689 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10690 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10691 as explained at the top of this document.
10692
10693 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
10694 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
10695 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
10696 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
10697 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
10698 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
10699 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
10700
10701 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
10702 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
10703 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
10704 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
10705 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010010706 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010707 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010708 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
10709 with short-lived sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010710 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
10711 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010712
10713 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10714 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10715 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
10716 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
10717 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
10718 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
10719
10720 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "srvtimeout". It is recommended
10721 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout srvtimeout" is
10722 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
10723
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010724 See also : "srvtimeout", "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010725
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010726
10727timeout server-fin <timeout>
10728 Set the inactivity timeout on the server side for half-closed connections.
10729 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10730 yes | no | yes | yes
10731 Arguments :
10732 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10733 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10734 as explained at the top of this document.
10735
10736 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
10737 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
10738 from "timeout server" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
10739 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
10740 FIN_WAIT state for too long when a remote server does not disconnect cleanly.
10741 This problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
10742 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
10743 down in one direction. This setting was provided for completeness, but in most
10744 situations, it should not be needed.
10745
10746 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10747 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
10748 will use the other timeouts (timeout.server or timeout.tunnel).
10749
10750 See also : "timeout client-fin", "timeout server", and "timeout tunnel".
10751
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010752
10753timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010010754 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010755 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10756 yes | yes | yes | yes
10757 Arguments :
10758 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
10759 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10760 as explained at the top of this document.
10761
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030010762 When a connection is tarpitted using "http-request tarpit" or
10763 "reqtarpit", it is maintained open with no activity for a certain
10764 amount of time, then closed. "timeout tarpit" defines how long it will
10765 be maintained open.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010766
10767 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
10768 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
10769 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
10770 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010010771 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010772
10773 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
10774
10775
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010776timeout tunnel <timeout>
10777 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
10778 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10779 yes | no | yes | yes
10780 Arguments :
10781 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10782 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10783 as explained at the top of this document.
10784
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010785 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010786 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
10787 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
10788 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010789 analyzer remains attached to either connection (e.g. tcp content rules are
10790 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (e.g.
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010791 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
10792 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
10793 specified.
10794
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010795 Since this timeout is usually used in conjunction with long-lived connections,
10796 it usually is a good idea to also set "timeout client-fin" to handle the
10797 situation where a client suddenly disappears from the net and does not
10798 acknowledge a close, or sends a shutdown and does not acknowledge pending
10799 data anymore. This can happen in lossy networks where firewalls are present,
10800 and is detected by the presence of large amounts of sessions in a FIN_WAIT
10801 state.
10802
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010803 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
10804 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
10805 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
10806 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010807 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010808
10809 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10810 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10811 forget about it.
10812
10813 Example :
10814 defaults http
10815 option http-server-close
10816 timeout connect 5s
10817 timeout client 30s
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010818 timeout client-fin 30s
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010819 timeout server 30s
10820 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
10821
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010822 See also : "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout server".
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010823
10824
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010825transparent (deprecated)
10826 Enable client-side transparent proxying
10827 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +010010828 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010829 Arguments : none
10830
10831 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
10832 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
10833 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
10834 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
10835 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
10836 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
10837 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
10838 appropriate server.
10839
10840 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
10841
10842 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
10843 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
10844
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010845 See also: "option transparent"
10846
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010847unique-id-format <string>
10848 Generate a unique ID for each request.
10849 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10850 yes | yes | yes | no
10851 Arguments :
10852 <string> is a log-format string.
10853
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010854 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
10855 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
10856 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
10857 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010858
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010859 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
10860 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple haproxy instances
10861 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
10862 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
10863 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
10864 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
10865 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
10866 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010867
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010868 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
10869 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010870
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010871 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010872
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050010873 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010874
10875 will generate:
10876
10877 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
10878
10879 See also: "unique-id-header"
10880
10881unique-id-header <name>
10882 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
10883 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10884 yes | yes | yes | no
10885 Arguments :
10886 <name> is the name of the header.
10887
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010888 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
10889 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010890
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010891 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010892
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050010893 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010894 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
10895
10896 will generate:
10897
10898 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
10899
10900 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010901
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020010902use_backend <backend> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020010903 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010904 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10905 no | yes | yes | no
10906 Arguments :
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010010907 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section, or a
10908 "log-format" string resolving to a backend name.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010909
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020010910 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7. If
10911 it is omitted, the rule is unconditionally applied.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010912
10913 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
10914 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
10915 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020010916 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010917 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (e.g.
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020010918 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
10919 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010920
10921 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
10922 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
10923 assign the backend.
10924
10925 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
10926 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
10927 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
10928 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
10929 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
10930 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
10931
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020010932 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010933 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020010934 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
10935 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
10936 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
10937
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010010938 When <backend> is a simple name, it is resolved at configuration time, and an
10939 error is reported if the specified backend does not exist. If <backend> is
10940 a log-format string instead, no check may be done at configuration time, so
10941 the backend name is resolved dynamically at run time. If the resulting
10942 backend name does not correspond to any valid backend, no other rule is
10943 evaluated, and the default_backend directive is applied instead. Note that
10944 when using dynamic backend names, it is highly recommended to use a prefix
10945 that no other backend uses in order to ensure that an unauthorized backend
10946 cannot be forced from the request.
10947
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010948 It is worth mentioning that "use_backend" rules with an explicit name are
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010010949 used to detect the association between frontends and backends to compute the
10950 backend's "fullconn" setting. This cannot be done for dynamic names.
10951
10952 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", "fullconn", "log-format", and
10953 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010954
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010955
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020010956use-server <server> if <condition>
10957use-server <server> unless <condition>
10958 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
10959 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10960 no | no | yes | yes
10961 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010962 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020010963
10964 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
10965
10966 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
10967 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
10968 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
10969
10970 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
10971 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
10972 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
10973 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
10974 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
10975 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
10976 matches will assign the server.
10977
10978 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
10979 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
10980 with the next rules until one matches.
10981
10982 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
10983 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
10984 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
10985 according to other persistence mechanisms.
10986
10987 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
10988 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
10989 stripped.
10990
10991 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
10992 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
10993 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field. And if these servers
10994 have their weight set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
10995
10996 Example :
10997 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
10998 use-server www if { req_ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
10999 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
11000 use-server mail if { req_ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
11001 server mail 192.168.0.1:587 weight 0
11002 use-server imap if { req_ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
Lukas Tribus98a3e3f2017-03-26 12:55:35 +000011003 server imap 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020011004 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
11005 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
11006
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011007 See also: "use_backend", section 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020011008
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011009
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100110105. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011011--------------------------
11012
11013The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
11014depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
11015settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
11016written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
11017described in this section.
11018
11019
110205.1. Bind options
11021-----------------
11022
11023The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
11024as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
11025no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
11026parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
11027while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
11028provided immediately after the setting name.
11029
11030The currently supported settings are the following ones.
11031
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010011032accept-netscaler-cip <magic number>
11033 Enforces the use of the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol over any
11034 connection accepted by any of the TCP sockets declared on the same line. The
11035 NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol dictates the layer 3/4 addresses of
11036 the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is used, with the
11037 only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will only see the
11038 real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses indicated in the
11039 protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real address will still
11040 be used. This keyword combined with support from external components can be
11041 used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the X-Forwarded-For
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010011042 mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always usable. See also
11043 "tcp-request connection expect-netscaler-cip" for a finer-grained setting of
11044 which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010011045
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011046accept-proxy
11047 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
Willy Tarreau77992672014-06-14 11:06:17 +020011048 the sockets declared on the same line. Versions 1 and 2 of the PROXY protocol
11049 are supported and correctly detected. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011050 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
11051 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
11052 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
11053 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011054 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011055 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
11056 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020011057 usable. See also "tcp-request connection expect-proxy" for a finer-grained
11058 setting of which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011059
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020011060allow-0rtt
Bertrand Jacquina25282b2018-08-14 00:56:13 +010011061 Allow receiving early data when using TLSv1.3. This is disabled by default,
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010011062 due to security considerations. Because it is vulnerable to replay attacks,
11063 you should only allow if for requests that are safe to replay, ie requests
11064 that are idempotent. You can use the "wait-for-handshake" action for any
11065 request that wouldn't be safe with early data.
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020011066
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020011067alpn <protocols>
11068 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
11069 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
11070 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
11071 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS
11072 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010011073 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to enable HTTP/2 on an HTTP frontend.
11074 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
11075 now obsolete NPN extension. At the time of writing this, most browsers still
11076 support both ALPN and NPN for HTTP/2 so a fallback to NPN may still work for
11077 a while. But ALPN must be used whenever possible. If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1
11078 are expected to be supported, both versions can be advertised, in order of
11079 preference, like below :
11080
11081 bind :443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020011082
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011083backlog <backlog>
Willy Tarreaue2711c72019-02-27 15:39:41 +010011084 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified or 0, the frontend's
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011085 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
11086
Emmanuel Hocdete7f2b732017-01-09 16:15:54 +010011087curves <curves>
11088 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
11089 the string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve suite")
11090 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format of the
11091 string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
11092 Example: "X25519:P-256" (without quote)
11093 When "curves" is set, "ecdhe" parameter is ignored.
11094
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020011095ecdhe <named curve>
11096 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
Emeric Brun6924ef82013-03-06 14:08:53 +010011097 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys. By default,
11098 used named curve is prime256v1.
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020011099
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020011100ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020011101 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11102 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
11103 client's certificate.
11104
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020011105ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
11106 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
11107 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
11108 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
11109 error is ignored.
11110
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020011111ca-sign-file <cafile>
11112 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11113 designates a PEM file containing both the CA certificate and the CA private
11114 key used to create and sign server's certificates. This is a mandatory
11115 setting when the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
11116 'generate-certificates' for details.
11117
Bertrand Jacquind4d0a232016-11-13 16:37:12 +000011118ca-sign-pass <passphrase>
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020011119 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It is
11120 the CA private key passphrase. This setting is optional and used only when
11121 the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
11122 'generate-certificates' for details.
11123
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011124ciphers <ciphers>
11125 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
11126 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +000011127 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000011128 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020011129 information and recommendations see e.g.
11130 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
11131 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
11132 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
11133
11134ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
11135 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
11136 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the string describing
11137 the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated during the
11138 TLSv1.3 handshake. The format of the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000011139 OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section. For cipher configuration
11140 for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers" keyword.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011141
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020011142crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020011143 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11144 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
11145 to verify client's certificate.
11146
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011147crt <cert>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011148 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11149 designates a PEM file containing both the required certificates and any
11150 associated private keys. This file can be built by concatenating multiple
11151 PEM files into one (e.g. cat cert.pem key.pem > combined.pem). If your CA
11152 requires an intermediate certificate, this can also be concatenated into this
11153 file.
11154
11155 If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters present in this file
11156 are loaded.
11157
11158 If a directory name is used instead of a PEM file, then all files found in
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010011159 that directory will be loaded in alphabetic order unless their name ends with
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010011160 '.issuer', '.ocsp' or '.sctl' (reserved extensions). This directive may be
11161 specified multiple times in order to load certificates from multiple files or
11162 directories. The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a
11163 valid TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of their CN or alt
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011164 subjects. Wildcards are supported, where a wildcard character '*' is used
11165 instead of the first hostname component (e.g. *.example.org matches
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010011166 www.example.org but not www.sub.example.org).
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011167
11168 If no SNI is provided by the client or if the SSL library does not support
11169 TLS extensions, or if the client provides an SNI hostname which does not
11170 match any certificate, then the first loaded certificate will be presented.
11171 This means that when loading certificates from a directory, it is highly
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010011172 recommended to load the default one first as a file or to ensure that it will
11173 always be the first one in the directory.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011174
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +020011175 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011176
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011177 Some CAs (such as GoDaddy) offer a drop down list of server types that do not
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011178 include HAProxy when obtaining a certificate. If this happens be sure to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011179 choose a web server that the CA believes requires an intermediate CA (for
11180 GoDaddy, selection Apache Tomcat will get the correct bundle, but many
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011181 others, e.g. nginx, result in a wrong bundle that will not work for some
11182 clients).
11183
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +020011184 For each PEM file, haproxy checks for the presence of file at the same path
11185 suffixed by ".ocsp". If such file is found, support for the TLS Certificate
11186 Status Request extension (also known as "OCSP stapling") is automatically
11187 enabled. The content of this file is optional. If not empty, it must contain
11188 a valid OCSP Response in DER format. In order to be valid an OCSP Response
11189 must comply with the following rules: it has to indicate a good status,
11190 it has to be a single response for the certificate of the PEM file, and it
11191 has to be valid at the moment of addition. If these rules are not respected
11192 the OCSP Response is ignored and a warning is emitted. In order to identify
11193 which certificate an OCSP Response applies to, the issuer's certificate is
11194 necessary. If the issuer's certificate is not found in the PEM file, it will
11195 be loaded from a file at the same path as the PEM file suffixed by ".issuer"
11196 if it exists otherwise it will fail with an error.
11197
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010011198 For each PEM file, haproxy also checks for the presence of file at the same
11199 path suffixed by ".sctl". If such file is found, support for Certificate
11200 Transparency (RFC6962) TLS extension is enabled. The file must contain a
11201 valid Signed Certificate Timestamp List, as described in RFC. File is parsed
11202 to check basic syntax, but no signatures are verified.
11203
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050011204 There are cases where it is desirable to support multiple key types, e.g. RSA
11205 and ECDSA in the cipher suites offered to the clients. This allows clients
11206 that support EC certificates to be able to use EC ciphers, while
11207 simultaneously supporting older, RSA only clients.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011208
11209 In order to provide this functionality, multiple PEM files, each with a
11210 different key type, are required. To associate these PEM files into a
11211 "cert bundle" that is recognized by haproxy, they must be named in the
11212 following way: All PEM files that are to be bundled must have the same base
11213 name, with a suffix indicating the key type. Currently, three suffixes are
11214 supported: rsa, dsa and ecdsa. For example, if www.example.com has two PEM
11215 files, an RSA file and an ECDSA file, they must be named: "example.pem.rsa"
11216 and "example.pem.ecdsa". The first part of the filename is arbitrary; only the
11217 suffix matters. To load this bundle into haproxy, specify the base name only:
11218
11219 Example : bind :8443 ssl crt example.pem
11220
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050011221 Note that the suffix is not given to haproxy; this tells haproxy to look for
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011222 a cert bundle.
11223
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011224 HAProxy will load all PEM files in the bundle at the same time to try to
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011225 support multiple key types. PEM files are combined based on Common Name
11226 (CN) and Subject Alternative Name (SAN) to support SNI lookups. This means
11227 that even if you give haproxy a cert bundle, if there are no shared CN/SAN
11228 entries in the certificates in that bundle, haproxy will not be able to
11229 provide multi-cert support.
11230
11231 Assuming bundle in the example above contained the following:
11232
11233 Filename | CN | SAN
11234 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
11235 example.pem.rsa | www.example.com | rsa.example.com
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050011236 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011237 example.pem.ecdsa | www.example.com | ecdsa.example.com
11238 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
11239
11240 Users connecting with an SNI of "www.example.com" will be able
11241 to use both RSA and ECDSA cipher suites. Users connecting with an SNI of
11242 "rsa.example.com" will only be able to use RSA cipher suites, and users
11243 connecting with "ecdsa.example.com" will only be able to use ECDSA cipher
Emmanuel Hocdet84e417d2017-08-16 11:33:17 +020011244 suites. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1 multi-cert is natively supported,
11245 no need to bundle certificates. ECDSA certificate will be preferred if client
11246 support it.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011247
11248 If a directory name is given as the <cert> argument, haproxy will
11249 automatically search and load bundled files in that directory.
11250
11251 OSCP files (.ocsp) and issuer files (.issuer) are supported with multi-cert
11252 bundling. Each certificate can have its own .ocsp and .issuer file. At this
11253 time, sctl is not supported in multi-certificate bundling.
11254
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020011255crt-ignore-err <errors>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011256 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. Sets a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011257 comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0. If
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011258 set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an error
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011259 is ignored.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020011260
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010011261crt-list <file>
11262 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011263 designates a list of PEM file with an optional ssl configuration and a SNI
11264 filter per certificate, with the following format for each line :
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010011265
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011266 <crtfile> [\[<sslbindconf> ...\]] [[!]<snifilter> ...]
11267
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020011268 sslbindconf support "npn", "alpn", "verify", "ca-file", "no-ca-names",
11269 crl-file", "ecdhe", "curves", "ciphers" configuration. With BoringSSL
Emmanuel Hocdet84e417d2017-08-16 11:33:17 +020011270 and Openssl >= 1.1.1 "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" are also supported.
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011271 It override the configuration set in bind line for the certificate.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010011272
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020011273 Wildcards are supported in the SNI filter. Negative filter are also supported,
11274 only useful in combination with a wildcard filter to exclude a particular SNI.
11275 The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid TLS Server
11276 Name Indication field matching one of the SNI filters. If no SNI filter is
11277 specified, the CN and alt subjects are used. This directive may be specified
11278 multiple times. See the "crt" option for more information. The default
11279 certificate is still needed to meet OpenSSL expectations. If it is not used,
11280 the 'strict-sni' option may be used.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010011281
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050011282 Multi-cert bundling (see "crt") is supported with crt-list, as long as only
Emmanuel Hocdetd294aea2016-05-13 11:14:06 +020011283 the base name is given in the crt-list. SNI filter will do the same work on
Emmanuel Hocdet84e417d2017-08-16 11:33:17 +020011284 all bundled certificates. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1 multi-cert is
11285 natively supported, avoid multi-cert bundling. RSA and ECDSA certificates can
11286 be declared in a row, and set different ssl and filter parameter.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011287
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011288 crt-list file example:
11289 cert1.pem
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010011290 cert2.pem [alpn h2,http/1.1]
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011291 certW.pem *.domain.tld !secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010011292 certS.pem [curves X25519:P-256 ciphers ECDHE-ECDSA-AES256-GCM-SHA384] secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011293
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011294defer-accept
11295 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
11296 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
11297 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011298 for which the client talks first (e.g. HTTP). It can slightly improve
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011299 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
11300 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
11301 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
11302 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
11303 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
11304 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
11305 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
11306
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020011307expose-fd listeners
11308 This option is only usable with the stats socket. It gives your stats socket
11309 the capability to pass listeners FD to another HAProxy process.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +020011310 During a reload with the master-worker mode, the process is automatically
11311 reexecuted adding -x and one of the stats socket with this option.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011312 See also "-x" in the management guide.
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020011313
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011314force-sslv3
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011315 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011316 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011317 for high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011318 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011319
11320force-tlsv10
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011321 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011322 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011323 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011324
11325force-tlsv11
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011326 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011327 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011328 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011329
11330force-tlsv12
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011331 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011332 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011333 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011334
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011335force-tlsv13
11336 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
11337 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011338 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011339
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020011340generate-certificates
11341 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11342 enables the dynamic SSL certificates generation. A CA certificate and its
11343 private key are necessary (see 'ca-sign-file'). When HAProxy is configured as
11344 a transparent forward proxy, SSL requests generate errors because of a common
11345 name mismatch on the certificate presented to the client. With this option
11346 enabled, HAProxy will try to forge a certificate using the SNI hostname
11347 indicated by the client. This is done only if no certificate matches the SNI
11348 hostname (see 'crt-list'). If an error occurs, the default certificate is
11349 used, else the 'strict-sni' option is set.
11350 It can also be used when HAProxy is configured as a reverse proxy to ease the
11351 deployment of an architecture with many backends.
11352
11353 Creating a SSL certificate is an expensive operation, so a LRU cache is used
11354 to store forged certificates (see 'tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size'). It
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011355 increases the HAProxy's memory footprint to reduce latency when the same
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020011356 certificate is used many times.
11357
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011358gid <gid>
11359 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
11360 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
11361 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
11362 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
11363 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
11364
11365group <group>
11366 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
11367 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
11368 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
11369 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
11370 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
11371
11372id <id>
11373 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
11374 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
11375 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
11376 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
11377
11378interface <interface>
Lukas Tribusfce2e962013-02-12 22:13:19 +010011379 Restricts the socket to a specific interface. When specified, only packets
11380 received from that particular interface are processed by the socket. This is
11381 currently only supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system
11382 interface, not an aliased interface. It is also possible to bind multiple
11383 frontends to the same address if they are bound to different interfaces. Note
11384 that binding to a network interface requires root privileges. This parameter
Jérôme Magnin61275192018-02-07 11:39:58 +010011385 is only compatible with TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets. When specified, return traffic
11386 uses the same interface as inbound traffic, and its associated routing table,
11387 even if there are explicit routes through different interfaces configured.
11388 This can prove useful to address asymmetric routing issues when the same
11389 client IP addresses need to be able to reach frontends hosted on different
11390 interfaces.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011391
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020011392level <level>
11393 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
11394 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
11395 sockets. <level> can be one of :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011396 - "user" is the least privileged level; only non-sensitive stats can be
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020011397 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
11398 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
11399 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011400 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (e.g. clear max
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020011401 counters).
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011402 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (e.g. clear
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020011403 all counters).
11404
Andjelko Iharosc4df59e2017-07-20 11:59:48 +020011405severity-output <format>
11406 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to configure severity
11407 level output prepended to informational feedback messages. Severity
11408 level of messages can range between 0 and 7, conforming to syslog
11409 rfc5424. Valid and successful socket commands requesting data
11410 (i.e. "show map", "get acl foo" etc.) will never have a severity level
11411 prepended. It is ignored by other sockets. <format> can be one of :
11412 - "none" (default) no severity level is prepended to feedback messages.
11413 - "number" severity level is prepended as a number.
11414 - "string" severity level is prepended as a string following the
11415 rfc5424 convention.
11416
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011417maxconn <maxconn>
11418 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
11419 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
11420 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
11421 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
11422 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
11423 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
11424 eat all memory.
11425
11426mode <mode>
11427 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
11428 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
11429 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
11430 UNIX sockets.
11431
11432mss <maxseg>
11433 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
11434 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
11435 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
11436 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
11437 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
11438 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
11439 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
11440 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
11441 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
11442 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
11443 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
11444
11445name <name>
11446 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
11447 page.
11448
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020011449namespace <name>
11450 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
11451 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a listener to
11452 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
11453 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
11454
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011455nice <nice>
11456 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
11457 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
11458 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
11459 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
11460 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
11461 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
11462 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
11463 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
11464 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
11465 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
11466 one for an RDP socket.
11467
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020011468no-ca-names
11469 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11470 prevents from send CA names in server hello message when ca-file is used.
11471
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011472no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011473 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011474 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener when
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011475 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011476 be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also available on
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011477 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver" and
11478 "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011479
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020011480no-tls-tickets
11481 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11482 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
11483 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011484 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage. This option is also
11485 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020011486
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011487no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011488 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011489 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011490 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011491 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011492 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
11493 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011494
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011495no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011496 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011497 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011498 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011499 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011500 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
11501 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011502
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011503no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011504 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011505 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011506 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011507 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011508 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
11509 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011510
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011511no-tlsv13
11512 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11513 disables support for TLSv1.3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
11514 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
11515 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011516 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
11517 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011518
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020011519npn <protocols>
11520 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
11521 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
11522 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
11523 This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020011524 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010011525 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
11526 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2. If HTTP/2 is desired on an older
11527 version of OpenSSL, NPN might still be used as most clients still support it
11528 at the time of writing this. It is possible to enable both NPN and ALPN
11529 though it probably doesn't make any sense out of testing.
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020011530
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000011531prefer-client-ciphers
11532 Use the client's preference when selecting the cipher suite, by default
11533 the server's preference is enforced. This option is also available on
11534 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribus926594f2018-05-18 17:55:57 +020011535 Note that with OpenSSL >= 1.1.1 ChaCha20-Poly1305 is reprioritized anyway
11536 (without setting this option), if a ChaCha20-Poly1305 cipher is at the top of
11537 the client cipher list.
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000011538
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010011539process <process-set>[/<thread-set>]
Willy Tarreaua36b3242019-02-02 13:14:34 +010011540 This restricts the list of processes or threads on which this listener is
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010011541 allowed to run. It does not enforce any process but eliminates those which do
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011542 not match. If the frontend uses a "bind-process" setting, the intersection
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010011543 between the two is applied. If in the end the listener is not allowed to run
11544 on any remaining process, a warning is emitted, and the listener will either
11545 run on the first process of the listener if a single process was specified,
11546 or on all of its processes if multiple processes were specified. If a thread
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011547 set is specified, it limits the threads allowed to process incoming
Willy Tarreaua36b3242019-02-02 13:14:34 +010011548 connections for this listener, for the the process set. If multiple processes
11549 and threads are configured, a warning is emitted, as it either results from a
11550 configuration error or a misunderstanding of these models. For the unlikely
11551 case where several ranges are needed, this directive may be repeated.
11552 <process-set> and <thread-set> must use the format
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010011553
11554 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
11555
11556 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
11557 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value. The main purpose of
11558 this directive is to be used with the stats sockets and have one different
11559 socket per process. The second purpose is to have multiple bind lines sharing
11560 the same IP:port but not the same process in a listener, so that the system
11561 can distribute the incoming connections into multiple queues and allow a
11562 smoother inter-process load balancing. Currently Linux 3.9 and above is known
11563 for supporting this. See also "bind-process" and "nbproc".
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +020011564
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020011565proto <name>
11566 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the incoming connections. It
11567 must be compatible with the mode of the frontend (TCP or HTTP). It must also
11568 be usable on the frontend side. The list of available protocols is reported
11569 in haproxy -vv.
11570 Idea behind this optipon is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
11571 protocol for all connections instantiated from this listening socket. For
Joseph Herlant71b4b152018-11-13 16:55:16 -080011572 instance, it is possible to force the http/2 on clear TCP by specifying "proto
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020011573 h2" on the bind line.
11574
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011575ssl
11576 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011577 enables SSL deciphering on connections instantiated from this listener. A
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011578 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
11579 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
Emmanuel Hocdetbd695fe2017-05-15 15:53:41 +020011580 to deciphered contents. SSLv3 is disabled per default, use "ssl-min-ver SSLv3"
11581 to enable it.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011582
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011583ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
11584 This option enforces use of <version> or lower on SSL connections instantiated
11585 from this listener. This option is also available on global statement
11586 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
11587
11588ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
11589 This option enforces use of <version> or upper on SSL connections instantiated
11590 from this listener. This option is also available on global statement
11591 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-max-ver".
11592
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +010011593strict-sni
11594 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. The
11595 SSL/TLS negotiation is allow only if the client provided an SNI which match
11596 a certificate. The default certificate is not used.
11597 See the "crt" option for more information.
11598
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010011599tcp-ut <delay>
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010011600 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all incoming connections instantiated from this
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010011601 listening socket. This option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It
11602 allows haproxy to configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011603 receiving an acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010011604 useful on long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as
11605 remote terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server
11606 timeouts must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is
11607 important to detect that the client has disappeared in order to release all
11608 resources associated with its connection (and the server's session). The
11609 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works
11610 for regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
11611
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020011612tfo
Lukas Tribus0defb902013-02-13 23:35:39 +010011613 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.7. It
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020011614 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
11615 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
11616 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
11617 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
11618 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
11619 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
11620 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
Lukas Tribus0999f762013-04-02 16:43:24 +020011621 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones. You may
11622 need to build HAProxy with USE_TFO=1 if your libc doesn't define
11623 TCP_FASTOPEN.
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020011624
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010011625tls-ticket-keys <keyfile>
11626 Sets the TLS ticket keys file to load the keys from. The keys need to be 48
Emeric Brun9e754772019-01-10 17:51:55 +010011627 or 80 bytes long, depending if aes128 or aes256 is used, encoded with base64
11628 with one line per key (ex. openssl rand 80 | openssl base64 -A | xargs echo).
11629 The first key determines the key length used for next keys: you can't mix
11630 aes128 and aes256 keys. Number of keys is specified by the TLS_TICKETS_NO
11631 build option (default 3) and at least as many keys need to be present in
11632 the file. Last TLS_TICKETS_NO keys will be used for decryption and the
11633 penultimate one for encryption. This enables easy key rotation by just
11634 appending new key to the file and reloading the process. Keys must be
11635 periodically rotated (ex. every 12h) or Perfect Forward Secrecy is
11636 compromised. It is also a good idea to keep the keys off any permanent
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010011637 storage such as hard drives (hint: use tmpfs and don't swap those files).
11638 Lifetime hint can be changed using tune.ssl.timeout.
11639
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011640transparent
11641 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
11642 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
11643 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
11644 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
11645 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
11646 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
11647 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
11648 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
11649 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
11650 so check for support with your vendor.
11651
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010011652v4v6
11653 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
11654 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to both IPv4
11655 and IPv6 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes necessary
11656 on systems which bind to IPv6 only by default. It has no effect on non-IPv6
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011657 sockets, and is overridden by the "v6only" option.
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010011658
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010011659v6only
11660 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
11661 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to IPv6 only
11662 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes preferred to doing it
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010011663 system-wide as it is per-listener. It has no effect on non-IPv6 sockets and
11664 has precedence over the "v4v6" option.
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010011665
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011666uid <uid>
11667 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
11668 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
11669 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
11670 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
11671 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
11672
11673user <user>
11674 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
11675 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
11676 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
11677 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
11678 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
11679
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020011680verify [none|optional|required]
11681 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
11682 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
11683 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
11684 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
11685 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020011686 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
11687 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
11688 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
11689 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020011690
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +0200116915.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010011692------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011693
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010011694The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
11695which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
11696arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
11697settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
11698after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
11699Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
11700address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011701
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011702 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010011703 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011704
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011705Note that all these settings are supported both by "server" and "default-server"
11706keywords, except "id" which is only supported by "server".
11707
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011708The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011709
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020011710addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011711 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
Baptiste Assmann13f83532016-03-06 23:14:36 +010011712 to send health-checks or to probe the agent-check. On some servers, it may be
11713 desirable to dedicate an IP address to specific component able to perform
11714 complex tests which are more suitable to health-checks than the application.
11715 This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not set. See also the
11716 "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011717
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011718agent-check
11719 Enable an auxiliary agent check which is run independently of a regular
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011720 health check. An agent health check is performed by making a TCP connection
Willy Tarreau7a0139e2018-12-16 08:42:56 +010011721 to the port set by the "agent-port" parameter and reading an ASCII string
11722 terminated by the first '\r' or '\n' met. The string is made of a series of
11723 words delimited by spaces, tabs or commas in any order, each consisting of :
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011724
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011725 - An ASCII representation of a positive integer percentage, e.g. "75%".
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011726 Values in this format will set the weight proportional to the initial
Willy Tarreauc5af3a62014-10-07 15:27:33 +020011727 weight of a server as configured when haproxy starts. Note that a zero
11728 weight is reported on the stats page as "DRAIN" since it has the same
11729 effect on the server (it's removed from the LB farm).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011730
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011731 - The string "maxconn:" followed by an integer (no space between). Values
11732 in this format will set the maxconn of a server. The maximum number of
11733 connections advertised needs to be multiplied by the number of load
11734 balancers and different backends that use this health check to get the
11735 total number of connections the server might receive. Example: maxconn:30
Nenad Merdanovic174dd372016-04-24 23:10:06 +020011736
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011737 - The word "ready". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011738 READY mode, thus canceling any DRAIN or MAINT state
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011739
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011740 - The word "drain". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
11741 DRAIN mode, thus it will not accept any new connections other than those
11742 that are accepted via persistence.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011743
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011744 - The word "maint". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
11745 MAINT mode, thus it will not accept any new connections at all, and health
11746 checks will be stopped.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011747
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011748 - The words "down", "failed", or "stopped", optionally followed by a
11749 description string after a sharp ('#'). All of these mark the server's
11750 operating state as DOWN, but since the word itself is reported on the stats
11751 page, the difference allows an administrator to know if the situation was
11752 expected or not : the service may intentionally be stopped, may appear up
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011753 but fail some validity tests, or may be seen as down (e.g. missing process,
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011754 or port not responding).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011755
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011756 - The word "up" sets back the server's operating state as UP if health checks
11757 also report that the service is accessible.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011758
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011759 Parameters which are not advertised by the agent are not changed. For
11760 example, an agent might be designed to monitor CPU usage and only report a
11761 relative weight and never interact with the operating status. Similarly, an
11762 agent could be designed as an end-user interface with 3 radio buttons
11763 allowing an administrator to change only the administrative state. However,
11764 it is important to consider that only the agent may revert its own actions,
11765 so if a server is set to DRAIN mode or to DOWN state using the agent, the
11766 agent must implement the other equivalent actions to bring the service into
11767 operations again.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011768
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090011769 Failure to connect to the agent is not considered an error as connectivity
11770 is tested by the regular health check which is enabled by the "check"
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011771 parameter. Warning though, it is not a good idea to stop an agent after it
11772 reports "down", since only an agent reporting "up" will be able to turn the
11773 server up again. Note that the CLI on the Unix stats socket is also able to
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +010011774 force an agent's result in order to work around a bogus agent if needed.
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090011775
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011776 Requires the "agent-port" parameter to be set. See also the "agent-inter"
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011777 and "no-agent-check" parameters.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011778
James Brown55f9ff12015-10-21 18:19:05 -070011779agent-send <string>
11780 If this option is specified, haproxy will send the given string (verbatim)
11781 to the agent server upon connection. You could, for example, encode
11782 the backend name into this string, which would enable your agent to send
11783 different responses based on the backend. Make sure to include a '\n' if
11784 you want to terminate your request with a newline.
11785
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011786agent-inter <delay>
11787 The "agent-inter" parameter sets the interval between two agent checks
11788 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
11789
11790 Just as with every other time-based parameter, it may be entered in any
11791 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "agent-inter"
11792 parameter also serves as a timeout for agent checks "timeout check" is
11793 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
11794 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
11795 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
11796 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
11797 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
11798 of backends use the same servers.
11799
11800 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-port" parameters.
11801
Misiek768d8602017-01-09 09:52:43 +010011802agent-addr <addr>
11803 The "agent-addr" parameter sets address for agent check.
11804
11805 You can offload agent-check to another target, so you can make single place
11806 managing status and weights of servers defined in haproxy in case you can't
11807 make self-aware and self-managing services. You can specify both IP or
11808 hostname, it will be resolved.
11809
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011810agent-port <port>
11811 The "agent-port" parameter sets the TCP port used for agent checks.
11812
11813 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-inter" parameters.
11814
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020011815allow-0rtt
11816 Allow sending early data to the server when using TLS 1.3.
Olivier Houchard22c9b442019-05-06 19:01:04 +020011817 Note that early data will be sent only if the client used early data, or
11818 if the backend uses "retry-on" with the "0rtt-rejected" keyword.
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020011819
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010011820alpn <protocols>
11821 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
11822 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
11823 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
11824 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS
11825 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
11826 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to connect to HTTP/2 servers.
11827 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
11828 now obsolete NPN extension.
11829 If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1 are expected to be supported, both versions can
11830 be advertised, in order of preference, like below :
11831
11832 server 127.0.0.1:443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
11833
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011834backup
11835 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
11836 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
11837 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
11838 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011839 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "no-backup" and
11840 "allbackups" options.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011841
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020011842ca-file <cafile>
11843 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11844 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
11845 server's certificate.
11846
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011847check
11848 This option enables health checks on the server. By default, a server is
Patrick Mézardb7aeec62012-01-22 16:01:22 +010011849 always considered available. If "check" is set, the server is available when
11850 accepting periodic TCP connections, to ensure that it is really able to serve
11851 requests. The default address and port to send the tests to are those of the
11852 server, and the default source is the same as the one defined in the
11853 backend. It is possible to change the address using the "addr" parameter, the
11854 port using the "port" parameter, the source address using the "source"
11855 address, and the interval and timers using the "inter", "rise" and "fall"
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +090011856 parameters. The request method is define in the backend using the "httpchk",
11857 "smtpchk", "mysql-check", "pgsql-check" and "ssl-hello-chk" options. Please
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011858 refer to those options and parameters for more information. See also
11859 "no-check" option.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011860
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +020011861check-send-proxy
11862 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
11863 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
11864 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
11865 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
11866 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
11867 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
11868 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
11869
Olivier Houchard92150142018-12-21 19:47:01 +010011870check-alpn <protocols>
11871 Defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol list consists in
11872 a comma-delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0"
11873 (without quotes). If it is not set, the server ALPN is used.
11874
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010011875check-sni <sni>
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020011876 This option allows you to specify the SNI to be used when doing health checks
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010011877 over SSL. It is only possible to use a string to set <sni>. If you want to
11878 set a SNI for proxied traffic, see "sni".
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020011879
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011880check-ssl
11881 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
11882 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
11883 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
11884 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011885 inserts an SSL transport layer below the checks, so that a simple TCP connect
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011886 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
11887 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011888 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (e.g. ciphers).
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011889 See the "ssl" option for more information and "no-check-ssl" to disable
11890 this option.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011891
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011892ciphers <ciphers>
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020011893 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. This
11894 option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
11895 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000011896 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
11897 information and recommendations see e.g.
11898 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
11899 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
11900 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011901
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020011902ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
11903 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
11904 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. This option sets the string
11905 describing the list of cipher algorithms that is negotiated during the TLS
11906 1.3 handshake with the server. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000011907 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section.
11908 For cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers"
11909 keyword.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020011910
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011911cookie <value>
11912 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
11913 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
11914 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
11915 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
11916 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
11917 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
11918 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
11919
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020011920crl-file <crlfile>
11921 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11922 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
11923 to verify server's certificate.
11924
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +020011925crt <cert>
11926 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
11927 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
11928 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
11929 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
11930 certificate request.
11931
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020011932disabled
11933 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
11934 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
11935 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
11936 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
11937 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011938 See also "enabled" setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020011939
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011940enabled
11941 This option may be used as 'server' setting to reset any 'disabled'
11942 setting which would have been inherited from 'default-server' directive as
11943 default value.
11944 It may also be used as 'default-server' setting to reset any previous
11945 'default-server' 'disabled' setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020011946
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011947error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010011948 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
11949 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
11950 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011951
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011952 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011953
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011954fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011955 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
11956 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
11957 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
11958
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011959force-sslv3
11960 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
11961 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011962 high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011963 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011964
11965force-tlsv10
11966 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011967 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011968 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011969
11970force-tlsv11
11971 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011972 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011973 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011974
11975force-tlsv12
11976 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011977 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011978 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011979
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011980force-tlsv13
11981 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
11982 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011983 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011984
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011985id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +020011986 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
11987 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
11988 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011989
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010011990init-addr {last | libc | none | <ip>},[...]*
11991 Indicate in what order the server's address should be resolved upon startup
11992 if it uses an FQDN. Attempts are made to resolve the address by applying in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011993 turn each of the methods mentioned in the comma-delimited list. The first
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010011994 method which succeeds is used. If the end of the list is reached without
11995 finding a working method, an error is thrown. Method "last" suggests to pick
11996 the address which appears in the state file (see "server-state-file"). Method
11997 "libc" uses the libc's internal resolver (gethostbyname() or getaddrinfo()
11998 depending on the operating system and build options). Method "none"
11999 specifically indicates that the server should start without any valid IP
12000 address in a down state. It can be useful to ignore some DNS issues upon
12001 startup, waiting for the situation to get fixed later. Finally, an IP address
12002 (IPv4 or IPv6) may be provided. It can be the currently known address of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012003 server (e.g. filled by a configuration generator), or the address of a dummy
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010012004 server used to catch old sessions and present them with a decent error
12005 message for example. When the "first" load balancing algorithm is used, this
12006 IP address could point to a fake server used to trigger the creation of new
12007 instances on the fly. This option defaults to "last,libc" indicating that the
12008 previous address found in the state file (if any) is used first, otherwise
12009 the libc's resolver is used. This ensures continued compatibility with the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012010 historic behavior.
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010012011
12012 Example:
12013 defaults
12014 # never fail on address resolution
12015 default-server init-addr last,libc,none
12016
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012017inter <delay>
12018fastinter <delay>
12019downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012020 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
12021 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
12022 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
12023 between checks depending on the server state :
12024
Pieter Baauw44fc9df2015-09-17 21:30:46 +020012025 Server state | Interval used
12026 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
12027 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
12028 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
12029 Transitionally UP (going down "fall"), | "fastinter" if set,
12030 Transitionally DOWN (going up "rise"), | "inter" otherwise.
12031 or yet unchecked. |
12032 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
12033 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set,
12034 | "inter" otherwise.
12035 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012036
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012037 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
12038 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
12039 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
12040 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012041 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
12042 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
12043 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
12044 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
12045 of backends use the same servers.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012046
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012047maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012048 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
12049 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
12050 concurrent requests goes higher than this value, they will be queued, waiting
12051 for a connection to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
12052 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
12053 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
12054 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
12055 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
12056
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012057maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012058 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
12059 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
12060 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
12061 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
12062 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. The
12063 default value is "0" which means the queue is unlimited. See also the
12064 "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters.
12065
Willy Tarreau9c538e02019-01-23 10:21:49 +010012066max-reuse <count>
12067 The "max-reuse" argument indicates the HTTP connection processors that they
12068 should not reuse a server connection more than this number of times to send
12069 new requests. Permitted values are -1 (the default), which disables this
12070 limit, or any positive value. Value zero will effectively disable keep-alive.
12071 This is only used to work around certain server bugs which cause them to leak
12072 resources over time. The argument is not necessarily respected by the lower
12073 layers as there might be technical limitations making it impossible to
12074 enforce. At least HTTP/2 connections to servers will respect it.
12075
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012076minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012077 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
12078 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
12079 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
12080 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
12081 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
12082 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012083 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012084 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010012085
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020012086namespace <name>
12087 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
12088 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a server to
12089 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
12090 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
12091
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012092no-agent-check
12093 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "agent-check"
12094 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12095 default value.
12096 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12097 "default-server" "agent-check" setting.
12098
12099no-backup
12100 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "backup"
12101 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12102 default value.
12103 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12104 "default-server" "backup" setting.
12105
12106no-check
12107 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check"
12108 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12109 default value.
12110 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12111 "default-server" "check" setting.
12112
12113no-check-ssl
12114 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check-ssl"
12115 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12116 default value.
12117 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12118 "default-server" "check-ssl" setting.
12119
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012120no-send-proxy
12121 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy"
12122 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12123 default value.
12124 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12125 "default-server" "send-proxy" setting.
12126
12127no-send-proxy-v2
12128 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2"
12129 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12130 default value.
12131 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12132 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2" setting.
12133
12134no-send-proxy-v2-ssl
12135 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl"
12136 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12137 default value.
12138 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12139 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl" setting.
12140
12141no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
12142 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn"
12143 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12144 default value.
12145 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12146 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" setting.
12147
12148no-ssl
12149 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "ssl"
12150 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12151 default value.
12152 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12153 "default-server" "ssl" setting.
12154
Willy Tarreau2a3fb1c2015-02-05 16:47:07 +010012155no-ssl-reuse
12156 This option disables SSL session reuse when SSL is used to communicate with
12157 the server. It will force the server to perform a full handshake for every
12158 new connection. It's probably only useful for benchmarking, troubleshooting,
12159 and for paranoid users.
12160
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020012161no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012162 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
12163 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012164 using any configuration option. Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012165
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020012166 Supported in default-server: No
12167
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020012168no-tls-tickets
12169 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12170 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
12171 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012172 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers. This option
12173 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012174 See also "tls-tickets".
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020012175
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020012176no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012177 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020012178 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
12179 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012180 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
12181 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012182 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012183
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020012184 Supported in default-server: No
12185
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020012186no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012187 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020012188 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
12189 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012190 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
12191 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012192 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012193
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020012194 Supported in default-server: No
12195
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020012196no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012197 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012198 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
12199 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012200 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
12201 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012202 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020012203
12204 Supported in default-server: No
12205
12206no-tlsv13
12207 This option disables support for TLSv1.3 when SSL is used to communicate with
12208 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
12209 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
12210 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
12211 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012212 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012213
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020012214 Supported in default-server: No
12215
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012216no-verifyhost
12217 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "verifyhost"
12218 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12219 default value.
12220 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12221 "default-server" "verifyhost" setting.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012222
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +090012223non-stick
12224 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
12225 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
12226 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
12227
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010012228npn <protocols>
12229 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
12230 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
12231 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
12232 This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
12233 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
12234 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
12235 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2.
12236
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010012237observe <mode>
12238 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
12239 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
12240 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
12241 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
12242 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
12243 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +010012244 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010012245
12246 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
12247
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012248on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010012249 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
12250 Currently, four modes are available:
12251 - fastinter: force fastinter
12252 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
12253 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
12254 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
12255 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
12256
12257 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
12258
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090012259on-marked-down <action>
12260 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
12261 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070012262 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
12263 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
12264 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
12265 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
12266 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
12267 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
12268 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
12269 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090012270
12271 Actions are disabled by default
12272
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070012273on-marked-up <action>
12274 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
12275 Currently one action is available:
12276 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
12277 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
12278 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
12279 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012280 with long sessions (e.g. LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
12281 than it tries to solve (e.g. incomplete transactions), so use this feature
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070012282 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
12283 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
12284
12285 Actions are disabled by default
12286
Olivier Houchard006e3102018-12-10 18:30:32 +010012287pool-max-conn <max>
12288 Set the maximum number of idling connections for a server. -1 means unlimited
12289 connections, 0 means no idle connections. The default is -1. When idle
12290 connections are enabled, orphaned idle connections which do not belong to any
12291 client session anymore are moved to a dedicated pool so that they remain
12292 usable by future clients. This only applies to connections that can be shared
12293 according to the same principles as those applying to "http-reuse".
12294
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010012295pool-purge-delay <delay>
12296 Sets the delay to start purging idle connections. Each <delay> interval, half
Olivier Houcharda56eebf2019-03-19 16:44:02 +010012297 of the idle connections are closed. 0 means we don't keep any idle connection.
12298 The default is 1s.
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010012299
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012300port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012301 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
12302 send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate a port
12303 to a specific component able to perform complex tests which are more suitable
12304 to health-checks than the application. It is common to run a simple script in
12305 inetd for instance. This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not
12306 set. See also the "addr" parameter.
12307
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020012308proto <name>
12309
12310 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the outgoing connections to this
12311 server. It must be compatible with the mode of the backend (TCP or HTTP). It
12312 must also be usable on the backend side. The list of available protocols is
12313 reported in haproxy -vv.
12314 Idea behind this optipon is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
12315 protocol for all connections established to this server.
12316
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012317redir <prefix>
12318 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
12319 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
12320 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
12321 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
12322 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
12323 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
12324 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
12325 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012326 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012327 requests are still analyzed, making this solution completely usable to direct
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012328 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
12329 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
12330 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
12331 loop between the client and HAProxy!
12332
12333 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
12334
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012335rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012336 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
12337 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
12338 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
12339
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020012340resolve-opts <option>,<option>,...
12341 Comma separated list of options to apply to DNS resolution linked to this
12342 server.
12343
12344 Available options:
12345
12346 * allow-dup-ip
12347 By default, HAProxy prevents IP address duplication in a backend when DNS
12348 resolution at runtime is in operation.
12349 That said, for some cases, it makes sense that two servers (in the same
12350 backend, being resolved by the same FQDN) have the same IP address.
12351 For such case, simply enable this option.
12352 This is the opposite of prevent-dup-ip.
12353
12354 * prevent-dup-ip
12355 Ensure HAProxy's default behavior is enforced on a server: prevent re-using
12356 an IP address already set to a server in the same backend and sharing the
12357 same fqdn.
12358 This is the opposite of allow-dup-ip.
12359
12360 Example:
12361 backend b_myapp
12362 default-server init-addr none resolvers dns
12363 server s1 myapp.example.com:80 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
12364 server s2 myapp.example.com:81 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
12365
12366 With the option allow-dup-ip set:
12367 * if the nameserver returns a single IP address, then both servers will use
12368 it
12369 * If the nameserver returns 2 IP addresses, then each server will pick up a
12370 different address
12371
12372 Default value: not set
12373
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012374resolve-prefer <family>
12375 When DNS resolution is enabled for a server and multiple IP addresses from
12376 different families are returned, HAProxy will prefer using an IP address
12377 from the family mentioned in the "resolve-prefer" parameter.
12378 Available families: "ipv4" and "ipv6"
12379
Baptiste Assmannc4aabae2015-08-04 22:43:06 +020012380 Default value: ipv6
12381
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012382 Example:
12383
12384 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-prefer ipv6
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012385
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010012386resolve-net <network>[,<network[,...]]
12387 This options prioritize th choice of an ip address matching a network. This is
12388 useful with clouds to prefer a local ip. In some cases, a cloud high
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010012389 availability service can be announced with many ip addresses on many
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012390 different datacenters. The latency between datacenter is not negligible, so
12391 this patch permits to prefer a local datacenter. If no address matches the
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010012392 configured network, another address is selected.
12393
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012394 Example:
12395
12396 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-net 10.0.0.0/8
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010012397
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012398resolvers <id>
12399 Points to an existing "resolvers" section to resolve current server's
12400 hostname.
12401
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012402 Example:
12403
12404 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 check resolvers mydns
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012405
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012406 See also section 5.3
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012407
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010012408send-proxy
12409 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
12410 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
12411 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
12412 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010012413 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" or
12414 "accept-netscaler-cip" listener, the advertised address will be used. Only
12415 TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families are supported. Other families such as
12416 Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN family. Servers using this option can
12417 fully be chained to another instance of haproxy listening with an
12418 "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be used if the server isn't
12419 aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent to the server, the PROXY
12420 protocol is automatically used when this option is set, unless there is an
12421 explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an explicit
12422 "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012423 See also the "no-send-proxy" option of this section and "accept-proxy" and
12424 "accept-netscaler-cip" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010012425
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012426send-proxy-v2
12427 The "send-proxy-v2" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version 2
12428 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
12429 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
12430 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
Emmanuel Hocdet404d9782017-10-24 10:55:14 +020012431 whatever the upper layer protocol. It also send ALPN information if an alpn
12432 have been negotiated. This setting must not be used if the server isn't aware
12433 of this version of the protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2" option of
12434 this section and send-proxy" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012435
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010012436proxy-v2-options <option>[,<option>]*
12437 The "proxy-v2-options" parameter add option to send in PROXY protocol version
12438 2 when "send-proxy-v2" is used. Options available are "ssl" (see also
Emmanuel Hocdetfa8d0f12018-02-01 15:53:52 +010012439 send-proxy-v2-ssl), "cert-cn" (see also "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn"), "ssl-cipher":
12440 name of the used cipher, "cert-sig": signature algorithm of the used
Emmanuel Hocdet253c3b72018-02-01 18:29:59 +010012441 certificate, "cert-key": key algorithm of the used certificate), "authority":
12442 host name value passed by the client (only sni from a tls connection is
Emmanuel Hocdet4399c752018-02-05 15:26:43 +010012443 supported), "crc32c": checksum of the proxy protocol v2 header.
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010012444
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012445send-proxy-v2-ssl
12446 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
12447 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
12448 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
12449 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
12450 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
12451 of the PROXY protocol is added to the PROXY protocol header. This setting
12452 must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012453 See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl" option of this section and the
12454 "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012455
12456send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
12457 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
12458 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
12459 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
12460 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
12461 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
12462 of the PROXY protocol, along along with the Common Name from the subject of
12463 the client certificate (if any), is added to the PROXY protocol header. This
12464 setting must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012465 protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" option of this section and
12466 the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012467
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012468slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012469 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
12470 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
12471 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
12472 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
12473 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
12474 parameters :
12475
12476 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
12477 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
12478
12479 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
12480 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
12481 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
12482 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
12483
12484 The slowstart never applies when haproxy starts, otherwise it would cause
12485 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
12486 seen as failed.
12487
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020012488sni <expression>
12489 The "sni" parameter evaluates the sample fetch expression, converts it to a
12490 string and uses the result as the host name sent in the SNI TLS extension to
12491 the server. A typical use case is to send the SNI received from the client in
12492 a bridged HTTPS scenario, using the "ssl_fc_sni" sample fetch for the
Willy Tarreau2ab88672017-07-05 18:23:03 +020012493 expression, though alternatives such as req.hdr(host) can also make sense. If
12494 "verify required" is set (which is the recommended setting), the resulting
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020012495 name will also be matched against the server certificate's names. See the
Jérôme Magninb36a6d22018-12-09 16:03:40 +010012496 "verify" directive for more details. If you want to set a SNI for health
12497 checks, see the "check-sni" directive for more details.
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020012498
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020012499source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020012500source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020012501source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012502 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
12503 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
12504 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
12505 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
12506
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020012507 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
12508 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
12509 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
12510 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
12511 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
12512 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
12513 server.
12514
Lukas Tribus7d56c6d2016-09-13 09:51:15 +000012515 Since Linux 4.2/libc 2.23 IP_BIND_ADDRESS_NO_PORT is set for connections
12516 specifying the source address without port(s).
12517
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012518ssl
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +020012519 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. It
12520 is critical to verify server certificates using "verify" when using SSL to
12521 connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man in
12522 the-middle attacks rendering SSL useless. When this option is used, health
12523 checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there is a "port" or an
12524 "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a different location.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012525 See the "no-ssl" to disable "ssl" option and "check-ssl" option to force
12526 SSL health checks.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012527
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012528ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
12529 This option enforces use of <version> or lower when SSL is used to communicate
12530 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
12531 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
12532
12533ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
12534 This option enforces use of <version> or upper when SSL is used to communicate
12535 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
12536 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-max-ver".
12537
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012538ssl-reuse
12539 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-ssl-reuse"
12540 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12541 default value.
12542 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12543 "default-server" "no-ssl-reuse" setting.
12544
12545stick
12546 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "non-stick"
12547 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12548 default value.
12549 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12550 "default-server" "non-stick" setting.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012551
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020012552tcp-ut <delay>
12553 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all outgoing connections to this server. This
12554 option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It allows haproxy to
12555 configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not receiving an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012556 acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially useful on
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020012557 long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as remote
12558 terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server timeouts
12559 must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is important to
12560 detect that the server has disappeared in order to release all resources
12561 associated with its connection (and the client's session). One typical use
12562 case is also to force dead server connections to die when health checks are
12563 too slow or during a soft reload since health checks are then disabled. The
12564 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works for
12565 regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
12566
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010012567tfo
12568 This option enables using TCP fast open when connecting to servers, on
12569 systems that support it (currently only the Linux kernel >= 4.11).
12570 See the "tfo" bind option for more information about TCP fast open.
12571 Please note that when using tfo, you should also use the "conn-failure",
12572 "empty-response" and "response-timeout" keywords for "retry-on", or haproxy
12573 won't be able to retry the connection on failure.
12574
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012575track [<proxy>/]<server>
Willy Tarreau32091232014-05-16 13:52:00 +020012576 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by tracking
12577 another one. It is possible to track a server which itself tracks another
12578 server, provided that at the end of the chain, a server has health checks
12579 enabled. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012580 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
12581
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012582tls-tickets
12583 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-tls-tickets"
12584 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12585 default value.
12586 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12587 "default-server" "no-tlsv-tickets" setting.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012588
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020012589verify [none|required]
12590 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +010012591 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. In the other case, The
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020012592 certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from 'ca-file' and
12593 optional CRLs from 'crl-file' after having checked that the names provided in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012594 the certificate's subject and subjectAlternateNames attributes match either
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020012595 the name passed using the "sni" directive, or if not provided, the static
12596 host name passed using the "verifyhost" directive. When no name is found, the
12597 certificate's names are ignored. For this reason, without SNI it's important
12598 to use "verifyhost". On verification failure the handshake is aborted. It is
12599 critically important to verify server certificates when using SSL to connect
12600 to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man-in-the-middle
12601 attacks rendering SSL totally useless. Unless "ssl_server_verify" appears in
12602 the global section, "verify" is set to "required" by default.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020012603
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070012604verifyhost <hostname>
12605 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in, and
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020012606 only takes effect if 'verify required' is also specified. This directive sets
12607 a default static hostname to check the server's certificate against when no
12608 SNI was used to connect to the server. If SNI is not used, this is the only
12609 way to enable hostname verification. This static hostname, when set, will
12610 also be used for health checks (which cannot provide an SNI value). If none
12611 of the hostnames in the certificate match the specified hostname, the
12612 handshake is aborted. The hostnames in the server-provided certificate may
12613 include wildcards. See also "verify", "sni" and "no-verifyhost" options.
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070012614
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012615weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012616 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
12617 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
12618 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +020012619 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
12620 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
12621 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
12622 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
12623 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
12624 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012625
12626
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200126275.3. Server IP address resolution using DNS
12628-------------------------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012629
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012630HAProxy allows using a host name on the server line to retrieve its IP address
12631using name servers. By default, HAProxy resolves the name when parsing the
12632configuration file, at startup and cache the result for the process' life.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012633This is not sufficient in some cases, such as in Amazon where a server's IP
12634can change after a reboot or an ELB Virtual IP can change based on current
12635workload.
12636This chapter describes how HAProxy can be configured to process server's name
12637resolution at run time.
12638Whether run time server name resolution has been enable or not, HAProxy will
12639carry on doing the first resolution when parsing the configuration.
12640
12641
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200126425.3.1. Global overview
12643----------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012644
12645As we've seen in introduction, name resolution in HAProxy occurs at two
12646different steps of the process life:
12647
12648 1. when starting up, HAProxy parses the server line definition and matches a
12649 host name. It uses libc functions to get the host name resolved. This
12650 resolution relies on /etc/resolv.conf file.
12651
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012652 2. at run time, HAProxy performs periodically name resolutions for servers
12653 requiring DNS resolutions.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012654
12655A few other events can trigger a name resolution at run time:
12656 - when a server's health check ends up in a connection timeout: this may be
12657 because the server has a new IP address. So we need to trigger a name
12658 resolution to know this new IP.
12659
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012660When using resolvers, the server name can either be a hostname, or a SRV label.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012661HAProxy considers anything that starts with an underscore as a SRV label. If a
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012662SRV label is specified, then the corresponding SRV records will be retrieved
12663from the DNS server, and the provided hostnames will be used. The SRV label
12664will be checked periodically, and if any server are added or removed, haproxy
12665will automatically do the same.
Olivier Houchardecfa18d2017-08-07 17:30:03 +020012666
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012667A few things important to notice:
12668 - all the name servers are queried in the mean time. HAProxy will process the
12669 first valid response.
12670
12671 - a resolution is considered as invalid (NX, timeout, refused), when all the
12672 servers return an error.
12673
12674
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200126755.3.2. The resolvers section
12676----------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012677
12678This section is dedicated to host information related to name resolution in
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012679HAProxy. There can be as many as resolvers section as needed. Each section can
12680contain many name servers.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012681
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012682When multiple name servers are configured in a resolvers section, then HAProxy
12683uses the first valid response. In case of invalid responses, only the last one
12684is treated. Purpose is to give the chance to a slow server to deliver a valid
12685answer after a fast faulty or outdated server.
12686
12687When each server returns a different error type, then only the last error is
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012688used by HAProxy. The following processing is applied on this error:
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012689
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012690 1. HAProxy retries the same DNS query with a new query type. The A queries are
12691 switch to AAAA or the opposite. SRV queries are not concerned here. Timeout
12692 errors are also excluded.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012693
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012694 2. When the fallback on the query type was done (or not applicable), HAProxy
12695 retries the original DNS query, with the preferred query type.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012696
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012697 3. HAProxy retries previous steps <resolve_retires> times. If no valid
12698 response is received after that, it stops the DNS resolution and reports
12699 the error.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012700
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012701For example, with 2 name servers configured in a resolvers section, the
12702following scenarios are possible:
12703
12704 - First response is valid and is applied directly, second response is
12705 ignored
12706
12707 - First response is invalid and second one is valid, then second response is
12708 applied
12709
12710 - First response is a NX domain and second one a truncated response, then
12711 HAProxy retries the query with a new type
12712
12713 - First response is a NX domain and second one is a timeout, then HAProxy
12714 retries the query with a new type
12715
12716 - Query timed out for both name servers, then HAProxy retries it with the
12717 same query type
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012718
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020012719As a DNS server may not answer all the IPs in one DNS request, haproxy keeps
12720a cache of previous answers, an answer will be considered obsolete after
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012721<hold obsolete> seconds without the IP returned.
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020012722
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012723
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012724resolvers <resolvers id>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012725 Creates a new name server list labeled <resolvers id>
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012726
12727A resolvers section accept the following parameters:
12728
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020012729accepted_payload_size <nb>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012730 Defines the maximum payload size accepted by HAProxy and announced to all the
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012731 name servers configured in this resolvers section.
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020012732 <nb> is in bytes. If not set, HAProxy announces 512. (minimal value defined
12733 by RFC 6891)
12734
Baptiste Assmann9d8dbbc2017-08-18 23:35:08 +020012735 Note: the maximum allowed value is 8192.
12736
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012737nameserver <id> <ip>:<port>
12738 DNS server description:
12739 <id> : label of the server, should be unique
12740 <ip> : IP address of the server
12741 <port> : port where the DNS service actually runs
12742
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060012743parse-resolv-conf
12744 Adds all nameservers found in /etc/resolv.conf to this resolvers nameservers
12745 list. Ordered as if each nameserver in /etc/resolv.conf was individually
12746 placed in the resolvers section in place of this directive.
12747
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012748hold <status> <period>
12749 Defines <period> during which the last name resolution should be kept based
12750 on last resolution <status>
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010012751 <status> : last name resolution status. Acceptable values are "nx",
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020012752 "other", "refused", "timeout", "valid", "obsolete".
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012753 <period> : interval between two successive name resolution when the last
12754 answer was in <status>. It follows the HAProxy time format.
12755 <period> is in milliseconds by default.
12756
Baptiste Assmann686408b2017-08-18 10:15:42 +020012757 Default value is 10s for "valid", 0s for "obsolete" and 30s for others.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012758
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012759resolution_pool_size <nb> (deprecated)
Baptiste Assmann201c07f2017-05-22 15:17:15 +020012760 Defines the number of resolutions available in the pool for this resolvers.
12761 If not defines, it defaults to 64. If your configuration requires more than
12762 <nb>, then HAProxy will return an error when parsing the configuration.
12763
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012764resolve_retries <nb>
12765 Defines the number <nb> of queries to send to resolve a server name before
12766 giving up.
12767 Default value: 3
12768
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012769 A retry occurs on name server timeout or when the full sequence of DNS query
12770 type failover is over and we need to start up from the default ANY query
12771 type.
12772
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012773timeout <event> <time>
12774 Defines timeouts related to name resolution
12775 <event> : the event on which the <time> timeout period applies to.
12776 events available are:
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010012777 - resolve : default time to trigger name resolutions when no
12778 other time applied.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012779 Default value: 1s
12780 - retry : time between two DNS queries, when no valid response
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010012781 have been received.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012782 Default value: 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012783 <time> : time related to the event. It follows the HAProxy time format.
12784 <time> is expressed in milliseconds.
12785
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012786 Example:
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012787
12788 resolvers mydns
12789 nameserver dns1 10.0.0.1:53
12790 nameserver dns2 10.0.0.2:53
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060012791 parse-resolv-conf
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012792 resolve_retries 3
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012793 timeout resolve 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012794 timeout retry 1s
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010012795 hold other 30s
12796 hold refused 30s
12797 hold nx 30s
12798 hold timeout 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012799 hold valid 10s
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020012800 hold obsolete 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012801
12802
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200128036. HTTP header manipulation
12804---------------------------
12805
12806In HTTP mode, it is possible to rewrite, add or delete some of the request and
12807response headers based on regular expressions. It is also possible to block a
12808request or a response if a particular header matches a regular expression,
12809which is enough to stop most elementary protocol attacks, and to protect
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +010012810against information leak from the internal network.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012811
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +010012812If HAProxy encounters an "Informational Response" (status code 1xx), it is able
12813to process all rsp* rules which can allow, deny, rewrite or delete a header,
12814but it will refuse to add a header to any such messages as this is not
12815HTTP-compliant. The reason for still processing headers in such responses is to
12816stop and/or fix any possible information leak which may happen, for instance
12817because another downstream equipment would unconditionally add a header, or if
12818a server name appears there. When such messages are seen, normal processing
12819still occurs on the next non-informational messages.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +020012820
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012821This section covers common usage of the following keywords, described in detail
12822in section 4.2 :
12823
12824 - reqadd <string>
12825 - reqallow <search>
12826 - reqiallow <search>
12827 - reqdel <search>
12828 - reqidel <search>
12829 - reqdeny <search>
12830 - reqideny <search>
12831 - reqpass <search>
12832 - reqipass <search>
12833 - reqrep <search> <replace>
12834 - reqirep <search> <replace>
12835 - reqtarpit <search>
12836 - reqitarpit <search>
12837 - rspadd <string>
12838 - rspdel <search>
12839 - rspidel <search>
12840 - rspdeny <search>
12841 - rspideny <search>
12842 - rsprep <search> <replace>
12843 - rspirep <search> <replace>
12844
12845With all these keywords, the same conventions are used. The <search> parameter
12846is a POSIX extended regular expression (regex) which supports grouping through
12847parenthesis (without the backslash). Spaces and other delimiters must be
12848prefixed with a backslash ('\') to avoid confusion with a field delimiter.
12849Other characters may be prefixed with a backslash to change their meaning :
12850
12851 \t for a tab
12852 \r for a carriage return (CR)
12853 \n for a new line (LF)
12854 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
12855 \# to mark a sharp and differentiate it from a comment
12856 \\ to use a backslash in a regex
12857 \\\\ to use a backslash in the text (*2 for regex, *2 for haproxy)
12858 \xXX to write the ASCII hex code XX as in the C language
12859
12860The <replace> parameter contains the string to be used to replace the largest
12861portion of text matching the regex. It can make use of the special characters
12862above, and can reference a substring which is delimited by parenthesis in the
12863regex, by writing a backslash ('\') immediately followed by one digit from 0 to
128649 indicating the group position (0 designating the entire line). This practice
12865is very common to users of the "sed" program.
12866
12867The <string> parameter represents the string which will systematically be added
12868after the last header line. It can also use special character sequences above.
12869
12870Notes related to these keywords :
12871---------------------------------
12872 - these keywords are not always convenient to allow/deny based on header
12873 contents. It is strongly recommended to use ACLs with the "block" keyword
12874 instead, resulting in far more flexible and manageable rules.
12875
12876 - lines are always considered as a whole. It is not possible to reference
12877 a header name only or a value only. This is important because of the way
12878 headers are written (notably the number of spaces after the colon).
12879
12880 - the first line is always considered as a header, which makes it possible to
12881 rewrite or filter HTTP requests URIs or response codes, but in turn makes
12882 it harder to distinguish between headers and request line. The regex prefix
12883 ^[^\ \t]*[\ \t] matches any HTTP method followed by a space, and the prefix
12884 ^[^ \t:]*: matches any header name followed by a colon.
12885
12886 - for performances reasons, the number of characters added to a request or to
12887 a response is limited at build time to values between 1 and 4 kB. This
12888 should normally be far more than enough for most usages. If it is too short
12889 on occasional usages, it is possible to gain some space by removing some
12890 useless headers before adding new ones.
12891
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012892 - keywords beginning with "reqi" and "rspi" are the same as their counterpart
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012893 without the 'i' letter except that they ignore case when matching patterns.
12894
12895 - when a request passes through a frontend then a backend, all req* rules
12896 from the frontend will be evaluated, then all req* rules from the backend
12897 will be evaluated. The reverse path is applied to responses.
12898
12899 - req* statements are applied after "block" statements, so that "block" is
12900 always the first one, but before "use_backend" in order to permit rewriting
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012901 before switching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012902
12903
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200129047. Using ACLs and fetching samples
12905----------------------------------
12906
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012907HAProxy is capable of extracting data from request or response streams, from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012908client or server information, from tables, environmental information etc...
12909The action of extracting such data is called fetching a sample. Once retrieved,
12910these samples may be used for various purposes such as a key to a stick-table,
12911but most common usages consist in matching them against predefined constant
12912data called patterns.
12913
12914
129157.1. ACL basics
12916---------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012917
12918The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
12919content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
12920from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
12921simple :
12922
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012923 - extract a data sample from a stream, table or the environment
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012924 - optionally apply some format conversion to the extracted sample
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012925 - apply one or multiple pattern matching methods on this sample
12926 - perform actions only when a pattern matches the sample
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012927
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012928The actions generally consist in blocking a request, selecting a backend, or
12929adding a header.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012930
12931In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
12932
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012933 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] [<value>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012934
12935This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
12936Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
12937and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012938an operator which may be specified before the set of values. Optionally some
12939conversion operators may be applied to the sample, and they will be specified
12940as a comma-delimited list of keywords just after the first keyword. The values
12941are of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012942
12943ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
12944'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
12945which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
12946
12947There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
12948performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
12949
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012950The criterion generally is the name of a sample fetch method, or one of its ACL
12951specific declinations. The default test method is implied by the output type of
12952this sample fetch method. The ACL declinations can describe alternate matching
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012953methods of a same sample fetch method. The sample fetch methods are the only
12954ones supporting a conversion.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012955
12956Sample fetch methods return data which can be of the following types :
12957 - boolean
12958 - integer (signed or unsigned)
12959 - IPv4 or IPv6 address
12960 - string
12961 - data block
12962
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012963Converters transform any of these data into any of these. For example, some
12964converters might convert a string to a lower-case string while other ones
12965would turn a string to an IPv4 address, or apply a netmask to an IP address.
12966The resulting sample is of the type of the last converter applied to the list,
12967which defaults to the type of the sample fetch method.
12968
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012969Each sample or converter returns data of a specific type, specified with its
12970keyword in this documentation. When an ACL is declared using a standard sample
12971fetch method, certain types automatically involved a default matching method
12972which are summarized in the table below :
12973
12974 +---------------------+-----------------+
12975 | Sample or converter | Default |
12976 | output type | matching method |
12977 +---------------------+-----------------+
12978 | boolean | bool |
12979 +---------------------+-----------------+
12980 | integer | int |
12981 +---------------------+-----------------+
12982 | ip | ip |
12983 +---------------------+-----------------+
12984 | string | str |
12985 +---------------------+-----------------+
12986 | binary | none, use "-m" |
12987 +---------------------+-----------------+
12988
12989Note that in order to match a binary samples, it is mandatory to specify a
12990matching method, see below.
12991
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012992The ACL engine can match these types against patterns of the following types :
12993 - boolean
12994 - integer or integer range
12995 - IP address / network
12996 - string (exact, substring, suffix, prefix, subdir, domain)
12997 - regular expression
12998 - hex block
12999
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013000The following ACL flags are currently supported :
13001
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020013002 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
13003 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013004 -m : use a specific pattern matching method
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010013005 -n : forbid the DNS resolutions
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010013006 -M : load the file pointed by -f like a map file.
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010013007 -u : force the unique id of the ACL
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013008 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
13009
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013010The "-f" flag is followed by the name of a file from which all lines will be
13011read as individual values. It is even possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments
13012if the patterns are to be loaded from multiple files. Empty lines as well as
13013lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs
13014will be stripped. If it is absolutely necessary to insert a valid pattern
13015beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a space so that it is not taken for
13016a comment. Depending on the data type and match method, haproxy may load the
13017lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast lookups. This is true for IPv4 and
13018exact string matching. In this case, duplicates will automatically be removed.
13019
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010013020The "-M" flag allows an ACL to use a map file. If this flag is set, the file is
13021parsed as two column file. The first column contains the patterns used by the
13022ACL, and the second column contain the samples. The sample can be used later by
13023a map. This can be useful in some rare cases where an ACL would just be used to
13024check for the existence of a pattern in a map before a mapping is applied.
13025
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010013026The "-u" flag forces the unique id of the ACL. This unique id is used with the
13027socket interface to identify ACL and dynamically change its values. Note that a
13028file is always identified by its name even if an id is set.
13029
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013030Also, note that the "-i" flag applies to subsequent entries and not to entries
13031loaded from files preceding it. For instance :
13032
13033 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
13034
13035In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
13036the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
13037case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
13038as well.
13039
13040The "-m" flag is used to select a specific pattern matching method on the input
13041sample. All ACL-specific criteria imply a pattern matching method and generally
13042do not need this flag. However, this flag is useful with generic sample fetch
13043methods to describe how they're going to be matched against the patterns. This
13044is required for sample fetches which return data type for which there is no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013045obvious matching method (e.g. string or binary). When "-m" is specified and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013046followed by a pattern matching method name, this method is used instead of the
13047default one for the criterion. This makes it possible to match contents in ways
13048that were not initially planned, or with sample fetch methods which return a
13049string. The matching method also affects the way the patterns are parsed.
13050
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010013051The "-n" flag forbids the dns resolutions. It is used with the load of ip files.
13052By default, if the parser cannot parse ip address it considers that the parsed
13053string is maybe a domain name and try dns resolution. The flag "-n" disable this
13054resolution. It is useful for detecting malformed ip lists. Note that if the DNS
13055server is not reachable, the haproxy configuration parsing may last many minutes
13056waiting fir the timeout. During this time no error messages are displayed. The
13057flag "-n" disable this behavior. Note also that during the runtime, this
13058function is disabled for the dynamic acl modifications.
13059
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013060There are some restrictions however. Not all methods can be used with all
13061sample fetch methods. Also, if "-m" is used in conjunction with "-f", it must
13062be placed first. The pattern matching method must be one of the following :
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013063
13064 - "found" : only check if the requested sample could be found in the stream,
13065 but do not compare it against any pattern. It is recommended not
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013066 to pass any pattern to avoid confusion. This matching method is
13067 particularly useful to detect presence of certain contents such
13068 as headers, cookies, etc... even if they are empty and without
13069 comparing them to anything nor counting them.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013070
13071 - "bool" : check the value as a boolean. It can only be applied to fetches
13072 which return a boolean or integer value, and takes no pattern.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013073 Value zero or false does not match, all other values do match.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013074
13075 - "int" : match the value as an integer. It can be used with integer and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013076 boolean samples. Boolean false is integer 0, true is integer 1.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013077
13078 - "ip" : match the value as an IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is compatible
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013079 with IP address samples only, so it is implied and never needed.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013080
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013081 - "bin" : match the contents against a hexadecimal string representing a
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013082 binary sequence. This may be used with binary or string samples.
13083
13084 - "len" : match the sample's length as an integer. This may be used with
13085 binary or string samples.
13086
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013087 - "str" : exact match : match the contents against a string. This may be
13088 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013089
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013090 - "sub" : substring match : check that the contents contain at least one of
13091 the provided string patterns. This may be used with binary or
13092 string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013093
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013094 - "reg" : regex match : match the contents against a list of regular
13095 expressions. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013096
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013097 - "beg" : prefix match : check that the contents begin like the provided
13098 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013099
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013100 - "end" : suffix match : check that the contents end like the provided
13101 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013102
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013103 - "dir" : subdir match : check that a slash-delimited portion of the
13104 contents exactly matches one of the provided string patterns.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013105 This may be used with binary or string samples.
13106
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013107 - "dom" : domain match : check that a dot-delimited portion of the contents
13108 exactly match one of the provided string patterns. This may be
13109 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013110
13111For example, to quickly detect the presence of cookie "JSESSIONID" in an HTTP
13112request, it is possible to do :
13113
13114 acl jsess_present cook(JSESSIONID) -m found
13115
13116In order to apply a regular expression on the 500 first bytes of data in the
13117buffer, one would use the following acl :
13118
13119 acl script_tag payload(0,500) -m reg -i <script>
13120
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013121On systems where the regex library is much slower when using "-i", it is
13122possible to convert the sample to lowercase before matching, like this :
13123
13124 acl script_tag payload(0,500),lower -m reg <script>
13125
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013126All ACL-specific criteria imply a default matching method. Most often, these
13127criteria are composed by concatenating the name of the original sample fetch
13128method and the matching method. For example, "hdr_beg" applies the "beg" match
13129to samples retrieved using the "hdr" fetch method. Since all ACL-specific
13130criteria rely on a sample fetch method, it is always possible instead to use
13131the original sample fetch method and the explicit matching method using "-m".
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020013132
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013133If an alternate match is specified using "-m" on an ACL-specific criterion,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013134the matching method is simply applied to the underlying sample fetch method.
13135For example, all ACLs below are exact equivalent :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020013136
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013137 acl short_form hdr_beg(host) www.
13138 acl alternate1 hdr_beg(host) -m beg www.
13139 acl alternate2 hdr_dom(host) -m beg www.
13140 acl alternate3 hdr(host) -m beg www.
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020013141
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020013142
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020013143The table below summarizes the compatibility matrix between sample or converter
13144types and the pattern types to fetch against. It indicates for each compatible
13145combination the name of the matching method to be used, surrounded with angle
13146brackets ">" and "<" when the method is the default one and will work by
13147default without "-m".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013148
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013149 +-------------------------------------------------+
13150 | Input sample type |
13151 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020013152 | pattern type | boolean | integer | ip | string | binary |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013153 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
13154 | none (presence only) | found | found | found | found | found |
13155 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020013156 | none (boolean value) |> bool <| bool | | bool | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013157 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020013158 | integer (value) | int |> int <| int | int | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013159 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013160 | integer (length) | len | len | len | len | len |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013161 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020013162 | IP address | | |> ip <| ip | ip |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013163 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020013164 | exact string | str | str | str |> str <| str |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013165 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013166 | prefix | beg | beg | beg | beg | beg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013167 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013168 | suffix | end | end | end | end | end |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013169 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013170 | substring | sub | sub | sub | sub | sub |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013171 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013172 | subdir | dir | dir | dir | dir | dir |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013173 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013174 | domain | dom | dom | dom | dom | dom |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013175 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013176 | regex | reg | reg | reg | reg | reg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013177 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
13178 | hex block | | | | bin | bin |
13179 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013180
13181
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200131827.1.1. Matching booleans
13183------------------------
13184
13185In order to match a boolean, no value is needed and all values are ignored.
13186Boolean matching is used by default for all fetch methods of type "boolean".
13187When boolean matching is used, the fetched value is returned as-is, which means
13188that a boolean "true" will always match and a boolean "false" will never match.
13189
13190Boolean matching may also be enforced using "-m bool" on fetch methods which
13191return an integer value. Then, integer value 0 is converted to the boolean
13192"false" and all other values are converted to "true".
13193
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013194
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200131957.1.2. Matching integers
13196------------------------
13197
13198Integer matching applies by default to integer fetch methods. It can also be
13199enforced on boolean fetches using "-m int". In this case, "false" is converted
13200to the integer 0, and "true" is converted to the integer 1.
13201
13202Integer matching also supports integer ranges and operators. Note that integer
13203matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value expressed with a
13204lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which may be omitted.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013205
13206For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
13207unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
13208representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
13209
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013210As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
13211two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
13212instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
13213ranges and operators.
13214
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013215For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013216operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
13217Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
13218of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013219
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013220Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013221
13222 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
13223 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
13224 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
13225 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
13226 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
13227
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013228For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013229
13230 acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
13231
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013232This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
13233
13234 acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
13235
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013236
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200132377.1.3. Matching strings
13238-----------------------
13239
13240String matching applies to string or binary fetch methods, and exists in 6
13241different forms :
13242
13243 - exact match (-m str) : the extracted string must exactly match the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013244 patterns;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013245
13246 - substring match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013247 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them is found inside;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013248
13249 - prefix match (-m beg) : the patterns are compared with the beginning of
13250 the extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
13251
13252 - suffix match (-m end) : the patterns are compared with the end of the
13253 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
13254
Baptiste Assmann33db6002016-03-06 23:32:10 +010013255 - subdir match (-m dir) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013256 string, delimited with slashes ("/"), and the ACL matches if any of them
13257 matches.
13258
13259 - domain match (-m dom) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
13260 string, delimited with dots ("."), and the ACL matches if any of them
13261 matches.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013262
13263String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
13264exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
13265characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
13266string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
13267to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013268before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013269
13270
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200132717.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
13272---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013273
13274Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
13275they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
13276possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
13277passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
13278the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013279the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
13280match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013281
13282
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200132837.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
13284-------------------------------------
13285
13286It is possible to match some extracted samples against a binary block which may
13287not safely be represented as a string. For this, the patterns must be passed as
13288a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number, when the match method is set
13289to binary. Each sequence of two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal
13290digits may be used upper or lower case.
13291
13292Example :
13293 # match "Hello\n" in the input stream (\x48 \x65 \x6c \x6c \x6f \x0a)
13294 acl hello payload(0,6) -m bin 48656c6c6f0a
13295
13296
132977.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
13298---------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013299
13300IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
13301netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
13302within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010013303host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013304difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
13305at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
13306does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
13307parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013308
Daniel Schnellereba56342016-04-13 00:26:52 +020013309The dotted IPv4 address notation is supported in both regular as well as the
13310abbreviated form with all-0-octets omitted:
13311
13312 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
13313 | Example 1 | Example 2 | Example 3 |
13314 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
13315 | 192.168.0.1 | 10.0.0.12 | 127.0.0.1 |
13316 | 192.168.1 | 10.12 | 127.1 |
13317 | 192.168.0.1/22 | 10.0.0.12/8 | 127.0.0.1/8 |
13318 | 192.168.1/22 | 10.12/8 | 127.1/8 |
13319 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
13320
13321Notice that this is different from RFC 4632 CIDR address notation in which
13322192.168.42/24 would be equivalent to 192.168.42.0/24.
13323
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020013324IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
13325Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
13326trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
13327IPv6 patterns.
13328
13329HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
13330following situations :
13331 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
13332 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
13333 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
13334 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
13335 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
13336 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
13337 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
13338 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
13339 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
13340 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
13341
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013342
133437.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
13344----------------------------------
13345
13346Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
13347combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
13348
13349 - AND (implicit)
13350 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
13351 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013352
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013353A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013354
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013355 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020013356
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013357Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
13358indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020013359
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013360For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
13361"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
13362requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
13363is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
13364
13365 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030013366 http-request deny if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
13367 http-request deny if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
13368 http-request deny unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013369
13370To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
13371and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
13372
13373 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
13374 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
13375 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
13376 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
13377
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013378 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static URLs
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013379 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
13380 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
13381 use_backend www if host_www
13382
13383It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
13384expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
13385be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
13386the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
13387
13388 The following rule :
13389
13390 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030013391 http-request deny if METH_POST missing_cl
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013392
13393 Can also be written that way :
13394
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030013395 http-request deny if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013396
13397It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
13398to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
13399simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
13400sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
13401good use is the following :
13402
13403 With named ACLs :
13404
13405 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
13406 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
13407 monitor fail if site_dead
13408
13409 With anonymous ACLs :
13410
13411 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
13412
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030013413See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "http-request deny" and "use_backend"
13414keywords.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013415
13416
134177.3. Fetching samples
13418---------------------
13419
13420Historically, sample fetch methods were only used to retrieve data to match
13421against patterns using ACLs. With the arrival of stick-tables, a new class of
13422sample fetch methods was created, most often sharing the same syntax as their
13423ACL counterpart. These sample fetch methods are also known as "fetches". As
13424of now, ACLs and fetches have converged. All ACL fetch methods have been made
13425available as fetch methods, and ACLs may use any sample fetch method as well.
13426
13427This section details all available sample fetch methods and their output type.
13428Some sample fetch methods have deprecated aliases that are used to maintain
13429compatibility with existing configurations. They are then explicitly marked as
13430deprecated and should not be used in new setups.
13431
13432The ACL derivatives are also indicated when available, with their respective
13433matching methods. These ones all have a well defined default pattern matching
13434method, so it is never necessary (though allowed) to pass the "-m" option to
13435indicate how the sample will be matched using ACLs.
13436
13437As indicated in the sample type versus matching compatibility matrix above,
13438when using a generic sample fetch method in an ACL, the "-m" option is
13439mandatory unless the sample type is one of boolean, integer, IPv4 or IPv6. When
13440the same keyword exists as an ACL keyword and as a standard fetch method, the
13441ACL engine will automatically pick the ACL-only one by default.
13442
13443Some of these keywords support one or multiple mandatory arguments, and one or
13444multiple optional arguments. These arguments are strongly typed and are checked
13445when the configuration is parsed so that there is no risk of running with an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013446incorrect argument (e.g. an unresolved backend name). Fetch function arguments
13447are passed between parenthesis and are delimited by commas. When an argument
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013448is optional, it will be indicated below between square brackets ('[ ]'). When
13449all arguments are optional, the parenthesis may be omitted.
13450
13451Thus, the syntax of a standard sample fetch method is one of the following :
13452 - name
13453 - name(arg1)
13454 - name(arg1,arg2)
13455
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013456
134577.3.1. Converters
13458-----------------
13459
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013460Sample fetch methods may be combined with transformations to be applied on top
13461of the fetched sample (also called "converters"). These combinations form what
13462is called "sample expressions" and the result is a "sample". Initially this
13463was only supported by "stick on" and "stick store-request" directives but this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013464has now be extended to all places where samples may be used (ACLs, log-format,
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013465unique-id-format, add-header, ...).
13466
13467These transformations are enumerated as a series of specific keywords after the
13468sample fetch method. These keywords may equally be appended immediately after
13469the fetch keyword's argument, delimited by a comma. These keywords can also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013470support some arguments (e.g. a netmask) which must be passed in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013471
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013472A certain category of converters are bitwise and arithmetic operators which
13473support performing basic operations on integers. Some bitwise operations are
13474supported (and, or, xor, cpl) and some arithmetic operations are supported
13475(add, sub, mul, div, mod, neg). Some comparators are provided (odd, even, not,
13476bool) which make it possible to report a match without having to write an ACL.
13477
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013478The currently available list of transformation keywords include :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013479
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001348051d.single(<prop>[,<prop>*])
13481 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
13482 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
13483 The device is identified using the User-Agent header passed to the
13484 converter. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
13485 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
13486
13487 Example :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013488 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request,
13489 # containing values for the three properties requested by using the
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +000013490 # User-Agent passed to the converter.
13491 frontend http-in
13492 bind *:8081
13493 default_backend servers
13494 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
13495 %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),51d.single(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
13496
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013497add(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013498 Adds <value> to the input value of type signed integer, and returns the
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013499 result as a signed integer. <value> can be a numeric value or a variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013500 name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The
13501 scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013502 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013503 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13504 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13505 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13506 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013507 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013508 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013509
Nenad Merdanovicc31499d2019-03-23 11:00:32 +010013510aes_gcm_dec(<bits>,<nonce>,<key>,<aead_tag>)
13511 Decrypts the raw byte input using the AES128-GCM, AES192-GCM or
13512 AES256-GCM algorithm, depending on the <bits> parameter. All other parameters
13513 need to be base64 encoded and the returned result is in raw byte format.
13514 If the <aead_tag> validation fails, the converter doesn't return any data.
13515 The <nonce>, <key> and <aead_tag> can either be strings or variables. This
13516 converter requires at least OpenSSL 1.0.1.
13517
13518 Example:
13519 http-response set-header X-Decrypted-Text %[var(txn.enc),\
13520 aes_gcm_dec(128,txn.nonce,Zm9vb2Zvb29mb29wZm9vbw==,txn.aead_tag)]
13521
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013522and(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013523 Performs a bitwise "AND" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013524 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013525 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
13526 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013527 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013528 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13529 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13530 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13531 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013532 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013533 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013534
Holger Just1bfc24b2017-05-06 00:56:53 +020013535b64dec
13536 Converts (decodes) a base64 encoded input string to its binary
13537 representation. It performs the inverse operation of base64().
13538
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020013539base64
13540 Converts a binary input sample to a base64 string. It is used to log or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013541 transfer binary content in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g.
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020013542 an SSL ID can be copied in a header).
13543
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013544bool
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013545 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013546 non-null, otherwise returns FALSE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013547 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013548 presence of a flag).
13549
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010013550bytes(<offset>[,<length>])
13551 Extracts some bytes from an input binary sample. The result is a binary
13552 sample starting at an offset (in bytes) of the original sample and
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010013553 optionally truncated at the given length.
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010013554
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010013555concat([<start>],[<var>],[<end>])
13556 Concatenates up to 3 fields after the current sample which is then turned to
13557 a string. The first one, <start>, is a constant string, that will be appended
13558 immediately after the existing sample. It may be omitted if not used. The
13559 second one, <var>, is a variable name. The variable will be looked up, its
13560 contents converted to a string, and it will be appended immediately after the
13561 <first> part. If the variable is not found, nothing is appended. It may be
13562 omitted as well. The third field, <end> is a constant string that will be
13563 appended after the variable. It may also be omitted. Together, these elements
13564 allow to concatenate variables with delimiters to an existing set of
13565 variables. This can be used to build new variables made of a succession of
13566 other variables, such as colon-delimited varlues. Note that due to the config
13567 parser, it is not possible to use a comma nor a closing parenthesis as
13568 delimitors.
13569
13570 Example:
13571 tcp-request session set-var(sess.src) src
13572 tcp-request session set-var(sess.dn) ssl_c_s_dn
13573 tcp-request session set-var(txn.sig) str(),concat(<ip=,sess.ip,>),concat(<dn=,sess.dn,>)
13574 http-request set-header x-hap-sig %[var(txn.sig)]
13575
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013576cpl
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013577 Takes the input value of type signed integer, applies a ones-complement
13578 (flips all bits) and returns the result as an signed integer.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013579
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010013580crc32([<avalanche>])
13581 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32
13582 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
13583 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
13584 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
13585 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
13586 provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32 to be
13587 computed on some input keys, so it follows the most common implementation as
13588 found in Ethernet, Gzip, PNG, etc... It is slower than the other algorithms
13589 but may provide a better or at least less predictable distribution. It must
13590 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010013591 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c" and the "hash-type" directive.
13592
13593crc32c([<avalanche>])
13594 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32C
13595 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
13596 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
13597 converter uses the same functions as described in RFC4960, Appendix B [8].
13598 It is provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32C to be
13599 computed on some input keys. It is slower than the other algorithms and it must
13600 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
13601 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32" and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010013602
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +010013603da-csv-conv(<prop>[,<prop>*])
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020013604 Asks the DeviceAtlas converter to identify the User Agent string passed on
13605 input, and to emit a string made of the concatenation of the properties
13606 enumerated in argument, delimited by the separator defined by the global
13607 keyword "deviceatlas-property-separator", or by default the pipe character
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000013608 ('|'). There's a limit of 12 different properties imposed by the haproxy
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020013609 configuration language.
13610
13611 Example:
13612 frontend www
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020013613 bind *:8881
13614 default_backend servers
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000013615 http-request set-header X-DeviceAtlas-Data %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),da-csv(primaryHardwareType,osName,osVersion,browserName,browserVersion,browserRenderingEngine)]
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020013616
Thierry FOURNIER9687c772015-05-07 15:46:29 +020013617debug
13618 This converter is used as debug tool. It dumps on screen the content and the
13619 type of the input sample. The sample is returned as is on its output. This
13620 converter only exists when haproxy was built with debugging enabled.
13621
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013622div(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013623 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
13624 result as an signed integer. If <value> is null, the largest unsigned
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013625 integer is returned (typically 2^63-1). <value> can be a numeric value or a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013626 variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
13627 scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013628 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013629 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13630 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13631 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13632 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013633 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013634 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013635
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013636djb2([<avalanche>])
13637 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the DJB2
13638 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
13639 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
13640 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
13641 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
13642 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
13643 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010013644 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c",
13645 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013646
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013647even
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013648 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is even
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013649 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "not,and(1),bool".
13650
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020013651field(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
13652 Extracts the substring at the given index counting from the beginning
13653 (positive index) or from the end (negative index) considering given delimiters
13654 from an input string. Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string
13655 formatted list of chars. Optionally you can specify <count> of fields to
13656 extract (default: 1). Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining
13657 fields.
13658
13659 Example :
13660 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(5,_) # f5
13661 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
13662 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,2) # f2_f3
13663 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-2,_,3) # f2_f3_
13664 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-3,_,0) # f1_f2_f3
Emeric Brunf399b0d2014-11-03 17:07:03 +010013665
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013666hex
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013667 Converts a binary input sample to a hex string containing two hex digits per
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013668 input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some binary input data
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013669 in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g. an SSL ID can be copied in a
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013670 header).
Thierry FOURNIER2f49d6d2014-03-12 15:01:52 +010013671
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020013672hex2i
13673 Converts a hex string containing two hex digits per input byte to an
13674 integer. If the input value can not be converted, then zero is returned.
13675
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013676http_date([<offset>])
13677 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
13678 representing this date in a format suitable for use in HTTP header fields. If
13679 an offset value is specified, then it is a number of seconds that is added to
13680 the date before the conversion is operated. This is particularly useful to
13681 emit Date header fields, Expires values in responses when combined with a
13682 positive offset, or Last-Modified values when the offset is negative.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013683
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013684in_table(<table>)
13685 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13686 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, a boolean false
13687 is returned. Otherwise a boolean true is returned. This can be used to verify
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013688 the presence of a certain key in a table tracking some elements (e.g. whether
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013689 or not a source IP address or an Authorization header was already seen).
13690
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010013691ipmask(<mask4>, [<mask6>])
13692 Apply a mask to an IP address, and use the result for lookups and storage.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020013693 This can be used to make all hosts within a certain mask to share the same
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010013694 table entries and as such use the same server. The mask4 can be passed in
13695 dotted form (e.g. 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (e.g. 24). The mask6 can
13696 be passed in quadruplet form (e.g. ffff:ffff::) or in CIDR form (e.g. 64).
13697 If no mask6 is given IPv6 addresses will fail to convert for backwards
13698 compatibility reasons.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020013699
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013700json([<input-code>])
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013701 Escapes the input string and produces an ASCII output string ready to use as a
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013702 JSON string. The converter tries to decode the input string according to the
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020013703 <input-code> parameter. It can be "ascii", "utf8", "utf8s", "utf8p" or
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013704 "utf8ps". The "ascii" decoder never fails. The "utf8" decoder detects 3 types
13705 of errors:
13706 - bad UTF-8 sequence (lone continuation byte, bad number of continuation
13707 bytes, ...)
13708 - invalid range (the decoded value is within a UTF-8 prohibited range),
13709 - code overlong (the value is encoded with more bytes than necessary).
13710
13711 The UTF-8 JSON encoding can produce a "too long value" error when the UTF-8
13712 character is greater than 0xffff because the JSON string escape specification
13713 only authorizes 4 hex digits for the value encoding. The UTF-8 decoder exists
13714 in 4 variants designated by a combination of two suffix letters : "p" for
13715 "permissive" and "s" for "silently ignore". The behaviors of the decoders
13716 are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013717 - "ascii" : never fails;
13718 - "utf8" : fails on any detected errors;
13719 - "utf8s" : never fails, but removes characters corresponding to errors;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013720 - "utf8p" : accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but fails on any other
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013721 error;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013722 - "utf8ps" : never fails, accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but removes
13723 characters corresponding to the other errors.
13724
13725 This converter is particularly useful for building properly escaped JSON for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013726 logging to servers which consume JSON-formatted traffic logs.
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013727
13728 Example:
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013729 capture request header Host len 15
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020013730 capture request header user-agent len 150
13731 log-format '{"ip":"%[src]","user-agent":"%[capture.req.hdr(1),json(utf8s)]"}'
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013732
13733 Input request from client 127.0.0.1:
13734 GET / HTTP/1.0
13735 User-Agent: Very "Ugly" UA 1/2
13736
13737 Output log:
13738 {"ip":"127.0.0.1","user-agent":"Very \"Ugly\" UA 1\/2"}
13739
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013740language(<value>[,<default>])
13741 Returns the value with the highest q-factor from a list as extracted from the
13742 "accept-language" header using "req.fhdr". Values with no q-factor have a
13743 q-factor of 1. Values with a q-factor of 0 are dropped. Only values which
13744 belong to the list of semi-colon delimited <values> will be considered. The
13745 argument <value> syntax is "lang[;lang[;lang[;...]]]". If no value matches the
13746 given list and a default value is provided, it is returned. Note that language
13747 names may have a variant after a dash ('-'). If this variant is present in the
13748 list, it will be matched, but if it is not, only the base language is checked.
13749 The match is case-sensitive, and the output string is always one of those
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013750 provided in arguments. The ordering of arguments is meaningless, only the
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013751 ordering of the values in the request counts, as the first value among
13752 multiple sharing the same q-factor is used.
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020013753
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013754 Example :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020013755
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013756 # this configuration switches to the backend matching a
13757 # given language based on the request :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020013758
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013759 acl es req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str es
13760 acl fr req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str fr
13761 acl en req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str en
13762 use_backend spanish if es
13763 use_backend french if fr
13764 use_backend english if en
13765 default_backend choose_your_language
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020013766
Willy Tarreau60a2ee72017-12-15 07:13:48 +010013767length
Etienne Carriereed0d24e2017-12-13 13:41:34 +010013768 Get the length of the string. This can only be placed after a string
13769 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
13770 type. The result is of type integer.
13771
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020013772lower
13773 Convert a string sample to lower case. This can only be placed after a string
13774 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
13775 type. The result is of type string.
13776
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020013777ltime(<format>[,<offset>])
13778 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
13779 representing this date in local time using a format defined by the <format>
13780 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
13781 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
13782 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
13783 by your operating system. See also the utime converter.
13784
13785 Example :
13786
13787 # Emit two colons, one with the local time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013788 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020013789 log-format %[date,ltime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
13790
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013791map(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
13792map_<match_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
13793map_<match_type>_<output_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
13794 Search the input value from <map_file> using the <match_type> matching method,
13795 and return the associated value converted to the type <output_type>. If the
13796 input value cannot be found in the <map_file>, the converter returns the
13797 <default_value>. If the <default_value> is not set, the converter fails and
13798 acts as if no input value could be fetched. If the <match_type> is not set, it
13799 defaults to "str". Likewise, if the <output_type> is not set, it defaults to
13800 "str". For convenience, the "map" keyword is an alias for "map_str" and maps a
13801 string to another string.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013802
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013803 It is important to avoid overlapping between the keys : IP addresses and
13804 strings are stored in trees, so the first of the finest match will be used.
13805 Other keys are stored in lists, so the first matching occurrence will be used.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013806
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010013807 The following array contains the list of all map functions available sorted by
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013808 input type, match type and output type.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013809
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013810 input type | match method | output type str | output type int | output type ip
13811 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13812 str | str | map_str | map_str_int | map_str_ip
13813 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Willy Tarreau787a4c02014-05-10 07:55:30 +020013814 str | beg | map_beg | map_beg_int | map_end_ip
13815 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013816 str | sub | map_sub | map_sub_int | map_sub_ip
13817 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13818 str | dir | map_dir | map_dir_int | map_dir_ip
13819 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13820 str | dom | map_dom | map_dom_int | map_dom_ip
13821 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13822 str | end | map_end | map_end_int | map_end_ip
13823 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Ruoshan Huang3c5e3742016-12-02 16:25:31 +080013824 str | reg | map_reg | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
13825 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13826 str | reg | map_regm | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013827 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13828 int | int | map_int | map_int_int | map_int_ip
13829 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13830 ip | ip | map_ip | map_ip_int | map_ip_ip
13831 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013832
Thierry Fournier8feaa662016-02-10 22:55:20 +010013833 The special map called "map_regm" expect matching zone in the regular
13834 expression and modify the output replacing back reference (like "\1") by
13835 the corresponding match text.
13836
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013837 The file contains one key + value per line. Lines which start with '#' are
13838 ignored, just like empty lines. Leading tabs and spaces are stripped. The key
13839 is then the first "word" (series of non-space/tabs characters), and the value
13840 is what follows this series of space/tab till the end of the line excluding
13841 trailing spaces/tabs.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013842
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013843 Example :
13844
13845 # this is a comment and is ignored
13846 2.22.246.0/23 United Kingdom \n
13847 <-><-----------><--><------------><---->
13848 | | | | `- trailing spaces ignored
13849 | | | `---------- value
13850 | | `-------------------- middle spaces ignored
13851 | `---------------------------- key
13852 `------------------------------------ leading spaces ignored
13853
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013854mod(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013855 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
13856 remainder as an signed integer. If <value> is null, then zero is returned.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013857 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013858 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013859 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013860 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13861 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13862 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13863 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013864 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013865 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013866
13867mul(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013868 Multiplies the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns
Thierry FOURNIER00c005c2015-07-08 01:10:21 +020013869 the product as an signed integer. In case of overflow, the largest possible
13870 value for the sign is returned so that the operation doesn't wrap around.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013871 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013872 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013873 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013874 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13875 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13876 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13877 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013878 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013879 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013880
Nenad Merdanovicb7e7c472017-03-12 21:56:55 +010013881nbsrv
13882 Takes an input value of type string, interprets it as a backend name and
13883 returns the number of usable servers in that backend. Can be used in places
13884 where we want to look up a backend from a dynamic name, like a result of a
13885 map lookup.
13886
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013887neg
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013888 Takes the input value of type signed integer, computes the opposite value,
13889 and returns the remainder as an signed integer. 0 is identity. This operator
13890 is provided for reversed subtracts : in order to subtract the input from a
13891 constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)".
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013892
13893not
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013894 Returns a boolean FALSE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013895 non-null, otherwise returns TRUE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013896 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013897 absence of a flag).
13898
13899odd
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013900 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is odd
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013901 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "and(1),bool".
13902
13903or(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013904 Performs a bitwise "OR" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013905 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013906 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
13907 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013908 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013909 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13910 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13911 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13912 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013913 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013914 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013915
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010013916protobuf(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
13917 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
13918 sample representation of a protocol buffer message with <field_number> as field
13919 number (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample
13920 if this field is present (see also "ungrpc" below).
13921 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
13922 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
13923 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
13924 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
13925 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
13926 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
13927 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
13928
Willy Tarreauc4dc3502015-01-23 20:39:28 +010013929regsub(<regex>,<subst>[,<flags>])
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010013930 Applies a regex-based substitution to the input string. It does the same
13931 operation as the well-known "sed" utility with "s/<regex>/<subst>/". By
13932 default it will replace in the input string the first occurrence of the
13933 largest part matching the regular expression <regex> with the substitution
13934 string <subst>. It is possible to replace all occurrences instead by adding
13935 the flag "g" in the third argument <flags>. It is also possible to make the
13936 regex case insensitive by adding the flag "i" in <flags>. Since <flags> is a
13937 string, it is made up from the concatenation of all desired flags. Thus if
13938 both "i" and "g" are desired, using "gi" or "ig" will have the same effect.
13939 It is important to note that due to the current limitations of the
Baptiste Assmann66025d82016-03-06 23:36:48 +010013940 configuration parser, some characters such as closing parenthesis, closing
13941 square brackets or comma are not possible to use in the arguments. The first
13942 use of this converter is to replace certain characters or sequence of
13943 characters with other ones.
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010013944
13945 Example :
13946
13947 # de-duplicate "/" in header "x-path".
13948 # input: x-path: /////a///b/c/xzxyz/
13949 # output: x-path: /a/b/c/xzxyz/
13950 http-request set-header x-path %[hdr(x-path),regsub(/+,/,g)]
13951
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020013952capture-req(<id>)
13953 Capture the string entry in the request slot <id> and returns the entry as
13954 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
13955
13956 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020013957 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
13958 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020013959
13960capture-res(<id>)
13961 Capture the string entry in the response slot <id> and returns the entry as
13962 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
13963
13964 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020013965 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
13966 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020013967
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013968sdbm([<avalanche>])
13969 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the SDBM
13970 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
13971 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
13972 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
13973 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
13974 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
13975 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010013976 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "wt6", "crc32c",
13977 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013978
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013979set-var(<var name>)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013980 Sets a variable with the input content and returns the content on the output
13981 as-is. The variable keeps the value and the associated input type. The name of
13982 the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013983 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013984 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13985 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013986 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013987 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
13988 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013989 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013990 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013991
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020013992sha1
13993 Converts a binary input sample to a SHA1 digest. The result is a binary
13994 sample with length of 20 bytes.
13995
Tim Duesterhusca097c12018-04-27 21:18:45 +020013996strcmp(<var>)
13997 Compares the contents of <var> with the input value of type string. Returns
13998 the result as a signed integer compatible with strcmp(3): 0 if both strings
13999 are identical. A value less than 0 if the left string is lexicographically
14000 smaller than the right string or if the left string is shorter. A value greater
14001 than 0 otherwise (right string greater than left string or the right string is
14002 shorter).
14003
14004 Example :
14005
14006 http-request set-var(txn.host) hdr(host)
14007 # Check whether the client is attempting domain fronting.
14008 acl ssl_sni_http_host_match ssl_fc_sni,strcmp(txn.host) eq 0
14009
14010
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014011sub(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014012 Subtracts <value> from the input value of type signed integer, and returns
14013 the result as an signed integer. Note: in order to subtract the input from
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014014 a constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)". <value> can be a numeric value
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014015 or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about
14016 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014017 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014018 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14019 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014020 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014021 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
14022 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014023 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014024 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014025
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014026table_bytes_in_rate(<table>)
14027 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14028 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14029 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average client-to-server
14030 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
14031 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
14032 sc_bytes_in_rate sample fetch keyword.
14033
14034
14035table_bytes_out_rate(<table>)
14036 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14037 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14038 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average server-to-client
14039 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
14040 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
14041 sc_bytes_out_rate sample fetch keyword.
14042
14043table_conn_cnt(<table>)
14044 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14045 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014046 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014047 connections associated with the input sample in the designated table. See
14048 also the sc_conn_cnt sample fetch keyword.
14049
14050table_conn_cur(<table>)
14051 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14052 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14053 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
14054 tracked connections associated with the input sample in the designated table.
14055 See also the sc_conn_cur sample fetch keyword.
14056
14057table_conn_rate(<table>)
14058 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14059 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14060 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming connection
14061 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
14062 sc_conn_rate sample fetch keyword.
14063
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020014064table_gpt0(<table>)
14065 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14066 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, boolean value zero
14067 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
14068 general purpose tag associated with the input sample in the designated table.
14069 See also the sc_get_gpt0 sample fetch keyword.
14070
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014071table_gpc0(<table>)
14072 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14073 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14074 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
14075 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
14076 table. See also the sc_get_gpc0 sample fetch keyword.
14077
14078table_gpc0_rate(<table>)
14079 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14080 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14081 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc0
14082 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
14083 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc0_rate
14084 sample fetch keyword.
14085
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014086table_gpc1(<table>)
14087 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14088 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14089 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the second
14090 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
14091 table. See also the sc_get_gpc1 sample fetch keyword.
14092
14093table_gpc1_rate(<table>)
14094 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14095 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14096 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc1
14097 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
14098 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc1_rate
14099 sample fetch keyword.
14100
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014101table_http_err_cnt(<table>)
14102 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14103 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014104 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014105 errors associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
14106 sc_http_err_cnt sample fetch keyword.
14107
14108table_http_err_rate(<table>)
14109 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14110 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14111 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP errors associated with the
14112 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of errors over the
14113 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_err_rate sample fetch
14114 keyword.
14115
14116table_http_req_cnt(<table>)
14117 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14118 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014119 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014120 requests associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
14121 the sc_http_req_cnt sample fetch keyword.
14122
14123table_http_req_rate(<table>)
14124 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14125 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14126 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP requests associated with the
14127 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of requests over the
14128 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_req_rate sample fetch
14129 keyword.
14130
14131table_kbytes_in(<table>)
14132 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14133 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014134 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of client-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014135 to-server data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
14136 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
14137 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_in sample fetch
14138 keyword.
14139
14140table_kbytes_out(<table>)
14141 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14142 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014143 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of server-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014144 to-client data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
14145 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
14146 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_out sample fetch
14147 keyword.
14148
14149table_server_id(<table>)
14150 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14151 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14152 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the server ID associated with
14153 the input sample in the designated table. A server ID is associated to a
14154 sample by a "stick" rule when a connection to a server succeeds. A server ID
14155 zero means that no server is associated with this key.
14156
14157table_sess_cnt(<table>)
14158 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14159 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014160 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014161 sessions associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that
14162 a session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
14163 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_cnt sample fetch
14164 keyword.
14165
14166table_sess_rate(<table>)
14167 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14168 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14169 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming session
14170 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that a
14171 session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
14172 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_rate sample fetch
14173 keyword.
14174
14175table_trackers(<table>)
14176 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14177 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14178 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
14179 connections tracking the same key as the input sample in the designated
14180 table. It differs from table_conn_cur in that it does not rely on any stored
14181 information but on the table's reference count (the "use" value which is
14182 returned by "show table" on the CLI). This may sometimes be more suited for
14183 layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a server how many concurrent
14184 connections there are from a given address for example. See also the
14185 sc_trackers sample fetch keyword.
14186
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020014187upper
14188 Convert a string sample to upper case. This can only be placed after a string
14189 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
14190 type. The result is of type string.
14191
Thierry FOURNIER82ff3c92015-05-07 15:46:20 +020014192url_dec
14193 Takes an url-encoded string provided as input and returns the decoded
14194 version as output. The input and the output are of type string.
14195
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014196ungrpc(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010014197 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010014198 sample representation of a gRPC message with <field_number> as field number
14199 (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample if this
14200 field is present.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014201 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
14202 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
14203 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
14204 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010014205 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014206 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
14207 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010014208
14209 Example:
14210 // with such a protocol buffer .proto file content adapted from
14211 // https://github.com/grpc/grpc/blob/master/examples/protos/route_guide.proto
14212
14213 message Point {
14214 int32 latitude = 1;
14215 int32 longitude = 2;
14216 }
14217
14218 message PPoint {
14219 Point point = 59;
14220 }
14221
14222 message Rectangle {
14223 // One corner of the rectangle.
14224 PPoint lo = 48;
14225 // The other corner of the rectangle.
14226 PPoint hi = 49;
14227 }
14228
14229 let's say a body request is made of a "Rectangle" object value (two PPoint
14230 protocol buffers messages), the four protocol buffers fields could be
14231 extracted with these "ungrpc" directives:
14232
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014233 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
14234 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "lo" first PPoint
14235 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.1,int32) # "latidude" of "hi" second PPoint
14236 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "hi" second PPoint
14237
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010014238 We could also extract the intermediary 48.59 field as a binary sample as follows:
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014239
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010014240 req.body,ungrpc(48.59)
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014241
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010014242 As a gRPC message is alway made of a gRPC header followed by protocol buffers
14243 messages, in the previous example the "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
14244 could be extracted with these equivalent directives:
14245
14246 req.body,ungrpc(48.59),protobuf(1,int32)
14247 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59.1,int32)
14248 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59),protobuf(1,int32)
14249
14250 Note that the first convert must be "ungrpc", the remaining ones must be
14251 "protobuf" and only the last one may have or not a second argument to
14252 interpret the previous binary sample.
14253
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010014254
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010014255unset-var(<var name>)
14256 Unsets a variable if the input content is defined. The name of the variable
14257 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
14258 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
14259 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14260 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
14261 response),
14262 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
14263 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
14264 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
14265 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
14266
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020014267utime(<format>[,<offset>])
14268 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
14269 representing this date in UTC time using a format defined by the <format>
14270 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
14271 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
14272 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
14273 by your operating system. See also the ltime converter.
14274
14275 Example :
14276
14277 # Emit two colons, one with the UTC time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014278 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020014279 log-format %[date,utime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
14280
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020014281word(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
14282 Extracts the nth word counting from the beginning (positive index) or from
14283 the end (negative index) considering given delimiters from an input string.
14284 Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string formatted list of chars.
14285 Optionally you can specify <count> of words to extract (default: 1).
14286 Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining words.
14287
14288 Example :
14289 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(4,_) # f5
14290 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
14291 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(3,_,2) # f3__f5
14292 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-2,_,3) # f1_f2_f3
14293 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-3,_,0) # f1_f2
Emeric Brunc9a0f6d2014-11-25 14:09:01 +010014294
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020014295wt6([<avalanche>])
14296 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the WT6
14297 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
14298 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
14299 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
14300 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
14301 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
14302 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010014303 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "sdbm", "crc32c",
14304 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020014305
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014306xor(<value>)
14307 Performs a bitwise "XOR" (exclusive OR) between <value> and the input value
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014308 of type signed integer, and returns the result as an signed integer.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014309 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014310 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014311 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014312 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14313 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014314 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014315 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
14316 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014317 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014318 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014319
Thierry FOURNIER01e09742016-12-26 11:46:11 +010014320xxh32([<seed>])
14321 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the 32-bit
14322 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
14323 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
14324 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
14325 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
14326 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
14327 as cryptographically secure.
14328
14329xxh64([<seed>])
14330 Hashes a binary input sample into a signed 64-bit quantity using the 64-bit
14331 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
14332 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
14333 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
14334 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
14335 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
14336 as cryptographically secure.
14337
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010014338
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200143397.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014340--------------------------------------------
14341
14342A first set of sample fetch methods applies to internal information which does
14343not even relate to any client information. These ones are sometimes used with
14344"monitor-fail" directives to report an internal status to external watchers.
14345The sample fetch methods described in this section are usable anywhere.
14346
14347always_false : boolean
14348 Always returns the boolean "false" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
14349 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
14350
14351always_true : boolean
14352 Always returns the boolean "true" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
14353 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
14354
14355avg_queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014356 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014357 divided by the number of active servers. The current backend is used if no
14358 backend is specified. This is very similar to "queue" except that the size of
14359 the farm is considered, in order to give a more accurate measurement of the
14360 time it may take for a new connection to be processed. The main usage is with
14361 ACL to return a sorry page to new users when it becomes certain they will get
14362 a degraded service, or to pass to the backend servers in a header so that
14363 they decide to work in degraded mode or to disable some functions to speed up
14364 the processing a bit. Note that in the event there would not be any active
14365 server anymore, twice the number of queued connections would be considered as
14366 the measured value. This is a fair estimate, as we expect one server to get
14367 back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send new traffic to another backend
14368 if in better shape. See also the "queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate"
14369 sample fetches.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +010014370
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014371be_conn([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020014372 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
14373 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
14374 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
14375 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040014376 See also the "fe_conn", "queue", "be_conn_free", and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
14377
14378be_conn_free([<backend>]) : integer
14379 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
14380 across available servers in the backend. Queue slots are not included. Backup
14381 servers are also not included, unless all other servers are down. If no
14382 backend name is specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible
14383 to check another backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040014384 nominal one is full. See also the "be_conn", "connslots", and "srv_conn_free"
14385 criteria.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040014386
14387 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0
14388 (meaning unlimited), then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which
14389 case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014390
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014391be_sess_rate([<backend>]) : integer
14392 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
14393 backend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
14394 switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014395 high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent sucking of an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014396 online dictionary). It can also be useful to add this element to logs using a
14397 log-format directive.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014398
14399 Example :
14400 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
14401 backend dynamic
14402 mode http
14403 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
14404 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014405
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014406bin(<hex>) : bin
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020014407 Returns a binary chain. The input is the hexadecimal representation
14408 of the string.
14409
14410bool(<bool>) : bool
14411 Returns a boolean value. <bool> can be 'true', 'false', '1' or '0'.
14412 'false' and '0' are the same. 'true' and '1' are the same.
14413
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014414connslots([<backend>]) : integer
14415 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connection slots
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014416 still available in the backend, by totaling the maximum amount of
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014417 connections on all servers and the maximum queue size. This is probably only
14418 used with ACLs.
Tait Clarridge7896d522012-12-05 21:39:31 -050014419
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014420 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014421 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014422 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
14423
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014424 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
14425 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014426
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020014427 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014428 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014429 multiple backends (perhaps using ACLs to do name-based load balancing) and
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014430 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014431 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014432 actually *down*, this fetch is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020014433 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014434
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014435 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
14436 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014437 then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014438 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014439
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010014440cpu_calls : integer
14441 Returns the number of calls to the task processing the stream or current
14442 request since it was allocated. This number is reset for each new request on
14443 the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value should usually be
14444 low and stable (around 2 calls for a typically simple request) but may become
14445 high if some processing (compression, caching or analysis) is performed. This
14446 is purely for performance monitoring purposes.
14447
14448cpu_ns_avg : integer
14449 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
14450 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
14451 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
14452 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
14453 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
14454 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
14455 and may affect other connection's apparent response time. Certain operations
14456 like compression, complex regex matching or heavy Lua operations may directly
14457 affect this value, and having it in the logs will make it easier to spot the
14458 faulty processing that needs to be fixed to recover decent performance.
14459 Note: this value is exactly cpu_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
14460
14461cpu_ns_tot : integer
14462 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
14463 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
14464 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
14465 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
14466 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
14467 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
14468 induces CPU costs on the machine, and may affect other connection's apparent
14469 response time. Certain operations like compression, complex regex matching or
14470 heavy Lua operations may directly affect this value, and having it in the
14471 logs will make it easier to spot the faulty processing that needs to be fixed
14472 to recover decent performance. The value may be artificially high due to a
14473 high cpu_calls count, for example when processing many HTTP chunks, and for
14474 this reason it is often preferred to log cpu_ns_avg instead.
14475
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020014476date([<offset>]) : integer
14477 Returns the current date as the epoch (number of seconds since 01/01/1970).
14478 If an offset value is specified, then it is a number of seconds that is added
14479 to the current date before returning the value. This is particularly useful
14480 to compute relative dates, as both positive and negative offsets are allowed.
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020014481 It is useful combined with the http_date converter.
14482
14483 Example :
14484
14485 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response
14486 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600),http_date]
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020014487
Etienne Carrierea792a0a2018-01-17 13:43:24 +010014488date_us : integer
14489 Return the microseconds part of the date (the "second" part is returned by
14490 date sample). This sample is coherent with the date sample as it is comes
14491 from the same timeval structure.
14492
Willy Tarreaud716f9b2017-10-13 11:03:15 +020014493distcc_body(<token>[,<occ>]) : binary
14494 Parses a distcc message and returns the body associated to occurrence #<occ>
14495 of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified, any may
14496 match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This can be
14497 used to extract file names or arguments in files built using distcc through
14498 haproxy. Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete
14499 list of supported tokens.
14500
14501distcc_param(<token>[,<occ>]) : integer
14502 Parses a distcc message and returns the parameter associated to occurrence
14503 #<occ> of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified,
14504 any may match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This
14505 can be used to extract certain information such as the protocol version, the
14506 file size or the argument in files built using distcc through haproxy.
14507 Another use case consists in waiting for the start of the preprocessed file
14508 contents before connecting to the server to avoid keeping idle connections.
14509 Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete list of
14510 supported tokens.
14511
14512 Example :
14513 # wait up to 20s for the pre-processed file to be uploaded
14514 tcp-request inspect-delay 20s
14515 tcp-request content accept if { distcc_param(DOTI) -m found }
14516 # send large files to the big farm
14517 use_backend big_farm if { distcc_param(DOTI) gt 1000000 }
14518
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +020014519env(<name>) : string
14520 Returns a string containing the value of environment variable <name>. As a
14521 reminder, environment variables are per-process and are sampled when the
14522 process starts. This can be useful to pass some information to a next hop
14523 server, or with ACLs to take specific action when the process is started a
14524 certain way.
14525
14526 Examples :
14527 # Pass the Via header to next hop with the local hostname in it
14528 http-request add-header Via 1.1\ %[env(HOSTNAME)]
14529
14530 # reject cookie-less requests when the STOP environment variable is set
14531 http-request deny if !{ cook(SESSIONID) -m found } { env(STOP) -m found }
14532
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014533fe_conn([<frontend>]) : integer
14534 Returns the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014535 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
14536 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014537 frontend. It can be used to return a sorry page before hard-blocking, or to
14538 use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is considered
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014539 full. This is mostly used with ACLs but can also be used to pass some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014540 statistics to servers in HTTP headers. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn",
14541 "fe_sess_rate" fetches.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020014542
Nenad Merdanovicad9a7e92016-10-03 04:57:37 +020014543fe_req_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
14544 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of HTTP requests per
14545 second sent to a frontend. This number can differ from "fe_sess_rate" in
14546 situations where client-side keep-alive is enabled.
14547
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014548fe_sess_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
14549 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
14550 frontend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
14551 limit the incoming session rate to an acceptable range in order to prevent
14552 abuse of service at the earliest moment, for example when combined with other
14553 layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for the rate to go
14554 down below the limit. It can also be useful to add this element to logs using
14555 a log-format directive. See also the "rate-limit sessions" directive for use
14556 in frontends.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010014557
14558 Example :
14559 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
14560 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
14561 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
14562 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
14563 frontend mail
14564 bind :25
14565 mode tcp
14566 maxconn 100
14567 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
14568 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
14569 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
14570 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010014571
Nenad Merdanovic807a6e72017-03-12 22:00:00 +010014572hostname : string
14573 Returns the system hostname.
14574
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014575int(<integer>) : signed integer
14576 Returns a signed integer.
14577
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020014578ipv4(<ipv4>) : ipv4
14579 Returns an ipv4.
14580
14581ipv6(<ipv6>) : ipv6
14582 Returns an ipv6.
14583
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010014584lat_ns_avg : integer
14585 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
14586 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
14587 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
14588 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
14589 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
14590 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
14591 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
14592 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
14593 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
14594 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, or to look for
14595 other heavy requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"),
14596 whose processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers
14597 could be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex.
14598 Note: this value is exactly lat_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
14599
14600lat_ns_tot : integer
14601 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
14602 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
14603 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
14604 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
14605 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
14606 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
14607 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
14608 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
14609 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
14610 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, or to look for
14611 other heavy requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"),
14612 whose processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers
14613 could be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex. Note: while it
14614 may intuitively seem that the total latency adds to a transfer time, it is
14615 almost never true because while a task waits for the CPU, network buffers
14616 continue to fill up and the next call will process more at once. The value
14617 may be artificially high due to a high cpu_calls count, for example when
14618 processing many HTTP chunks, and for this reason it is often preferred to log
14619 lat_ns_avg instead, which is a more relevant performance indicator.
14620
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020014621meth(<method>) : method
14622 Returns a method.
14623
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010014624nbproc : integer
14625 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of processes that were
14626 started (it equals the global "nbproc" setting). This is useful for logging
14627 and debugging purposes.
14628
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014629nbsrv([<backend>]) : integer
14630 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of usable servers of
14631 either the current backend or the named backend. This is mostly used with
14632 ACLs but can also be useful when added to logs. This is normally used to
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014633 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
14634 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
14635 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010014636
Patrick Hemmerfabb24f2018-08-13 14:07:57 -040014637prio_class : integer
14638 Returns the priority class of the current session for http mode or connection
14639 for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to "http-request
14640 set-priority-class" or "tcp-request content set-priority-class".
14641
14642prio_offset : integer
14643 Returns the priority offset of the current session for http mode or
14644 connection for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to
14645 "http-request set-priority-offset" or "tcp-request content
14646 set-priority-offset".
14647
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010014648proc : integer
14649 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the process calling
14650 the function, between 1 and global.nbproc. This is useful for logging and
14651 debugging purposes.
14652
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014653queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014654 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
14655 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
14656 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014657 one. This is useful with ACLs or to pass statistics to backend servers. This
14658 can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level, generally
14659 indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers. One
14660 possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones. See
14661 also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" fetches.
14662
Willy Tarreau84310e22014-02-14 11:59:04 +010014663rand([<range>]) : integer
14664 Returns a random integer value within a range of <range> possible values,
14665 starting at zero. If the range is not specified, it defaults to 2^32, which
14666 gives numbers between 0 and 4294967295. It can be useful to pass some values
14667 needed to take some routing decisions for example, or just for debugging
14668 purposes. This random must not be used for security purposes.
14669
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014670srv_conn([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
14671 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
14672 connections on the designated server, possibly including the connection being
14673 evaluated. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the
14674 current backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is
14675 full, or to inform the server about our view of the number of active
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040014676 connections with it. See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn", "queue", and
14677 "srv_conn_free" fetch methods.
14678
14679srv_conn_free([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
14680 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
14681 on the designated server, possibly including the connection being evaluated.
14682 The value does not include queue slots. If <backend> is omitted, then the
14683 server is looked up in the current backend. It can be used to use a specific
14684 farm when one server is full, or to inform the server about our view of the
14685 number of active connections with it. See also the "be_conn_free" and
14686 "srv_conn" fetch methods.
14687
14688 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: If the server maxconn is 0, then this fetch clearly
14689 does not make sense, in which case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014690
14691srv_is_up([<backend>/]<server>) : boolean
14692 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
14693 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
14694 looked up in the current backend. It is mainly used to take action based on
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014695 an external status reported via a health check (e.g. a geographical site's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014696 availability). Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in
14697 using dummy servers as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from
14698 the CLI, so that rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
14699
Willy Tarreauff2b7af2017-10-13 11:46:26 +020014700srv_queue([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
14701 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connections currently
14702 pending in the designated server's queue. If <backend> is omitted, then the
14703 server is looked up in the current backend. It can sometimes be used together
14704 with the "use-server" directive to force to use a known faster server when it
14705 is not much loaded. See also the "srv_conn", "avg_queue" and "queue" sample
14706 fetch methods.
14707
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014708srv_sess_rate([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
14709 Returns an integer corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
14710 designated server, in number of new sessions per second. If <backend> is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014711 omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. This is mostly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014712 used with ACLs but can make sense with logs too. This is used to switch to an
14713 alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too high a session
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014714 rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent latent requests from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014715 overloading servers).
14716
14717 Example :
14718 # Redirect to a separate back
14719 acl srv1_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv1) gt 50
14720 acl srv2_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv2) gt 50
14721 use_backend be2 if srv1_full or srv2_full
14722
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010014723stopping : boolean
14724 Returns TRUE if the process calling the function is currently stopping. This
14725 can be useful for logging, or for relaxing certain checks or helping close
14726 certain connections upon graceful shutdown.
14727
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020014728str(<string>) : string
14729 Returns a string.
14730
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014731table_avl([<table>]) : integer
14732 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
14733 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
14734
14735table_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14736 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
14737 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
14738 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
14739
Christopher Faulet34adb2a2017-11-21 21:45:38 +010014740thread : integer
14741 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the thread calling
14742 the function, between 0 and (global.nbthread-1). This is useful for logging
14743 and debugging purposes.
14744
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014745var(<var-name>) : undefined
14746 Returns a variable with the stored type. If the variable is not set, the
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014747 sample fetch fails. The name of the variable starts with an indication
14748 about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014749 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014750 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14751 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014752 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014753 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
14754 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014755 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014756 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014757
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200147587.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014759----------------------------------
14760
14761The layer 4 usually describes just the transport layer which in haproxy is
14762closest to the connection, where no content is yet made available. The fetch
14763methods described here are usable as low as the "tcp-request connection" rule
14764sets unless they require some future information. Those generally include
14765TCP/IP addresses and ports, as well as elements from stick-tables related to
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014766the incoming connection. For retrieving a value from a sticky counters, the
14767counter number can be explicitly set as 0, 1, or 2 using the pre-defined
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020014768"sc0_", "sc1_", or "sc2_" prefix. These three pre-defined prefixes can only be
14769used if MAX_SESS_STKCTR value does not exceed 3, otherwise the counter number
14770can be specified as the first integer argument when using the "sc_" prefix.
14771Starting from "sc_0" to "sc_N" where N is (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). An optional
14772table may be specified with the "sc*" form, in which case the currently
14773tracked key will be looked up into this alternate table instead of the table
14774currently being tracked.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014775
Jérôme Magnin35e53a62019-01-16 14:38:37 +010014776bc_http_major : integer
Jérôme Magnin86577422018-12-07 09:03:11 +010014777 Returns the backend connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
14778 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
14779 encoding and not the version present in the request header.
14780
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014781be_id : integer
14782 Returns an integer containing the current backend's id. It can be used in
14783 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request.
14784
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010014785be_name : string
14786 Returns a string containing the current backend's name. It can be used in
14787 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request.
14788
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014789dst : ip
14790 This is the destination IPv4 address of the connection on the client side,
14791 which is the address the client connected to. It can be useful when running
14792 in transparent mode. It is of type IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
14793 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent, according to
Willy Tarreau64ded3d2019-01-23 10:02:15 +010014794 RFC 4291. When the incoming connection passed through address translation or
14795 redirection involving connection tracking, the original destination address
14796 before the redirection will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and
14797 destination may seldom appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl
14798 is set, because a late response may reopen a timed out connection and switch
14799 what is believed to be the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014800
14801dst_conn : integer
14802 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
14803 connections on the same socket including the one being evaluated. It is
14804 normally used with ACLs but can as well be used to pass the information to
14805 servers in an HTTP header or in logs. It can be used to either return a sorry
14806 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
14807 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
14808 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
14809 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" fetches.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014810
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020014811dst_is_local : boolean
14812 Returns true if the destination address of the incoming connection is local
14813 to the system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning
14814 that it was intercepted in transparent mode. It can be useful to apply
14815 certain rules by default to forwarded traffic and other rules to the traffic
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014816 targeting the real address of the machine. For example the stats page could
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020014817 be delivered only on this address, or SSH access could be locally redirected.
14818 Please note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do
14819 it only once per connection.
14820
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014821dst_port : integer
14822 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
14823 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected to.
14824 This might be used when running in transparent mode, when assigning dynamic
14825 ports to some clients for a whole application session, to stick all users to
14826 a same server, or to pass the destination port information to a server using
14827 an HTTP header.
14828
Willy Tarreau60ca10a2017-08-18 15:26:54 +020014829fc_http_major : integer
14830 Reports the front connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
14831 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
14832 encoding and not on the version present in the request header.
14833
Emeric Brun4f603012017-01-05 15:11:44 +010014834fc_rcvd_proxy : boolean
14835 Returns true if the client initiated the connection with a PROXY protocol
14836 header.
14837
Thierry Fournier / OZON.IO6310bef2016-07-24 20:16:50 +020014838fc_rtt(<unit>) : integer
14839 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) measured by the kernel for the client
14840 connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds. <unit>
14841 can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the server
14842 connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
14843 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
14844 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14845
14846fc_rttvar(<unit>) : integer
14847 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) variance measured by the kernel for the
14848 client connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds.
14849 <unit> can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the
14850 server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
14851 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
14852 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14853
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070014854fc_unacked(<unit>) : integer
14855 Returns the unacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
14856 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
14857 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
14858 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14859
14860fc_sacked(<unit>) : integer
14861 Returns the sacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
14862 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
14863 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
14864 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14865
14866fc_retrans(<unit>) : integer
14867 Returns the retransmits counter measured by the kernel for the client
14868 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
14869 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
14870 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14871
14872fc_fackets(<unit>) : integer
14873 Returns the fack counter measured by the kernel for the client
14874 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
14875 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
14876 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14877
14878fc_lost(<unit>) : integer
14879 Returns the lost counter measured by the kernel for the client
14880 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
14881 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
14882 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14883
14884fc_reordering(<unit>) : integer
14885 Returns the reordering counter measured by the kernel for the client
14886 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
14887 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
14888 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14889
Marcin Deranek9a66dfb2018-04-13 14:37:50 +020014890fe_defbe : string
14891 Returns a string containing the frontend's default backend name. It can be
14892 used in frontends to check which backend will handle requests by default.
14893
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014894fe_id : integer
14895 Returns an integer containing the current frontend's id. It can be used in
Marcin Deranek6e413ed2016-12-13 12:40:01 +010014896 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014897 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
14898
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010014899fe_name : string
14900 Returns a string containing the current frontend's name. It can be used in
14901 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
14902 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
14903
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014904sc_bytes_in_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014905sc0_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
14906sc1_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
14907sc2_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014908 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
14909 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
14910 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
14911
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014912sc_bytes_out_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014913sc0_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
14914sc1_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
14915sc2_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014916 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
14917 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
14918 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
14919
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014920sc_clr_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014921sc0_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14922sc1_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14923sc2_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020014924 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
14925 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010014926 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
14927 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
14928 when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020014929
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030014930 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020014931 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
14932 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020014933 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
14934 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 5
14935 acl save sc0_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020014936 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
14937 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
14938
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014939sc_clr_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
14940sc0_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14941sc1_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14942sc2_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14943 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
14944 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
14945 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
14946 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
14947 when a first ACL was verified.
14948
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014949sc_conn_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014950sc0_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14951sc1_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14952sc2_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014953 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections from currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014954 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
14955
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014956sc_conn_cur(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014957sc0_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
14958sc1_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
14959sc2_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014960 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
14961 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
14962 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
14963
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014964sc_conn_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014965sc0_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
14966sc1_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
14967sc2_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014968 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
14969 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
14970 See also src_conn_rate.
14971
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014972sc_get_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014973sc0_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14974sc1_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14975sc2_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014976 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014977 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020014978
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014979sc_get_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
14980sc0_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14981sc1_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14982sc2_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14983 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
14984 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc1 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1.
14985
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020014986sc_get_gpt0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
14987sc0_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
14988sc1_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
14989sc2_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
14990 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
14991 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpt0.
14992
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014993sc_gpc0_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014994sc0_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
14995sc1_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
14996sc2_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020014997 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
14998 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
14999 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015000 src_gpc0_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
15001 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
15002 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015003
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015004sc_gpc1_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
15005sc0_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
15006sc1_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
15007sc2_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
15008 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
15009 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
15010 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
15011 src_gpcA_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
15012 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
15013 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
15014
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015015sc_http_err_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015016sc0_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15017sc1_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15018sc2_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015019 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015020 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
15021 See also src_http_err_cnt.
15022
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015023sc_http_err_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015024sc0_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
15025sc1_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
15026sc2_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015027 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
15028 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
15029 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
15030 src_http_err_rate.
15031
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015032sc_http_req_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015033sc0_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15034sc1_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15035sc2_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015036 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015037 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
15038 src_http_req_cnt.
15039
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015040sc_http_req_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015041sc0_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
15042sc1_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
15043sc2_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015044 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
15045 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
15046 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
15047 src_http_req_rate.
15048
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015049sc_inc_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015050sc0_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15051sc1_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15052sc2_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015053 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010015054 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
15055 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
15056 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
15057 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015058
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030015059 Example:
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020015060 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
15061 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015062 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
15063
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015064sc_inc_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
15065sc0_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15066sc1_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15067sc2_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15068 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
15069 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
15070 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
15071 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
15072 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified.
15073
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015074sc_kbytes_in(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015075sc0_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
15076sc1_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
15077sc2_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020015078 Returns the total amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
15079 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
15080 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015081
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015082sc_kbytes_out(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015083sc0_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
15084sc1_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
15085sc2_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020015086 Returns the total amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
15087 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
15088 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015089
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015090sc_sess_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015091sc0_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15092sc1_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15093sc2_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015094 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections that were transformed
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015095 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
15096 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
15097 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040015098 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015099 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
15100
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015101sc_sess_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015102sc0_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
15103sc1_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
15104sc2_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015105 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
15106 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
15107 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
15108 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
15109 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040015110 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015111
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015112sc_tracked(<ctr>[,<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015113sc0_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
15114sc1_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
15115sc2_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau6f1615f2013-06-03 15:15:22 +020015116 Returns true if the designated session counter is currently being tracked by
15117 the current session. This can be useful when deciding whether or not we want
15118 to set some values in a header passed to the server.
15119
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015120sc_trackers(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015121sc0_trackers([<table>]) : integer
15122sc1_trackers([<table>]) : integer
15123sc2_trackers([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010015124 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
15125 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020015126 begins and decremented when tracking stops. It differs from sc0_conn_cur in
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010015127 that it does not rely on any stored information but on the table's reference
15128 count (the "use" value which is returned by "show table" on the CLI). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015129 may sometimes be more suited for layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a
15130 server how many concurrent connections there are from a given address for
15131 example.
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010015132
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015133so_id : integer
15134 Returns an integer containing the current listening socket's id. It is useful
15135 in frontends involving many "bind" lines, or to stick all users coming via a
15136 same socket to the same server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015137
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015138src : ip
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015139 This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session. It is of type
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015140 IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are
15141 mapped to their IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. Note that it is the
15142 TCP-level source address which is used, and not the address of a client
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010015143 behind a proxy. However if the "accept-proxy" or "accept-netscaler-cip" bind
15144 directive is used, it can be the address of a client behind another
15145 PROXY-protocol compatible component for all rule sets except
Willy Tarreau64ded3d2019-01-23 10:02:15 +010015146 "tcp-request connection" which sees the real address. When the incoming
15147 connection passed through address translation or redirection involving
15148 connection tracking, the original destination address before the redirection
15149 will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and destination may seldom
15150 appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl is set, because a late
15151 response may reopen a timed out connection and switch what is believed to be
15152 the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015153
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010015154 Example:
15155 # add an HTTP header in requests with the originating address' country
15156 http-request set-header X-Country %[src,map_ip(geoip.lst)]
15157
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015158src_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
15159 Returns the average bytes rate from the incoming connection's source address
15160 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
15161 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015162 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015163
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015164src_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
15165 Returns the average bytes rate to the incoming connection's source address in
15166 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015167 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015168 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015169
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015170src_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15171 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
15172 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
15173 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
15174 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
15175 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
15176 was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020015177
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030015178 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020015179 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
15180 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
15181 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
15182 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010015183 acl save src_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020015184 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
15185 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
15186
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015187src_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15188 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
15189 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
15190 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
15191 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
15192 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
15193 was verified.
15194
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015195src_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015196 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the current
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015197 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015198 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015199 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015200
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015201src_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015202 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015203 current incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
15204 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015205 zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015206
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015207src_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
15208 Returns the average connection rate from the incoming connection's source
15209 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
15210 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015211 the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015212
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015213src_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015214 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015215 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015216 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015217 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015218
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015219src_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15220 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
15221 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
15222 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
15223 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1 and src_inc_gpc1.
15224
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020015225src_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
15226 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
15227 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
15228 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
15229 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpt0.
15230
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015231src_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020015232 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015233 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020015234 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
15235 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015236 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc0_rate, src_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
15237 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
15238 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020015239
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015240src_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
15241 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
15242 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
15243 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
15244 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
15245 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc1_rate, src_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
15246 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
15247 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
15248
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015249src_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015250 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015251 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015252 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015253 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015254 returned.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015255
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015256src_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
15257 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's source
15258 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
15259 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
15260 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015261 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015262
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015263src_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015264 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015265 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
15266 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015267 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015268
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015269src_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
15270 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
15271 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
15272 table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015273 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015274 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015275
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015276src_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15277 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
15278 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
15279 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020015280 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015281 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
15282 connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015283
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030015284 Example:
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015285 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010015286 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015287 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015288
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015289src_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15290 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
15291 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
15292 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
15293 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc1.
15294 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
15295 connection when a first ACL was verified.
15296
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020015297src_is_local : boolean
15298 Returns true if the source address of the incoming connection is local to the
15299 system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning that it
15300 comes from a remote machine. Note that UNIX addresses are considered local.
15301 It can be useful to apply certain access restrictions based on where the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015302 client comes from (e.g. require auth or https for remote machines). Please
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020015303 note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do it only
15304 once per connection.
15305
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015306src_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020015307 Returns the total amount of data received from the incoming connection's
15308 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
15309 stick-table, measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is
15310 returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits
15311 values to 4 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015312
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015313src_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020015314 Returns the total amount of data sent to the incoming connection's source
15315 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
15316 measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is returned. The
15317 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
15318 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020015319
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015320src_port : integer
15321 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
15322 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected from.
15323 Usage of this function is very limited as modern protocols do not care much
15324 about source ports nowadays.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010015325
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015326src_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015327 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the incoming
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015328 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
15329 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
15330 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015331 is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015332
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015333src_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
15334 Returns the average session rate from the incoming connection's source
15335 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
15336 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
15337 session is a connection that went past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015338 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015339
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015340src_updt_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15341 Creates or updates the entry associated to the incoming connection's source
15342 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table.
15343 This table must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise
15344 the match will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the
15345 expiration timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match
15346 can't return zero. This was used to reject service abusers based on their
15347 source address. Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-sc*"
15348 actions in "tcp-request" rules instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020015349
15350 Example :
15351 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
15352 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
15353 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
15354 listen ssh
15355 bind :22
15356 mode tcp
15357 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015358 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015359 tcp-request content reject if { src_updt_conn_cnt gt 3 }
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020015360 server local 127.0.0.1:22
15361
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015362srv_id : integer
15363 Returns an integer containing the server's id when processing the response.
15364 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
15365 debugging.
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +020015366
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200153677.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015368----------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +020015369
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015370The layer 5 usually describes just the session layer which in haproxy is
15371closest to the session once all the connection handshakes are finished, but
15372when no content is yet made available. The fetch methods described here are
15373usable as low as the "tcp-request content" rule sets unless they require some
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015374future information. Those generally include the results of SSL negotiations.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020015375
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001537651d.all(<prop>[,<prop>*]) : string
15377 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
15378 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
15379 The device is identified using all the important HTTP headers from the
15380 request. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
15381 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
15382
15383 Example :
15384 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request
15385 # containing the three properties requested using all relevant headers from
15386 # the request.
15387 frontend http-in
15388 bind *:8081
15389 default_backend servers
15390 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
15391 %[51d.all(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
15392
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015393ssl_bc : boolean
15394 Returns true when the back connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
15395 layer and is locally deciphered. This means the outgoing connection was made
15396 other a server with the "ssl" option.
15397
15398ssl_bc_alg_keysize : integer
15399 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the outgoing
15400 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15401
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010015402ssl_bc_alpn : string
15403 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
15404 outgoing connection made via a TLS transport layer.
15405 The result is a string containing the protocol name negociated with the
15406 server. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
15407 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
15408 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "server" line specifies a
15409 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to pick a protocol from this
15410 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
15411 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_bc_npn".
15412
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015413ssl_bc_cipher : string
15414 Returns the name of the used cipher when the outgoing connection was made
15415 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15416
Emeric Brun74f7ffa2018-02-19 16:14:12 +010015417ssl_bc_is_resumed : boolean
15418 Returns true when the back connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
15419 layer and the newly created SSL session was resumed using a cached
15420 session or a TLS ticket.
15421
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010015422ssl_bc_npn : string
15423 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an outgoing connection
15424 made via a TLS transport layer. The result is a string containing the
15425 protocol name negociated with the server . The SSL library must have been
15426 built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that
15427 the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the "npn" keyword on the
15428 "server" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to
15429 pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be used. Please note that
15430 the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
15431
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015432ssl_bc_protocol : string
15433 Returns the name of the used protocol when the outgoing connection was made
15434 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15435
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020015436ssl_bc_unique_id : binary
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015437 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020015438 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
15439 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015440
15441ssl_bc_session_id : binary
15442 Returns the SSL ID of the back connection when the outgoing connection was
15443 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to log if we want to know
15444 if session was reused or not.
15445
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040015446ssl_bc_session_key : binary
15447 Returns the SSL session master key of the back connection when the outgoing
15448 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
15449 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
15450 BoringSSL.
15451
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015452ssl_bc_use_keysize : integer
15453 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the outgoing
15454 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15455
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015456ssl_c_ca_err : integer
15457 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15458 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification of the client
15459 certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was encountered during this
15460 verification process. Please refer to your SSL library's documentation to
15461 find the exhaustive list of error codes.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020015462
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015463ssl_c_ca_err_depth : integer
15464 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15465 returns the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
15466 verification of the client certificate. If no error is encountered, 0 is
15467 returned.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015468
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010015469ssl_c_der : binary
15470 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the client when the
15471 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
15472 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
15473
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015474ssl_c_err : integer
15475 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15476 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth 0, or
15477 0 if no error was encountered during this verification process. Please refer
15478 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
15479 codes.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015480
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015481ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
15482 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15483 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
15484 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
15485 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
15486 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
15487 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
15488 For instance, "ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
15489 "ssl_c_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015490
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015491ssl_c_key_alg : string
15492 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
15493 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15494 transport layer.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015495
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015496ssl_c_notafter : string
15497 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted string
15498 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15499 transport layer.
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020015500
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015501ssl_c_notbefore : string
15502 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted string
15503 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15504 transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010015505
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015506ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
15507 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15508 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
15509 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
15510 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
15511 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
15512 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
15513 For instance, "ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
15514 "ssl_c_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010015515
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015516ssl_c_serial : binary
15517 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client when the
15518 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
15519 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015520
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015521ssl_c_sha1 : binary
15522 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the client when
15523 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This can be
15524 used to stick a client to a server, or to pass this information to a server.
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020015525 Note that the output is binary, so if you want to pass that signature to the
15526 server, you need to encode it in hex or base64, such as in the example below:
15527
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030015528 Example:
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020015529 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-SHA1 %[ssl_c_sha1,hex]
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015530
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015531ssl_c_sig_alg : string
15532 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
15533 the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
15534 layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015535
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015536ssl_c_used : boolean
15537 Returns true if current SSL session uses a client certificate even if current
15538 connection uses SSL session resumption. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020015539
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015540ssl_c_verify : integer
15541 Returns the verify result error ID when the incoming connection was made over
15542 an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no error is encountered. Please
15543 refer to your SSL library's documentation for an exhaustive list of error
15544 codes.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020015545
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015546ssl_c_version : integer
15547 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client when the
15548 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020015549
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010015550ssl_f_der : binary
15551 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the frontend when the
15552 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
15553 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
15554
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015555ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
15556 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15557 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
15558 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
15559 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015560 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015561 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
15562 For instance, "ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
15563 "ssl_f_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015564
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015565ssl_f_key_alg : string
15566 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
15567 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an
15568 SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020015569
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015570ssl_f_notafter : string
15571 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
15572 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15573 transport layer.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015574
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015575ssl_f_notbefore : string
15576 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
15577 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15578 transport layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015579
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015580ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
15581 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15582 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
15583 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
15584 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
15585 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
15586 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
15587 For instance, "ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
15588 "ssl_f_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020015589
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015590ssl_f_serial : binary
15591 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
15592 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
15593 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015594
Emeric Brun55f4fa82014-04-30 17:11:25 +020015595ssl_f_sha1 : binary
15596 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the frontend
15597 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
15598 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
15599
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015600ssl_f_sig_alg : string
15601 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
15602 the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
15603 layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020015604
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015605ssl_f_version : integer
15606 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
15607 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15608
15609ssl_fc : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015610 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
15611 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
15612 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
15613
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015614 Example :
15615 # This passes "X-Proto: https" to servers when client connects over SSL
15616 listen http-https
15617 bind :80
15618 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy.pem
15619 http-request add-header X-Proto https if { ssl_fc }
15620
15621ssl_fc_alg_keysize : integer
15622 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the incoming
15623 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15624
15625ssl_fc_alpn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015626 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015627 incoming connection made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by
15628 haproxy. The result is a string containing the protocol name advertised by
15629 the client. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
15630 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
15631 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a
15632 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to pick a protocol from this
15633 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
15634 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_fc_npn".
15635
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015636ssl_fc_cipher : string
15637 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection was made
15638 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020015639
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010015640ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin : binary
15641 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum returned
15642 value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010015643 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010015644
15645ssl_fc_cipherlist_hex : string
15646 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list encoded as
15647 hexadecimal. The maximum returned value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010015648 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010015649
15650ssl_fc_cipherlist_str : string
15651 Returns the decoded text form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum
15652 number of ciphers returned is according with the value of
15653 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size". Note that this sample-fetch is only
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015654 available with OpenSSL >= 1.0.2. If the function is not enabled, this
Emmanuel Hocdetddcde192017-09-01 17:32:08 +020015655 sample-fetch returns the hash like "ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010015656
15657ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh : integer
15658 Returns a xxh64 of the cipher list. This hash can be return only is the value
15659 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size" is set greater than 0, however the hash
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010015660 take in account all the data of the cipher list.
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010015661
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015662ssl_fc_has_crt : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015663 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
15664 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +010015665 Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket, client
15666 certificate is not present in the current connection but may be retrieved
15667 from the cache or the ticket. So prefer "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if
15668 current SSL session uses a client certificate.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015669
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +020015670ssl_fc_has_early : boolean
15671 Returns true if early data were sent, and the handshake didn't happen yet. As
15672 it has security implications, it is useful to be able to refuse those, or
15673 wait until the handshake happened.
15674
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015675ssl_fc_has_sni : boolean
15676 This checks for the presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI)
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020015677 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
15678 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
15679 that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
15680 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020015681
Nenad Merdanovic1516fe32016-05-17 03:31:21 +020015682ssl_fc_is_resumed : boolean
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020015683 Returns true if the SSL/TLS session has been resumed through the use of
Jérôme Magnin4a326cb2018-01-15 14:01:17 +010015684 SSL session cache or TLS tickets on an incoming connection over an SSL/TLS
15685 transport layer.
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020015686
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015687ssl_fc_npn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015688 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an incoming connection
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015689 made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by haproxy. The result
15690 is a string containing the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL
15691 library must have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
15692 haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the
15693 "npn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing
15694 forces the client to pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be
15695 requested. Please note that the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +020015696
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015697ssl_fc_protocol : string
15698 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming connection was made
15699 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020015700
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020015701ssl_fc_unique_id : binary
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040015702 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020015703 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
15704 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040015705
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015706ssl_fc_session_id : binary
15707 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming connection was
15708 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to stick a given client to
15709 a server. It is important to note that some browsers refresh their session ID
15710 every few minutes.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020015711
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040015712ssl_fc_session_key : binary
15713 Returns the SSL session master key of the front connection when the incoming
15714 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
15715 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
15716 BoringSSL.
15717
15718
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015719ssl_fc_sni : string
15720 This extracts the Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI) field from an
15721 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
15722 deciphered by haproxy. The result (when present) typically is a string
15723 matching the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must have
15724 been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
15725
15726 This fetch is different from "req_ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the
15727 connection being deciphered by haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly
15728 forwarded. See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_reg" below. This
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +020015729 requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
15730 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015731
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015732 ACL derivatives :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015733 ssl_fc_sni_end : suffix match
15734 ssl_fc_sni_reg : regex match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020015735
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015736ssl_fc_use_keysize : integer
15737 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the incoming
15738 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020015739
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020015740
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200157417.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015742------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020015743
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015744Fetching samples from buffer contents is a bit different from the previous
15745sample fetches above because the sampled data are ephemeral. These data can
15746only be used when they're available and will be lost when they're forwarded.
15747For this reason, samples fetched from buffer contents during a request cannot
15748be used in a response for example. Even while the data are being fetched, they
15749can change. Sometimes it is necessary to set some delays or combine multiple
15750sample fetch methods to ensure that the expected data are complete and usable,
15751for example through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request
15752content" keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015753
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015754payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary (deprecated)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015755 This is an alias for "req.payload" when used in the context of a request (e.g.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015756 "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload" when used in the context of
15757 a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015758
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015759payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary (deprecated)
15760 This is an alias for "req.payload_lv" when used in the context of a request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015761 (e.g. "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload_lv" when used in the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015762 context of a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015763
Thierry FOURNIERd7d88812017-04-19 15:15:14 +020015764req.hdrs : string
15765 Returns the current request headers as string including the last empty line
15766 separating headers from the request body. The last empty line can be used to
15767 detect a truncated header block. This sample fetch is useful for some SPOE
15768 headers analyzers and for advanced logging.
15769
Thierry FOURNIER5617dce2017-04-09 05:38:19 +020015770req.hdrs_bin : binary
15771 Returns the current request headers contained in preparsed binary form. This
15772 is useful for offloading some processing with SPOE. Each string is described
15773 by a length followed by the number of bytes indicated in the length. The
15774 length is represented using the variable integer encoding detailed in the
15775 SPOE documentation. The end of the list is marked by a couple of empty header
15776 names and values (length of 0 for both).
15777
15778 *(<str:header-name><str:header-value>)<empty string><empty string>
15779
15780 int: refer to the SPOE documentation for the encoding
15781 str: <int:length><bytes>
15782
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015783req.len : integer
15784req_len : integer (deprecated)
15785 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
15786 request buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
15787 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
15788 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
15789 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
15790 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
15791 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP request
15792 content inspection.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015793
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015794req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
15795 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020015796 in the request buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
15797 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
15798 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
15799 any location.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015800
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015801 ACL alternatives :
15802 payload(<offset>,<length>) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015803
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015804req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
15805 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
15806 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
15807 the request buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
15808 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015809
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015810 ACL alternatives :
15811 payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015812
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015813 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015814
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015815req.proto_http : boolean
15816req_proto_http : boolean (deprecated)
15817 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
15818 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
15819 is used so there should be no surprises. The test does not match until the
15820 request is complete, failed or timed out. This test may be used to report the
15821 protocol in TCP logs, but the biggest use is to block TCP request analysis
15822 until a complete HTTP request is present in the buffer, for example to track
15823 a header.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015824
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015825 Example:
15826 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
15827 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
15828 tcp-request content reject if !HTTP
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020015829 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015830
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015831req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string
15832rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
15833 When the request buffer looks like the RDP protocol, extracts the RDP cookie
15834 <name>, or any cookie if unspecified. The parser only checks for the first
15835 cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol specification. The cookie name is
15836 case insensitive. Generally the "MSTS" cookie name will be used, as it can
15837 contain the user name of the client connecting to the server if properly
15838 configured on the client. The "MSTSHASH" cookie is often used as well for
15839 session stickiness to servers.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015840
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015841 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing algorithm may be
15842 used and thus the distribution of clients to backend servers is not linked to
15843 a hash of the RDP cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
15844 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconn" will lead to a more even
15845 distribution of clients to backend servers than the hash used by "balance
15846 rdp-cookie".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015847
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015848 ACL derivatives :
15849 req_rdp_cookie([<name>]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015850
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015851 Example :
15852 listen tse-farm
15853 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
15854 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
15855 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
15856 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
15857 # apply RDP cookie persistence
15858 persist rdp-cookie
15859 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
15860 # This is only useful makes sense if
15861 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
15862 stick-table type string size 204800
15863 stick on req.rdp_cookie(mstshash)
15864 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
15865 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015866
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015867 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the
15868 "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015869
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015870req.rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer
15871rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer (deprecated)
15872 Tries to parse the request buffer as RDP protocol, then returns an integer
15873 corresponding to the number of RDP cookies found. If an optional cookie name
15874 is passed, only cookies matching this name are considered. This is mostly
15875 used in ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015876
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015877 ACL derivatives :
15878 req_rdp_cookie_cnt([<name>]) : integer match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015879
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110015880req.ssl_alpn : string
15881 Returns a string containing the values of the Application-Layer Protocol
15882 Negotiation (ALPN) TLS extension (RFC7301), sent by the client within the SSL
15883 ClientHello message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the
15884 request buffer and not to the contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so
15885 this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This is useful
15886 in ACL to make a routing decision based upon the ALPN preferences of a TLS
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020015887 client, like in the example below. See also "ssl_fc_alpn".
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110015888
15889 Examples :
15890 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
15891 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
15892 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020015893 use_backend bk_acme if { req.ssl_alpn acme-tls/1 }
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110015894 default_backend bk_default
15895
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020015896req.ssl_ec_ext : boolean
15897 Returns a boolean identifying if client sent the Supported Elliptic Curves
15898 Extension as defined in RFC4492, section 5.1. within the SSL ClientHello
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020015899 message. This can be used to present ECC compatible clients with EC
15900 certificate and to use RSA for all others, on the same IP address. Note that
15901 this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and not to
15902 contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind"
15903 lines having the "ssl" option.
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020015904
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015905req.ssl_hello_type : integer
15906req_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
15907 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
15908 in the request buffer if the buffer contains data that parse as a complete
15909 SSL (v3 or superior) client hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
15910 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
15911 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
15912 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
15913 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015914
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015915req.ssl_sni : string
15916req_ssl_sni : string (deprecated)
15917 Returns a string containing the value of the Server Name TLS extension sent
15918 by a client in a TLS stream passing through the request buffer if the buffer
15919 contains data that parse as a complete SSL (v3 or superior) client hello
15920 message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
15921 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
15922 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. SNI normally contains the
15923 name of the host the client tries to connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is
15924 useful for allowing or denying access to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used
15925 by the client. This test was designed to be used with TCP request content
15926 inspection. If content switching is needed, it is recommended to first wait
15927 for a complete client hello (type 1), like in the example below. See also
15928 "ssl_fc_sni".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015929
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015930 ACL derivatives :
15931 req_ssl_sni : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015932
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015933 Examples :
15934 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
15935 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
15936 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
15937 use_backend bk_allow if { req_ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
15938 default_backend bk_sorry_page
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015939
Pradeep Jindalbb2acf52015-09-29 10:12:57 +053015940req.ssl_st_ext : integer
15941 Returns 0 if the client didn't send a SessionTicket TLS Extension (RFC5077)
15942 Returns 1 if the client sent SessionTicket TLS Extension
15943 Returns 2 if the client also sent non-zero length TLS SessionTicket
15944 Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and
15945 not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with
15946 "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This can for example be used to detect
15947 whether the client sent a SessionTicket or not and stick it accordingly, if
15948 no SessionTicket then stick on SessionID or don't stick as there's no server
15949 side state is there when SessionTickets are in use.
15950
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015951req.ssl_ver : integer
15952req_ssl_ver : integer (deprecated)
15953 Returns an integer value containing the version of the SSL/TLS protocol of a
15954 stream present in the request buffer. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
15955 messages are supported. TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. The value is
15956 composed of the major version multiplied by 65536, added to the minor
15957 version. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
15958 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
15959 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. The ACL version of the test
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015960 matches against a decimal notation in the form MAJOR.MINOR (e.g. 3.1). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015961 fetch is mostly used in ACL.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015962
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015963 ACL derivatives :
15964 req_ssl_ver : decimal match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015965
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020015966res.len : integer
15967 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
15968 response buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
15969 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
15970 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
15971 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
15972 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
15973 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP response
15974 content inspection.
15975
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015976res.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
15977 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020015978 in the response buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
15979 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
15980 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
15981 any location.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015982
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015983res.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
15984 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
15985 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
15986 the response buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets
15987 if prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015988
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015989 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015990
Willy Tarreau971f7b62015-09-29 14:06:59 +020015991res.ssl_hello_type : integer
15992rep_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
15993 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
15994 in the response buffer if the buffer contains data that parses as a complete
15995 SSL (v3 or superior) hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
15996 contents found in the response buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
15997 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "server" lines having the "ssl"
15998 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
15999 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
16000
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016001wait_end : boolean
16002 This fetch either returns true when the inspection period is over, or does
16003 not fetch. It is only used in ACLs, in conjunction with content analysis to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016004 avoid returning a wrong verdict early. It may also be used to delay some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016005 actions, such as a delayed reject for some special addresses. Since it either
16006 stops the rules evaluation or immediately returns true, it is recommended to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016007 use this acl as the last one in a rule. Please note that the default ACL
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016008 "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior declaration. This test was designed
16009 to be used with TCP request content inspection.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016010
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016011 Examples :
16012 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
16013 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
16014 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016015
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016016 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
16017 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
16018 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
16019 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
16020 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
16021 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
16022 tcp-request content reject
16023
16024
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200160257.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016026--------------------------------------
16027
16028It is possible to fetch samples from HTTP contents, requests and responses.
16029This application layer is also called layer 7. It is only possible to fetch the
16030data in this section when a full HTTP request or response has been parsed from
16031its respective request or response buffer. This is always the case with all
16032HTTP specific rules and for sections running with "mode http". When using TCP
16033content inspection, it may be necessary to support an inspection delay in order
16034to let the request or response come in first. These fetches may require a bit
16035more CPU resources than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and
16036response are indexed.
16037
16038base : string
16039 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
16040 the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the question
16041 mark. It can be useful in virtual hosted environments to detect URL abuses as
16042 well as to improve shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size
16043 stick table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
16044 requested objects by host/path. With ACLs it can allow simple content
16045 switching rules involving the host and the path at the same time, such as
16046 "www.example.com/favicon.ico". See also "path" and "uri".
16047
16048 ACL derivatives :
16049 base : exact string match
16050 base_beg : prefix match
16051 base_dir : subdir match
16052 base_dom : domain match
16053 base_end : suffix match
16054 base_len : length match
16055 base_reg : regex match
16056 base_sub : substring match
16057
16058base32 : integer
16059 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value returned by the "base" fetch method
16060 above. This is useful to track per-URL activity on high traffic sites without
16061 having to store all URLs. Instead a shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020016062 memory. The output type is an unsigned integer. The hash function used is
16063 SDBM with full avalanche on the output. Technically, base32 is exactly equal
16064 to "base,sdbm(1)".
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016065
16066base32+src : binary
16067 This returns the concatenation of the base32 fetch above and the src fetch
16068 below. The resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes
16069 depending on the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP,
16070 per-URL counters.
16071
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010016072capture.req.hdr(<idx>) : string
16073 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture request
16074 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
16075 The first entry is an index of 0. See also: "capture request header".
16076
16077capture.req.method : string
16078 This extracts the METHOD of an HTTP request. It can be used in both request
16079 and response. Unlike "method", it can be used in both request and response
16080 because it's allocated.
16081
16082capture.req.uri : string
16083 This extracts the request's URI, which starts at the first slash and ends
16084 before the first space in the request (without the host part). Unlike "path"
16085 and "url", it can be used in both request and response because it's
16086 allocated.
16087
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020016088capture.req.ver : string
16089 This extracts the request's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
16090 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "req.ver", it can be used in both request, response, and
16091 logs because it relies on a persistent flag.
16092
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010016093capture.res.hdr(<idx>) : string
16094 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture response
16095 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
16096 The first entry is an index of 0.
16097 See also: "capture response header"
16098
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020016099capture.res.ver : string
16100 This extracts the response's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
16101 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "res.ver", it can be used in logs because it relies on a
16102 persistent flag.
16103
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020016104req.body : binary
16105 This returns the HTTP request's available body as a block of data. It
16106 requires that the request body has been buffered made available using
16107 "option http-buffer-request". In case of chunked-encoded body, currently only
16108 the first chunk is analyzed.
16109
Thierry FOURNIER9826c772015-05-20 15:50:54 +020016110req.body_param([<name>) : string
16111 This fetch assumes that the body of the POST request is url-encoded. The user
16112 can check if the "content-type" contains the value
16113 "application/x-www-form-urlencoded". This extracts the first occurrence of the
16114 parameter <name> in the body, which ends before '&'. The parameter name is
16115 case-sensitive. If no name is given, any parameter will match, and the first
16116 one will be returned. The result is a string corresponding to the value of the
16117 parameter <name> as presented in the request body (no URL decoding is
16118 performed). Note that the ACL version of this fetch iterates over multiple
16119 parameters and will iteratively report all parameters values if no name is
16120 given.
16121
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020016122req.body_len : integer
16123 This returns the length of the HTTP request's available body in bytes. It may
16124 be lower than the advertised length if the body is larger than the buffer. It
16125 requires that the request body has been buffered made available using
16126 "option http-buffer-request".
16127
16128req.body_size : integer
16129 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP request's body in bytes. It
16130 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the first
16131 chunk in case of chunked encoding. In order to parse the chunks, it requires
16132 that the request body has been buffered made available using
16133 "option http-buffer-request".
16134
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016135req.cook([<name>]) : string
16136cook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
16137 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
16138 header line from the request, and returns its value as string. If no name is
16139 specified, the first cookie value is returned. When used with ACLs, all
16140 matching cookies are evaluated. Spaces around the name and the value are
16141 ignored as requested by the Cookie header specification (RFC6265). The cookie
16142 name is case-sensitive. Empty cookies are valid, so an empty cookie may very
16143 well return an empty value if it is present. Use the "found" match to detect
16144 presence. Use the res.cook() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
16145
16146 ACL derivatives :
16147 cook([<name>]) : exact string match
16148 cook_beg([<name>]) : prefix match
16149 cook_dir([<name>]) : subdir match
16150 cook_dom([<name>]) : domain match
16151 cook_end([<name>]) : suffix match
16152 cook_len([<name>]) : length match
16153 cook_reg([<name>]) : regex match
16154 cook_sub([<name>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016155
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016156req.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16157cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
16158 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
16159 <name> in the request, or all cookies if <name> is not specified.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016160
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016161req.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
16162cook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
16163 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
16164 header line from the request, and converts its value to an integer which is
16165 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. When
16166 used in ACLs, all matching names are iterated over until a value matches.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020016167
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016168cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
16169 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
16170 header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header from the response, and
16171 returns its value as a string. A typical use is to get multiple clients
16172 sharing a same profile use the same server. This can be similar to what
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020016173 "appsession" did with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016174 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts. If no name is
16175 specified, the first cookie value is returned. This fetch should not be used
16176 anymore and should be replaced by req.cook() or res.cook() instead as it
16177 ambiguously uses the direction based on the context where it is used.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016178
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016179hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
16180 This is equivalent to req.hdr() when used on requests, and to res.hdr() when
16181 used on responses. Please refer to these respective fetches for more details.
16182 In case of doubt about the fetch direction, please use the explicit ones.
16183 Note that contrary to the hdr() sample fetch method, the hdr_* ACL keywords
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016184 unambiguously apply to the request headers.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016185
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016186req.fhdr(<name>[,<occ>]) : string
16187 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
16188 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
16189 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
16190 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
16191 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
16192 with -1 being the last one. It differs from req.hdr() in that any commas
16193 present in the value are returned and are not used as delimiters. This is
16194 sometimes useful with headers such as User-Agent.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016195
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016196req.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16197 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
16198 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
16199 not specified. Contrary to its req.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
16200 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016201
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016202req.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
16203 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
16204 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
16205 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
16206 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
16207 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
16208 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header
16209 once converted to IP, associated with an IP stick-table. The function
16210 considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +000016211 are desired instead, use req.fhdr(). Please carefully check RFC7231 to know
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016212 how certain headers are supposed to be parsed. Also, some of them are case
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016213 insensitive (e.g. Connection).
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016214
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016215 ACL derivatives :
16216 hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
16217 hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
16218 hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
16219 hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
16220 hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
16221 hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
16222 hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
16223 hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
16224
16225req.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16226hdr_cnt([<header>]) : integer (deprecated)
16227 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
16228 header field name <name>, or the total number of header field values if
16229 <name> is not specified. It is important to remember that one header line may
16230 count as several headers if it has several values. The function considers any
16231 comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers are desired
16232 instead, req.fhdr_cnt() should be used instead. With ACLs, it can be used to
16233 detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific header, as well as to block
16234 request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests which contain more than one
16235 of certain headers. See "req.hdr" for more information on header matching.
16236
16237req.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
16238hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
16239 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request,
16240 converts it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. When used
16241 with ACLs, all occurrences are checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value
16242 of every header is checked. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
16243 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016244 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016245 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. A typical use
16246 is with the X-Forwarded-For and X-Client-IP headers.
16247
16248req.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
16249hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
16250 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request, and
16251 converts it to an integer value. When used with ACLs, all occurrences are
16252 checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value of every header is checked.
16253 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
16254 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
16255 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
16256 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header.
16257
Frédéric Lécailleec891192019-02-26 15:02:35 +010016258
16259
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016260http_auth(<userlist>) : boolean
16261 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
16262 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist. This
16263 fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
16264 basic auth is supported.
16265
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010016266http_auth_group(<userlist>) : string
16267 Returns a string corresponding to the user name found in the authentication
16268 data received from the client if both the user name and password are valid
16269 according to the specified userlist. The main purpose is to use it in ACLs
16270 where it is then checked whether the user belongs to any group within a list.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016271 This fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
16272 basic auth is supported.
16273
16274 ACL derivatives :
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010016275 http_auth_group(<userlist>) : group ...
16276 Returns true when the user extracted from the request and whose password is
16277 valid according to the specified userlist belongs to at least one of the
16278 groups.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016279
16280http_first_req : boolean
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020016281 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
16282 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016283 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or to help grouping
16284 requests in the logs.
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020016285
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016286method : integer + string
16287 Returns an integer value corresponding to the method in the HTTP request. For
16288 example, "GET" equals 1 (check sources to establish the matching). Value 9
16289 means "other method" and may be converted to a string extracted from the
16290 stream. This should not be used directly as a sample, this is only meant to
16291 be used from ACLs, which transparently convert methods from patterns to these
16292 integer + string values. Some predefined ACL already check for most common
16293 methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016294
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016295 ACL derivatives :
16296 method : case insensitive method match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016297
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016298 Example :
16299 # only accept GET and HEAD requests
16300 acl valid_method method GET HEAD
16301 http-request deny if ! valid_method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016302
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016303path : string
16304 This extracts the request's URL path, which starts at the first slash and
16305 ends before the question mark (without the host part). A typical use is with
16306 prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate multiple
16307 information from databases and keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing
16308 caches, it would be wiser to use "url" instead. With ACLs, it's typically
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016309 used to match exact file names (e.g. "/login.php"), or directory parts using
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016310 the derivative forms. See also the "url" and "base" fetch methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016311
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016312 ACL derivatives :
16313 path : exact string match
16314 path_beg : prefix match
16315 path_dir : subdir match
16316 path_dom : domain match
16317 path_end : suffix match
16318 path_len : length match
16319 path_reg : regex match
16320 path_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016321
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010016322query : string
16323 This extracts the request's query string, which starts after the first
16324 question mark. If no question mark is present, this fetch returns nothing. If
16325 a question mark is present but nothing follows, it returns an empty string.
16326 This means it's possible to easily know whether a query string is present
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010016327 using the "found" matching method. This fetch is the complement of "path"
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010016328 which stops before the question mark.
16329
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010016330req.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
16331 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
16332 appear in the request when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
16333 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
16334 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
16335
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016336req.ver : string
16337req_ver : string (deprecated)
16338 Returns the version string from the HTTP request, for example "1.1". This can
16339 be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. Some predefined ACL already
16340 check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016341
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016342 ACL derivatives :
16343 req_ver : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020016344
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016345res.comp : boolean
16346 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been compressed by
16347 HAProxy, otherwise returns boolean "false". This may be used to add
16348 information in the logs.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016349
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016350res.comp_algo : string
16351 Returns a string containing the name of the algorithm used if the response
16352 was compressed by HAProxy, for example : "deflate". This may be used to add
16353 some information in the logs.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016354
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016355res.cook([<name>]) : string
16356scook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
16357 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
16358 header line from the response, and returns its value as string. If no name is
16359 specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020016360
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016361 ACL derivatives :
16362 scook([<name>] : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020016363
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016364res.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16365scook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
16366 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
16367 <name> in the response, or all cookies if <name> is not specified. This is
16368 mostly useful when combined with ACLs to detect suspicious responses.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016369
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016370res.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
16371scook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
16372 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
16373 header line from the response, and converts its value to an integer which is
16374 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016375
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016376res.fhdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
16377 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
16378 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
16379 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
16380 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
16381 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. It
16382 differs from res.hdr() in that any commas present in the value are returned
16383 and are not used as delimiters. If this is not desired, the res.hdr() fetch
16384 should be used instead. This is sometimes useful with headers such as Date or
16385 Expires.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016386
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016387res.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16388 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
16389 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
16390 not specified. Contrary to its res.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
16391 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas. If this is not
16392 desired, the res.hdr_cnt() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016393
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016394res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
16395shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string (deprecated)
16396 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
16397 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
16398 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
16399 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
16400 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This
16401 can be useful to learn some data into a stick-table. The function considers
16402 any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If this is not desired, the
16403 res.fhdr() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016404
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016405 ACL derivatives :
16406 shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
16407 shdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
16408 shdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
16409 shdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
16410 shdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
16411 shdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
16412 shdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
16413 shdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
16414
16415res.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16416shdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
16417 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
16418 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
16419 not specified. The function considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct
16420 values. If this is not desired, the res.fhdr_cnt() fetch should be used
16421 instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016422
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016423res.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
16424shdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
16425 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response,
16426 convert it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. Optionally, a
16427 specific occurrence might be specified as a position number. Positive values
16428 indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one.
16429 Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being
16430 the last one. This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016431
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010016432res.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
16433 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
16434 appear in the response when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
16435 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
16436 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
16437
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016438res.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
16439shdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
16440 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, and
16441 converts it to an integer value. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
16442 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
16443 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
16444 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This can be
16445 useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010016446
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016447res.ver : string
16448resp_ver : string (deprecated)
16449 Returns the version string from the HTTP response, for example "1.1". This
16450 can be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020016451
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016452 ACL derivatives :
16453 resp_ver : exact string match
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010016454
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016455set-cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
16456 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
16457 header line from the response and uses the corresponding value to match. This
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020016458 can be comparable to what "appsession" did with default options, but with
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016459 support for multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010016460
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016461 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the "res.cook"
16462 fetch. This keyword will disappear soon.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010016463
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016464status : integer
16465 Returns an integer containing the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, for
16466 example, 302. It is mostly used within ACLs and integer ranges, for example,
16467 to remove any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016468
Thierry Fournier0e00dca2016-04-07 15:47:40 +020016469unique-id : string
16470 Returns the unique-id attached to the request. The directive
16471 "unique-id-format" must be set. If it is not set, the unique-id sample fetch
16472 fails. Note that the unique-id is usually used with HTTP requests, however this
16473 sample fetch can be used with other protocols. Obviously, if it is used with
16474 other protocols than HTTP, the unique-id-format directive must not contain
16475 HTTP parts. See: unique-id-format and unique-id-header
16476
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016477url : string
16478 This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A typical use is
16479 with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate
16480 multiple information from databases and keep them in caches. With ACLs, using
16481 "path" is preferred over using "url", because clients may send a full URL as
16482 is normally done with proxies. The only real use is to match "*" which does
16483 not match in "path", and for which there is already a predefined ACL. See
16484 also "path" and "base".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016485
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016486 ACL derivatives :
16487 url : exact string match
16488 url_beg : prefix match
16489 url_dir : subdir match
16490 url_dom : domain match
16491 url_end : suffix match
16492 url_len : length match
16493 url_reg : regex match
16494 url_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016495
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016496url_ip : ip
16497 This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the host part is
16498 presented as an IP address. Its use is very limited. For instance, a
16499 monitoring system might use this field as an alternative for the source IP in
16500 order to test what path a given source address would follow, or to force an
16501 entry in a table for a given source address. With ACLs it can be used to
16502 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
16503 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016504
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016505url_port : integer
16506 This extracts the port part from the request's URL. Note that if the port is
16507 not specified in the request, port 80 is assumed. With ACLs it can be used to
16508 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
16509 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016510
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020016511urlp([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
16512url_param([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016513 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the query
16514 string, which begins after either '?' or <delim>, and which ends before '&',
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020016515 ';' or <delim>. The parameter name is case-sensitive. If no name is given,
16516 any parameter will match, and the first one will be returned. The result is
16517 a string corresponding to the value of the parameter <name> as presented in
16518 the request (no URL decoding is performed). This can be used for session
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016519 stickiness based on a client ID, to extract an application cookie passed as a
16520 URL parameter, or in ACLs to apply some checks. Note that the ACL version of
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020016521 this fetch iterates over multiple parameters and will iteratively report all
16522 parameters values if no name is given
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016523
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016524 ACL derivatives :
16525 urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : exact string match
16526 urlp_beg(<name>[,<delim>]) : prefix match
16527 urlp_dir(<name>[,<delim>]) : subdir match
16528 urlp_dom(<name>[,<delim>]) : domain match
16529 urlp_end(<name>[,<delim>]) : suffix match
16530 urlp_len(<name>[,<delim>]) : length match
16531 urlp_reg(<name>[,<delim>]) : regex match
16532 urlp_sub(<name>[,<delim>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016533
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016534
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016535 Example :
16536 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
16537 stick on urlp(PHPSESSIONID)
16538 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
16539 stick on urlp(JSESSIONID,;)
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016540
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030016541urlp_val([<name>[,<delim>]]) : integer
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016542 See "urlp" above. This one extracts the URL parameter <name> in the request
16543 and converts it to an integer value. This can be used for session stickiness
16544 based on a user ID for example, or with ACLs to match a page number or price.
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +020016545
Dragan Dosen0070cd52016-06-16 12:19:49 +020016546url32 : integer
16547 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value obtained by concatenating the first
16548 Host header and the whole URL including parameters (not only the path part of
16549 the request, as in the "base32" fetch above). This is useful to track per-URL
16550 activity. A shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of memory. The output type
16551 is an unsigned integer.
16552
16553url32+src : binary
16554 This returns the concatenation of the "url32" fetch and the "src" fetch. The
16555 resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes depending on
16556 the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP, per-URL counters.
16557
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +010016558
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200165597.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016560---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010016561
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016562Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
16563every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020016564order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010016565
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016566ACL name Equivalent to Usage
16567---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016568FALSE always_false never match
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +020016569HTTP req_proto_http match if protocol is valid HTTP
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016570HTTP_1.0 req_ver 1.0 match HTTP version 1.0
16571HTTP_1.1 req_ver 1.1 match HTTP version 1.1
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016572HTTP_CONTENT hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length
16573HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
16574HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
16575HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
16576LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016577METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020016578METH_DELETE method DELETE match HTTP DELETE method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016579METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
16580METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
16581METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
16582METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020016583METH_PUT method PUT match HTTP PUT method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016584METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020016585RDP_COOKIE req_rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016586REQ_CONTENT req_len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016587TRUE always_true always match
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016588WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
16589---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010016590
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010016591
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200165928. Logging
16593----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010016594
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016595One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
16596provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
16597very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
16598provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
16599state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010016600to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016601headers.
16602
16603In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
16604about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
16605send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
16606
16607 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
16608 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
16609 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
16610 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
16611 at the termination.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016612 - per-request control of log-level, e.g.
Jim Freeman9e8714b2015-05-26 09:16:34 -060016613 http-request set-log-level silent if sensitive_request
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016614
16615The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
16616allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
16617as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
16618while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
16619real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
16620delay.
16621
16622
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200166238.1. Log levels
16624---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016625
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090016626TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016627source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090016628HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
16629in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
16630track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
16631syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
16632about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016633
16634
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200166358.2. Log formats
16636----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016637
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016638HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090016639and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
16640slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
16641options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016642
16643 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
16644 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
16645 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
16646 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
16647 extents.
16648
16649 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
16650 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
16651 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
16652 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
16653 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
16654
16655 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
16656 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
16657 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
16658 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
16659 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
16660
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020016661 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
16662 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
16663 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
16664 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
16665
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016666 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
16667
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016668Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
16669specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
16670field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
16671servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
16672always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
16673identifier.
16674
16675Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
16676 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
16677 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
16678 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
16679 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
16680
16681
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200166828.2.1. Default log format
16683-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016684
16685This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
16686as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
16687format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
16688
16689 Example :
16690 listen www
16691 mode http
16692 log global
16693 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
16694
16695 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
16696 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
16697 (www/HTTP)
16698
16699 Field Format Extract from the example above
16700 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
16701 2 'Connect from' Connect from
16702 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
16703 4 'to' to
16704 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
16705 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
16706
16707Detailed fields description :
16708 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
16709 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
16710 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
16711 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
16712 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
16713 and processed the connection.
16714 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
16715
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010016716In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
16717"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
16718connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
16719
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016720It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
16721will eventually disappear.
16722
16723
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200167248.2.2. TCP log format
16725---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016726
16727The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
16728is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
16729information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
16730counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
16731emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
16732environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
16733the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
16734sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020016735specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
16736not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
16737fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
16738marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016739
16740 Example :
16741 frontend fnt
16742 mode tcp
16743 option tcplog
16744 log global
16745 default_backend bck
16746
16747 backend bck
16748 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
16749
16750 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
16751 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
16752 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
16753
16754 Field Format Extract from the example above
16755 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
16756 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
16757 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
16758 4 frontend_name fnt
16759 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
16760 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
16761 7 bytes_read* 212
16762 8 termination_state --
16763 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
16764 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
16765
16766Detailed fields description :
16767 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010016768 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
16769 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
16770 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010016771 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016772 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010016773 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016774
16775 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010016776 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
16777 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
16778 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016779
16780 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by haproxy
16781 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
16782 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020016783 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. When used in
16784 HTTP mode, the accept_date field will be reset to the first moment the
16785 connection is ready to receive a new request (end of previous response for
16786 HTTP/1, immediately after previous request for HTTP/2).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016787
16788 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
16789 and processed the connection.
16790
16791 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
16792 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
16793 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
16794 applications.
16795
16796 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
16797 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
16798 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
16799 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
16800 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
16801
16802 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
16803 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
16804 See "Timers" below for more details.
16805
16806 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
16807 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
16808 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
16809 "Timers" below for more details.
16810
16811 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016812 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016813 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
16814 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
16815 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
16816 details.
16817
16818 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
16819 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
16820 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
16821 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
16822 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
16823
16824 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
16825 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
16826 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
16827 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
16828 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
16829 for more details.
16830
16831 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040016832 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016833 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
16834 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
16835 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016836 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016837
16838 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
16839 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
16840 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
16841 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
16842 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
16843 caused by a denial of service attack.
16844
16845 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
16846 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
16847 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
16848 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
16849 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
16850 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
16851 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
16852 denial of service attack.
16853
16854 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
16855 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
16856 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
16857 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
16858 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
16859 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
16860 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
16861 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
16862 be processed than on other servers.
16863
16864 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
16865 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
16866 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
16867 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
16868 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
16869 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
16870 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
16871 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
16872 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
16873 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
16874 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
16875 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
16876 should not be attributed to the logged server.
16877
16878 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
16879 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
16880 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
16881 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
16882 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
16883 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016884 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016885 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
16886
16887 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
16888 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
16889 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
16890 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
16891 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
16892 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016893 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016894 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
16895 occurs.
16896
16897
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200168988.2.3. HTTP log format
16899----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016900
16901The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
16902is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
16903the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
16904are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
16905emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
16906generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
16907"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
16908which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020016909frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
16910is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016911
16912Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
16913slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
16914with a star ('*') after the field name below.
16915
16916 Example :
16917 frontend http-in
16918 mode http
16919 option httplog
16920 log global
16921 default_backend bck
16922
16923 backend static
16924 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
16925
16926 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
16927 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
16928 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010016929 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016930
16931 Field Format Extract from the example above
16932 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
16933 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016934 3 '[' request_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016935 4 frontend_name http-in
16936 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016937 6 TR '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Ta* 10/0/30/69/109
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016938 7 status_code 200
16939 8 bytes_read* 2750
16940 9 captured_request_cookie -
16941 10 captured_response_cookie -
16942 11 termination_state ----
16943 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
16944 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
16945 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
16946 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
16947 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010016948
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016949Detailed fields description :
16950 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010016951 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
16952 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
16953 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010016954 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016955 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010016956 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016957
16958 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010016959 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
16960 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
16961 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016962
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016963 - "request_date" is the exact date when the first byte of the HTTP request
16964 was received by haproxy (log field %tr).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016965
16966 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
16967 and processed the connection.
16968
16969 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
16970 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
16971 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
16972
16973 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
16974 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
16975 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
16976 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
16977 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
16978 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
16979
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016980 - "TR" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for a full HTTP
16981 request from the client (not counting body) after the first byte was
16982 received. It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before a complete
16983 request could be received or the a bad request was received. It should
16984 always be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet.
16985 Large times here generally indicate network issues between the client and
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020016986 haproxy or requests being typed by hand. See section 8.4 "Timing Events"
16987 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016988
16989 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
16990 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020016991 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016992
16993 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
16994 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020016995 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See section
16996 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016997
16998 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
16999 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
17000 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
17001 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
17002 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017003 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See section 8.4
17004 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017005
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017006 - "Ta" is the time the request remained active in haproxy, which is the total
17007 time in milliseconds elapsed between the first byte of the request was
17008 received and the last byte of response was sent. It covers all possible
17009 processing except the handshake (see Th) and idle time (see Ti). There is
17010 one exception, if "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting
17011 stops at the moment the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is
17012 prepended before the value, indicating that the final one will be larger.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017013 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017014
17015 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
17016 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by haproxy when
17017 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by haproxy.
17018
17019 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
17020 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
17021 specified, the this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
17022 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
17023 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
17024 overflowing.
17025
17026 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
17027 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
17028 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
17029 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
17030 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
17031 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
17032 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
17033 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
17034
17035 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
17036 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
17037 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
17038 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
17039 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
17040 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
17041 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
17042 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
17043
17044 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
17045 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
17046 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
17047 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
17048 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
17049 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
17050 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
17051
17052 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017053 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017054 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
17055 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
17056 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017057 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017058 system.
17059
17060 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
17061 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
17062 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
17063 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
17064 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
17065 caused by a denial of service attack.
17066
17067 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
17068 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
17069 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
17070 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
17071 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
17072 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
17073 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
17074 denial of service attack.
17075
17076 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
17077 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
17078 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
17079 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
17080 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
17081 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
17082 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
17083 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
17084 processed than on other servers.
17085
17086 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
17087 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
17088 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
17089 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
17090 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
17091 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
17092 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
17093 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
17094 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
17095 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
17096 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
17097 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
17098 should not be attributed to the logged server.
17099
17100 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
17101 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
17102 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
17103 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
17104 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
17105 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017106 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017107 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
17108
17109 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
17110 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
17111 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
17112 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
17113 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
17114 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017115 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017116 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
17117 occurs.
17118
17119 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
17120 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
17121 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
17122 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
17123 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
17124 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
17125 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
17126 cookies" below for more details.
17127
17128 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
17129 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
17130 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
17131 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
17132 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
17133 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
17134 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
17135 and cookies" below for more details.
17136
17137 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
17138 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
17139 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
17140 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
17141 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
17142 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
17143 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
17144 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
17145
17146
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200171478.2.4. Custom log format
17148------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017149
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017150The directive log-format allows you to customize the logs in http mode and tcp
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017151mode. It takes a string as argument.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017152
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017153HAProxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017154Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
17155separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
17156prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
17157
17158Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
17159variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010017160("Q") and escaped ("E") string formats.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017161
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010017162If a variable is named between square brackets ('[' .. ']') then it is used
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020017163as a sample expression rule (see section 7.3). This it useful to add some
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010017164less common information such as the client's SSL certificate's DN, or to log
17165the key that would be used to store an entry into a stick table.
17166
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017167Note: spaces must be escaped. A space character is considered as a separator.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017168In order to emit a verbatim '%', it must be preceded by another '%' resulting
Willy Tarreau06d97f92013-12-02 17:45:48 +010017169in '%%'. HAProxy will automatically merge consecutive separators.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017170
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010017171Note: when using the RFC5424 syslog message format, the characters '"',
17172'\' and ']' inside PARAM-VALUE should be escaped with '\' as prefix (see
17173https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3.3 for more details). In
17174such cases, the use of the flag "E" should be considered.
17175
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017176Flags are :
17177 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017178 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010017179 * E: escape characters '"', '\' and ']' in a string with '\' as prefix
17180 (intended purpose is for the RFC5424 structured-data log formats)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017181
17182 Example:
17183
17184 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
17185 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
17186
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010017187 log-format-sd %{+Q,+E}o\ [exampleSDID@1234\ header=%[capture.req.hdr(0)]]
17188
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017189At the moment, the default HTTP format is defined this way :
17190
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017191 log-format "%ci:%cp [%tr] %ft %b/%s %TR/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Ta %ST %B %CC \
17192 %CS %tsc %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq %hr %hs %{+Q}r"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017193
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017194the default CLF format is defined this way :
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017195
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017196 log-format "%{+Q}o %{-Q}ci - - [%trg] %r %ST %B \"\" \"\" %cp \
17197 %ms %ft %b %s %TR %Tw %Tc %Tr %Ta %tsc %ac %fc \
17198 %bc %sc %rc %sq %bq %CC %CS %hrl %hsl"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017199
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017200and the default TCP format is defined this way :
17201
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017202 log-format "%ci:%cp [%t] %ft %b/%s %Tw/%Tc/%Tt %B %ts \
17203 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq"
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017204
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017205Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
17206
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017207 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020017208 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017209 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
17210 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
17211 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017212 | | %B | bytes_read (from server to client) | numeric |
17213 | H | %CC | captured_request_cookie | string |
17214 | H | %CS | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020017215 | | %H | hostname | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000017216 | H | %HM | HTTP method (ex: POST) | string |
17217 | H | %HP | HTTP request URI without query string (path) | string |
Andrew Hayworthe63ac872015-07-31 16:14:16 +000017218 | H | %HQ | HTTP request URI query string (ex: ?bar=baz) | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000017219 | H | %HU | HTTP request URI (ex: /foo?bar=baz) | string |
17220 | H | %HV | HTTP version (ex: HTTP/1.0) | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010017221 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
Willy Tarreau4bf99632014-06-13 12:21:40 +020017222 | | %ST | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020017223 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017224 | | %Ta | Active time of the request (from TR to end) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017225 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Willy Tarreau27b639d2016-05-17 17:55:27 +020017226 | | %Td | Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr) | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080017227 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017228 | | %Th | connection handshake time (SSL, PROXY proto) | numeric |
17229 | H | %Ti | idle time before the HTTP request | numeric |
17230 | H | %Tq | Th + Ti + TR | numeric |
17231 | H | %TR | time to receive the full request from 1st byte| numeric |
17232 | H | %Tr | Tr (response time) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020017233 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017234 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
17235 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017236 | | %U | bytes_uploaded (from client to server) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017237 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
17238 | | %b | backend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017239 | | %bc | beconn (backend concurrent connections) | numeric |
17240 | | %bi | backend_source_ip (connecting address) | IP |
17241 | | %bp | backend_source_port (connecting address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017242 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017243 | | %ci | client_ip (accepted address) | IP |
17244 | | %cp | client_port (accepted address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017245 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017246 | | %fc | feconn (frontend concurrent connections) | numeric |
17247 | | %fi | frontend_ip (accepting address) | IP |
17248 | | %fp | frontend_port (accepting address) | numeric |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020017249 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
Willy Tarreau7346acb2014-08-28 15:03:15 +020017250 | | %lc | frontend_log_counter | numeric |
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020017251 | | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
17252 | | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
17253 | | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
17254 | | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
Willy Tarreau812c88e2015-08-09 10:56:35 +020017255 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds (left-padded with 0) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020017256 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020017257 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017258 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
Willy Tarreau1f0da242014-01-25 11:01:50 +010017259 | | %rt | request_counter (HTTP req or TCP session) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017260 | | %s | server_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017261 | | %sc | srv_conn (server concurrent connections) | numeric |
17262 | | %si | server_IP (target address) | IP |
17263 | | %sp | server_port (target address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017264 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020017265 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
17266 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017267 | | %t | date_time (with millisecond resolution) | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017268 | H | %tr | date_time of HTTP request | date |
17269 | H | %trg | gmt_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
Jens Bissinger15c64ff2018-08-23 14:11:27 +020017270 | H | %trl | local_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017271 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020017272 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017273 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017274
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020017275 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017276
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010017277
172788.2.5. Error log format
17279-----------------------
17280
17281When an incoming connection fails due to an SSL handshake or an invalid PROXY
17282protocol header, haproxy will log the event using a shorter, fixed line format.
17283By default, logs are emitted at the LOG_INFO level, unless the option
17284"log-separate-errors" is set in the backend, in which case the LOG_ERR level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017285will be used. Connections on which no data are exchanged (e.g. probes) are not
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010017286logged if the "dontlognull" option is set.
17287
17288The format looks like this :
17289
17290 >>> Dec 3 18:27:14 localhost \
17291 haproxy[6103]: 127.0.0.1:56059 [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380] frt/f1: \
17292 Connection error during SSL handshake
17293
17294 Field Format Extract from the example above
17295 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[6103]:
17296 2 client_ip ':' client_port 127.0.0.1:56059
17297 3 '[' accept_date ']' [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380]
17298 4 frontend_name "/" bind_name ":" frt/f1:
17299 5 message Connection error during SSL handshake
17300
17301These fields just provide minimal information to help debugging connection
17302failures.
17303
17304
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200173058.3. Advanced logging options
17306-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017307
17308Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
17309just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
17310options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
17311for more information about their usage.
17312
17313
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200173148.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
17315------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017316
17317It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
17318haproxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
17319commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
17320monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
17321ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
17322
17323 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
17324 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
17325 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
17326 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
17327
17328 - if the connection come from a known source network, use "monitor-net" to
17329 declare this network as monitoring only. Any host in this network will then
17330 only be able to perform health checks, and their requests will not be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017331 logged. This is generally appropriate to designate a list of equipment
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017332 such as other load-balancers.
17333
17334 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
17335 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
17336 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
17337
17338
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200173398.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
17340----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017341
17342The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
17343what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
17344or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017345"option logasap" in the frontend. HAProxy will then log as soon as possible,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017346just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
17347log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
17348after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
17349is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
17350with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
17351with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
17352
17353
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200173548.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
17355------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020017356
17357Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
17358for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
17359"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
17360retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
17361raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
17362a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
17363file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
17364you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
17365"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
17366
17367
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200173688.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
17369--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020017370
17371Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
17372multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
17373them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
17374"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
17375logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
17376error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
17377and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
17378too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
17379useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
17380alternative.
17381
17382
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200173838.4. Timing events
17384------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017385
17386Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
17387reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
17388the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
17389frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017390mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/Ta". In
17391addition, three other measures are provided, "Th", "Ti", and "Tq".
17392
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010017393Timings events in HTTP mode:
17394
17395 first request 2nd request
17396 |<-------------------------------->|<-------------- ...
17397 t tr t tr ...
17398 ---|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|--
17399 : Th Ti TR Tw Tc Tr Td : Ti ...
17400 :<---- Tq ---->: :
17401 :<-------------- Tt -------------->:
17402 :<--------- Ta --------->:
17403
17404Timings events in TCP mode:
17405
17406 TCP session
17407 |<----------------->|
17408 t t
17409 ---|----|----|----|----|---
17410 | Th Tw Tc Td |
17411 |<------ Tt ------->|
17412
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017413 - Th: total time to accept tcp connection and execute handshakes for low level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017414 protocols. Currently, these protocols are proxy-protocol and SSL. This may
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017415 only happen once during the whole connection's lifetime. A large time here
17416 may indicate that the client only pre-established the connection without
17417 speaking, that it is experiencing network issues preventing it from
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017418 completing a handshake in a reasonable time (e.g. MTU issues), or that an
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017419 SSL handshake was very expensive to compute. Please note that this time is
17420 reported only before the first request, so it is safe to average it over
17421 all request to calculate the amortized value. The second and subsequent
17422 request will always report zero here.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017423
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017424 - Ti: is the idle time before the HTTP request (HTTP mode only). This timer
17425 counts between the end of the handshakes and the first byte of the HTTP
17426 request. When dealing with a second request in keep-alive mode, it starts
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017427 to count after the end of the transmission the previous response. When a
17428 multiplexed protocol such as HTTP/2 is used, it starts to count immediately
17429 after the previous request. Some browsers pre-establish connections to a
17430 server in order to reduce the latency of a future request, and keep them
17431 pending until they need it. This delay will be reported as the idle time. A
17432 value of -1 indicates that nothing was received on the connection.
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017433
17434 - TR: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
17435 elapsed between the first bytes received and the moment the proxy received
17436 the empty line marking the end of the HTTP headers. The value "-1"
17437 indicates that the end of headers has never been seen. This happens when
17438 the client closes prematurely or times out. This time is usually very short
17439 since most requests fit in a single packet. A large time may indicate a
17440 request typed by hand during a test.
17441
17442 - Tq: total time to get the client request from the accept date or since the
17443 emission of the last byte of the previous response (HTTP mode only). It's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017444 exactly equal to Th + Ti + TR unless any of them is -1, in which case it
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017445 returns -1 as well. This timer used to be very useful before the arrival of
17446 HTTP keep-alive and browsers' pre-connect feature. It's recommended to drop
17447 it in favor of TR nowadays, as the idle time adds a lot of noise to the
17448 reports.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017449
17450 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
17451 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
17452 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
17453 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
17454 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
17455
17456 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
17457 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
17458 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
17459 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
17460 connection never established.
17461
17462 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
17463 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
17464 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
17465 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
17466 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
17467 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
17468 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
17469 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
17470 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
17471 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
17472 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
17473
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017474 - Ta: total active time for the HTTP request, between the moment the proxy
17475 received the first byte of the request header and the emission of the last
17476 byte of the response body. The exception is when the "logasap" option is
17477 specified. In this case, it only equals (TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is prefixed with
17478 a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data transmission time,
17479 by subtracting other timers when valid :
17480
17481 Td = Ta - (TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
17482
17483 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. Note that
17484 "Ta" can never be negative.
17485
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017486 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
17487 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017488 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+Ti+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and
17489 is prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017490 transmission time, by subtracting other timers when valid :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017491
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017492 Td = Tt - (Th + Ti + TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017493
17494 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017495 mode, "Ti", "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never
17496 be negative and that for HTTP, Tt is simply equal to (Th+Ti+Ta).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017497
17498These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
17499protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
17500that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017501due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Ta" or
17502"Tt" is close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means
17503that a session has been aborted on timeout.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017504
17505Most common cases :
17506
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017507 - If "Th" or "Ti" are close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between
17508 the client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might
17509 happen when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It
17510 may happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network
17511 cause. Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has
17512 ended, haproxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds.
17513 The time spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay
17514 processing of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the
17515 order of a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of
17516 new connections have been accepted at once. Using one of the keep-alive
17517 modes may display larger idle times since "Ti" measures the time spent
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020017518 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017519
17520 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
17521 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
17522 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
17523 of ms on remote networks.
17524
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017525 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
17526 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
17527 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017528
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017529 - If "Ta" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
17530 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection while
17531 haproxy is running in tunnel mode and both have agreed on a keep-alive
17532 connection mode. In order to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify
17533 one of the HTTP options to manipulate keep-alive or close options on either
17534 the frontend or the backend. Having the smallest possible 'Ta' or 'Tt' is
17535 important when connection regulation is used with the "maxconn" option on
17536 the servers, since no new connection will be sent to the server until
17537 another one is released.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017538
17539Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
17540
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017541 TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Ta The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017542 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017543 except "Ta" which is shorter than reality.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017544
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017545 -1/xx/xx/xx/Ta The client was not able to send a complete request in time
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017546 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
17547 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
17548
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017549 TR/-1/xx/xx/Ta It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017550 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
17551 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
17552 flags.
17553
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017554 TR/Tw/-1/xx/Ta The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
17555 actively refused it or it timed out after Ta-(TR+Tw) ms.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017556 Check the session termination flags, then check the
17557 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
17558 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
17559 the client connection was maintained open.
17560
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017561 TR/Tw/Tc/-1/Ta The server has accepted the connection but did not return
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017562 a complete response in time, or it closed its connection
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017563 unexpectedly after Ta-(TR+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017564 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
17565
17566
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200175678.5. Session state at disconnection
17568-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017569
17570TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
17571"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
175722-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
17573each of which has a special meaning :
17574
17575 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
17576 session to terminate :
17577
17578 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
17579
17580 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
17581 server explicitly refused it.
17582
17583 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
17584 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
17585 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
17586 error in server response which might have caused information leak
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017587 (e.g. cacheable cookie).
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020017588
17589 L : the session was locally processed by haproxy and was not passed to
17590 a server. This is what happens for stats and redirects.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017591
17592 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
17593 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
17594 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
17595 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
17596 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
17597
17598 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
17599 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
17600 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
17601 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
17602 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
17603
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090017604 D : the session was killed by haproxy because the server was detected
17605 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
17606
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070017607 U : the session was killed by haproxy on this backup server because an
17608 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
17609 backup connections when going up.
17610
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020017611 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on haproxy.
17612
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017613 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
17614 send or receive data.
17615
17616 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
17617 send or receive data.
17618
17619 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
17620 with nothing left in the buffers.
17621
17622 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
17623
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010017624 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017625 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
17626
17627 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
17628 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
17629 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
17630 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
17631 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
17632
17633 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
17634 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
17635
17636 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
17637 server (HTTP only).
17638
17639 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
17640
17641 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
17642 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
17643 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
17644
17645 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
17646 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
17647 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
17648
17649 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
17650
17651 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
17652 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
17653
17654 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
17655 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
17656 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
17657
17658 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
17659 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020017660 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
17661 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017662
17663 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
17664 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
17665 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
17666 another server.
17667
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017668 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017669 server.
17670
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017671 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
17672 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
17673 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
17674 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
17675
17676 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
17677 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
17678 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
17679 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
17680
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020017681 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
17682 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
17683 "use-server" rule).
17684
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017685 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
17686
17687 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
17688 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
17689
17690 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
17691
17692 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
17693 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
17694 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
17695
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017696 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
17697 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017698 happens every time there is activity at a different date than the
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017699 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
17700 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
17701
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017702 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
17703
17704 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
17705 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
17706
17707 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
17708
17709 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
17710
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017711The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
17712was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017713helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
17714starvation, attacks, etc...
17715
17716The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
17717alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
17718easier finding and understanding.
17719
17720 Flags Reason
17721
17722 -- Normal termination.
17723
17724 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
17725 server. This can happen when haproxy tries to connect to a recently
17726 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while haproxy is
17727 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
17728
17729 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
17730 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
17731 client and haproxy which decided to actively break the connection,
17732 by network routing issues between the client and haproxy, or by a
17733 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
17734 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010017735
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017736 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
17737 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020017738 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017739
17740 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
17741 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
17742 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
17743
17744 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
17745 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
17746 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
17747 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
17748 the server takes too long to respond.
17749
17750 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
17751 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
17752 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
17753 long a time to respond.
17754
17755 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
17756 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
17757 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
17758 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between haproxy
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020017759 and the client. "option http-ignore-probes" can be used to ignore
17760 connections without any data transfer.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017761
17762 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
17763 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
17764 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
17765 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
17766 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020017767 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here. Note: recently,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020017768 some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature consisting
17769 in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites just
17770 in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
17771 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408
17772 Request Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when
17773 the browser decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log
17774 and feed the error counters. Some versions of some browsers have even
17775 been reported to display the error code. It is possible to work
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017776 around the undesirable effects of this behavior by adding "option
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020017777 http-ignore-probes" in the frontend, resulting in connections with
17778 zero data transfer to be totally ignored. This will definitely hide
17779 the errors of people experiencing connectivity issues though.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017780
17781 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
17782 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017783 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
17784 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
17785 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
17786 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017787
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020017788 LR The request was intercepted and locally handled by haproxy. Generally
17789 it means that this was a redirect or a stats request.
17790
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010017791 SC The server or an equipment between it and haproxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017792 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
17793 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017794 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (e.g. no route,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017795 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
17796 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
17797
17798 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
17799 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
17800 503 or 504 here.
17801
17802 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
17803 transfer. This usually means that haproxy has received an RST from
17804 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
17805 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
17806 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
17807
17808 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
17809 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017810 by too short timeouts on L4 equipment before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017811 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
17812 between the client and the server expiring first on haproxy.
17813
17814 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
17815 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
17816 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
17817 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
17818 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
17819 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
17820 between haproxy and the server.
17821
17822 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
17823 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
17824 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
17825 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
17826 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
17827 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
17828 solution is to fix the application.
17829
17830 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
17831 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
17832 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
17833 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
17834 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
17835 external attacks.
17836
17837 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
17838 process' socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020017839 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017840 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
17841 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
17842
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010017843 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
17844 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
17845 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017846 the client. HAProxy supports chunk sizes of up to 2GB - 1 (2147483647
Willy Tarreauf3a3e132013-08-31 08:16:26 +020017847 bytes). Any larger size will be considered as an error.
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010017848
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017849 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
17850 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
17851 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
17852 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010017853 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
17854 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
17855 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
17856 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
17857 logs.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017858
17859 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
17860 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
17861 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
17862 returned an HTTP 403 error.
17863
17864 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
17865 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
17866 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
17867 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
17868
17869 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
17870 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
17871 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
17872 only be solved by proper system tuning.
17873
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017874The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
17875persistence was handled by the client, the server and by haproxy. This is very
17876important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
17877re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
17878
17879 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
17880
17881 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
17882 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
17883 set on a GET request.
17884
17885 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
17886 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017887 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017888 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
17889
17890 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
17891 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
17892 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
17893
17894 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
17895 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
17896 already got a cookie.
17897
17898 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
17899 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
17900 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
17901 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
17902 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
17903
17904 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
17905 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
17906 new cookie was inserted in the response.
17907
17908 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
17909 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
17910 new cookie was inserted in the response.
17911
17912 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
17913 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
17914
17915 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
17916 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
17917 then advertised in the response.
17918
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017919
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200179208.6. Non-printable characters
17921-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017922
17923In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
17924consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
17925converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
17926prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
17927being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
17928escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
17929is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
17930'}' when logging headers.
17931
17932Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
17933issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
17934containing spaces is "User-Agent".
17935
17936Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
17937the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
17938performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
17939
17940
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200179418.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
17942---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017943
17944Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
17945achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017946section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017947cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
17948the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
17949the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017950locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017951not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
17952user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
17953a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
17954wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
17955
17956 Examples :
17957 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
17958 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
17959
17960 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
17961 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
17962
17963
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200179648.8. Capturing HTTP headers
17965---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017966
17967Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
17968proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
17969the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
17970server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
17971
17972Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
17973response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017974section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017975
17976It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010017977time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
17978appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017979are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
17980and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
17981follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
17982request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
17983in the logs.
17984
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020017985As a special case, it is possible to specify an HTTP header capture in a TCP
17986frontend. The purpose is to enable logging of headers which will be parsed in
17987an HTTP backend if the request is then switched to this HTTP backend.
17988
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017989 Example :
17990 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
17991 listen proxy-out
17992 mode http
17993 option httplog
17994 option logasap
17995 log global
17996 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
17997
17998 # log the name of the virtual server
17999 capture request header Host len 20
18000
18001 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
18002 capture request header Content-Length len 10
18003
18004 # log the beginning of the referrer
18005 capture request header Referer len 20
18006
18007 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
18008 capture response header Server len 20
18009
18010 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
18011 capture response header Content-Length len 10
18012
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018013 # log the expected cache behavior on the response
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018014 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
18015
18016 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
18017 capture response header Via len 20
18018
18019 # log the URL location during a redirection
18020 capture response header Location len 20
18021
18022 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
18023 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
18024 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
18025 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
18026 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
18027
18028 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
18029 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
18030 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
18031 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010018032 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018033
18034 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
18035 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
18036 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
18037 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
18038 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010018039 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018040
18041
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200180428.9. Examples of logs
18043---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018044
18045These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
18046them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
18047reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
18048
18049 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
18050 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
18051 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
18052
18053 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
18054 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
18055
18056 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
18057 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
18058 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
18059
18060 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
18061 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
18062
18063 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
18064 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
18065 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
18066
18067 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010018068 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018069 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
18070 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
18071
18072 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
18073 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
18074 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
18075
18076 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "rspdeny" or
18077 "rspideny" filter, or because the response was improperly formatted and
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +020018078 not HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018079 risked being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502
18080 bad gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was haproxy who decided
18081 to return the 502 and not the server.
18082
18083 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010018084 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018085
18086 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
18087 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
18088 Nothing was sent to any server.
18089
18090 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
18091 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
18092
18093 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
18094 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018095 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018096 send a 408 return code to the client.
18097
18098 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
18099 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
18100
18101 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
18102 5 seconds ("c----").
18103
18104 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
18105 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010018106 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018107
18108 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018109 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018110 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
18111 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
18112 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
18113 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
18114 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010018115
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020018116
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200181179. Supported filters
18118--------------------
18119
18120Here are listed officially supported filters with the list of parameters they
18121accept. Depending on compile options, some of these filters might be
18122unavailable. The list of available filters is reported in haproxy -vv.
18123
18124See also : "filter"
18125
181269.1. Trace
18127----------
18128
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010018129filter trace [name <name>] [random-parsing] [random-forwarding] [hexdump]
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020018130
18131 Arguments:
18132 <name> is an arbitrary name that will be reported in
18133 messages. If no name is provided, "TRACE" is used.
18134
18135 <random-parsing> enables the random parsing of data exchanged between
18136 the client and the server. By default, this filter
18137 parses all available data. With this parameter, it
18138 only parses a random amount of the available data.
18139
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018140 <random-forwarding> enables the random forwarding of parsed data. By
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020018141 default, this filter forwards all previously parsed
18142 data. With this parameter, it only forwards a random
18143 amount of the parsed data.
18144
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018145 <hexdump> dumps all forwarded data to the server and the client.
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010018146
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020018147This filter can be used as a base to develop new filters. It defines all
18148callbacks and print a message on the standard error stream (stderr) with useful
18149information for all of them. It may be useful to debug the activity of other
18150filters or, quite simply, HAProxy's activity.
18151
18152Using <random-parsing> and/or <random-forwarding> parameters is a good way to
18153tests the behavior of a filter that parses data exchanged between a client and
18154a server by adding some latencies in the processing.
18155
18156
181579.2. HTTP compression
18158---------------------
18159
18160filter compression
18161
18162The HTTP compression has been moved in a filter in HAProxy 1.7. "compression"
18163keyword must still be used to enable and configure the HTTP compression. And
Christopher Faulet27d93c32018-12-15 22:32:02 +010018164when no other filter is used, it is enough. When used with the cache enabled,
18165it is also enough. In this case, the compression is always done after the
18166response is stored in the cache. But it is mandatory to explicitly use a filter
18167line to enable the HTTP compression when at least one filter other than the
18168cache is used for the same listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know
18169the filters evaluation order.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020018170
Christopher Faulet27d93c32018-12-15 22:32:02 +010018171See also : "compression" and section 9.4 about the cache filter.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020018172
18173
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +0200181749.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
18175--------------------------------------------
18176
18177filter spoe [engine <name>] config <file>
18178
18179 Arguments :
18180
18181 <name> is the engine name that will be used to find the right scope in
18182 the configuration file. If not provided, all the file will be
18183 parsed.
18184
18185 <file> is the path of the engine configuration file. This file can
18186 contain configuration of several engines. In this case, each
18187 part must be placed in its own scope.
18188
18189The Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE) is a filter communicating with
18190external components. It allows the offload of some specifics processing on the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018191streams in tiered applications. These external components and information
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020018192exchanged with them are configured in dedicated files, for the main part. It
18193also requires dedicated backends, defined in HAProxy configuration.
18194
18195SPOE communicates with external components using an in-house binary protocol,
18196the Stream Processing Offload Protocol (SPOP).
18197
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010018198For all information about the SPOE configuration and the SPOP specification, see
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020018199"doc/SPOE.txt".
18200
18201Important note:
18202 The SPOE filter is highly experimental for now and was not heavily
18203 tested. It is really not production ready. So use it carefully.
18204
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +0100182059.4. Cache
18206----------
18207
18208filter cache <name>
18209
18210 Arguments :
18211
18212 <name> is name of the cache section this filter will use.
18213
18214The cache uses a filter to store cacheable responses. The HTTP rules
18215"cache-store" and "cache-use" must be used to define how and when to use a
18216cache. By default the correpsonding filter is implicitly defined. And when no
Christopher Faulet27d93c32018-12-15 22:32:02 +010018217other filters than cache or compression are used, it is enough. In such case,
18218the compression filter is always evaluated after the cache filter. But it is
18219mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to use a cache when at least one
18220filter other than the compression is used for the same
18221listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
18222order.
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +010018223
Christopher Faulet27d93c32018-12-15 22:32:02 +010018224See also : section 9.2 about the compression filter and section 10 about cache.
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +010018225
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01001822610. Cache
18227---------
18228
18229HAProxy provides a cache, which was designed to perform cache on small objects
18230(favicon, css...). This is a minimalist low-maintenance cache which runs in
18231RAM.
18232
18233The cache is based on a memory which is shared between processes and threads,
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +010018234this memory is split in blocks of 1k.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018235
18236If an object is not used anymore, it can be deleted to store a new object
18237independently of its expiration date. The oldest objects are deleted first
18238when we try to allocate a new one.
18239
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +010018240The cache uses a hash of the host header and the URI as the key.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018241
18242It's possible to view the status of a cache using the Unix socket command
18243"show cache" consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide
18244for more details.
18245
18246When an object is delivered from the cache, the server name in the log is
18247replaced by "<CACHE>".
18248
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +01001824910.1. Limitation
18250----------------
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018251
18252The cache won't store and won't deliver objects in these cases:
18253
18254- If the response is not a 200
18255- If the response contains a Vary header
Frédéric Lécaille5f8bea62018-10-23 10:09:19 +020018256- If the Content-Length + the headers size is greater than "max-object-size"
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018257- If the response is not cacheable
18258
18259- If the request is not a GET
18260- If the HTTP version of the request is smaller than 1.1
William Lallemand8a16fe02018-05-22 11:04:33 +020018261- If the request contains an Authorization header
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018262
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +010018263Caution!: For HAProxy version prior to 1.9, due to the limitation of the
18264filters, it is not recommended to use the cache with other filters. Using them
18265can cause undefined behavior if they modify the response (compression for
18266example). For HAProxy 1.9 and greater, it is safe, for HTX proxies only (see
18267"option http-use-htx" for details).
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018268
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +01001826910.2. Setup
18270-----------
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018271
18272To setup a cache, you must define a cache section and use it in a proxy with
18273the corresponding http-request and response actions.
18274
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +01001827510.2.1. Cache section
18276---------------------
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018277
18278cache <name>
18279 Declare a cache section, allocate a shared cache memory named <name>, the
18280 size of cache is mandatory.
18281
18282total-max-size <megabytes>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018283 Define the size in RAM of the cache in megabytes. This size is split in
Frédéric Lécaillee3c83d82018-10-25 10:46:40 +020018284 blocks of 1kB which are used by the cache entries. Its maximum value is 4095.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018285
Frédéric Lécaille5f8bea62018-10-23 10:09:19 +020018286max-object-size <bytes>
Frédéric Lécaillee3c83d82018-10-25 10:46:40 +020018287 Define the maximum size of the objects to be cached. Must not be greater than
18288 an half of "total-max-size". If not set, it equals to a 256th of the cache size.
18289 All objects with sizes larger than "max-object-size" will not be cached.
Frédéric Lécaille5f8bea62018-10-23 10:09:19 +020018290
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018291max-age <seconds>
18292 Define the maximum expiration duration. The expiration is set has the lowest
18293 value between the s-maxage or max-age (in this order) directive in the
18294 Cache-Control response header and this value. The default value is 60
18295 seconds, which means that you can't cache an object more than 60 seconds by
18296 default.
18297
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +01001829810.2.2. Proxy section
18299---------------------
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018300
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +020018301http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018302 Try to deliver a cached object from the cache <name>. This directive is also
18303 mandatory to store the cache as it calculates the cache hash. If you want to
18304 use a condition for both storage and delivering that's a good idea to put it
18305 after this one.
18306
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +020018307http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018308 Store an http-response within the cache. The storage of the response headers
18309 is done at this step, which means you can use others http-response actions
18310 to modify headers before or after the storage of the response. This action
18311 is responsible for the setup of the cache storage filter.
18312
18313
18314Example:
18315
18316 backend bck1
18317 mode http
18318
18319 http-request cache-use foobar
18320 http-response cache-store foobar
18321 server srv1 127.0.0.1:80
18322
18323 cache foobar
18324 total-max-size 4
18325 max-age 240
18326
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010018327/*
18328 * Local variables:
18329 * fill-column: 79
18330 * End:
18331 */